After the conquest of the South Pole by Amundsen, who, by a
narrow margin of days only, was in advance of the British
Expedition under Scott, there remained but one great main object
of Antarctic journeyings—the crossing of the South Polar continent
from sea to sea.
When I returned from the Nimrod Expedition on which we had to turn
back from our attempt to plant the British flag on the South Pole,
being beaten by stress of circumstances within ninety-seven miles
of our goal, my mind turned to the crossing of the continent, for
I was morally certain that either Amundsen or Scott would reach
the Pole on our own route or a parallel one. After hearing of
the Norwegian success I began to make preparations to start a last
great journey—so that the first crossing of the last continent
should be achieved by a British Expedition.
We failed in this object, but the story of our attempt is the
subject for the following pages, and I think that though failure
in the actual accomplishment must be recorded, there are chapters
in this book of high adventure, strenuous days, lonely nights,
unique experiences, and, above all, records of unflinching
determination, supreme loyalty, and generous self-sacrifice on
the part of my men which, even in these days that have witnessed
the sacrifices of nations and regardlessness of self on the part
of individuals, still will be of interest to readers who now turn
gladly from the red horror of war and the strain of the last five
years to read, perhaps with more understanding minds, the tale of
the White Warfare of the South. The struggles, the disappointments,
and the endurance of this small party of Britishers, hidden away
for nearly two years in the fastnesses of the Polar ice, striving
to carry out the ordained task and ignorant of the crises through
which the world was passing, make a story which is unique in the
history of Antarctic exploration.
Owing to the loss of the Endurance and the disaster to the Aurora,
certain documents relating mainly to the organization and preparation
of the Expedition have been lost; but, anyhow, I had no intention of
presenting a detailed account of the scheme of preparation, storing,
and other necessary but, to the general reader, unimportant affairs,
as since the beginning of this century, every book on Antarctic
exploration has dealt fully with this matter. I therefore briefly
place before you the inception and organization of the Expedition,
and insert here the copy of the programme which I prepared in order
to arouse the interest of the general public in the Expedition.
“The Trans-continental Party.
“The first crossing of the Antarctic continent, from sea to sea
via the Pole, apart from its historic value, will be a journey
of great scientific importance.
“The distance will be roughly 1800 miles, and the first half of
this, from the Weddell Sea to the Pole, will be over unknown
ground. Every step will be an advance in geographical science.
It will be learned whether the great Victoria chain of mountains,
which has been traced from the Ross Sea to the Pole, extends across
the continent and thus links up (except for the ocean break)
with the Andes of South America, and whether the great plateau
around the Pole dips gradually towards the Weddell Sea.
“Continuous magnetic observations will be taken on the journey.
The route will lead towards the Magnetic Pole, and the determination
of the dip of the magnetic needle will be of importance in practical
magnetism. The meteorological conditions will be carefully noted,
and this should help to solve many of our weather problems.
“The glaciologist and geologist will study ice formations and the
nature of the mountains, and this report will prove of great
scientific interest.
“Scientific Work by Other Parties.
“While the Trans-continental party is carrying out, for the
British Flag, the greatest Polar journey ever attempted,
the other parties will be engaged in important scientific work.
“Two sledging parties will operate from the base on the Weddell
Sea. One will travel westwards towards Graham Land, making
observations, collecting geological specimens, and proving whether
there are mountains in that region linked up with those found on
the other side of the Pole.
“Another party will travel eastward toward Enderby Land, carrying
out a similar programme, and a third, remaining at the base, will
study the fauna of the land and sea, and the meteorological
conditions.
“From the Ross Sea base, on the other side of the Pole, another
party will push southward and will probably await the arrival of
the Trans-continental party at the top of the Beardmore Glacier,
near Mount Buckley, where the first seams of coal were discovered
in the Antarctic. This region is of great importance to the
geologist, who will be enabled to read much of the history of the
Antarctic in the rocks.
“Both the ships of the Expedition will be equipped for dredging,
sounding, and every variety of hydrographical work. The Weddell
Sea ship will endeavour to trace the unknown coast-line of Graham
Land, and from both the vessels, with their scientific staffs,
important results may be expected.
“The several shore parties and the two ships will thus carry out
geographical and scientific work on a scale and over an area never
before attempted by any one Polar expedition.
“This will be the first use of the Weddell Sea as a base for
exploration, and all the parties will open up vast stretches of
unknown land. It is appropriate that this work should be carried
out under the British Flag, since the whole of the area southward
to the Pole is British territory. In July 1908, Letters Patent
were issued under the Great Seal declaring that the Governor of the
Falkland Islands should be the Governor of Graham Land (which forms
the western side of the Weddell Sea), and another section of the
same proclamation defines the area of British territory as
‘situated in the South Atlantic Ocean to the south of the 50th
parallel of south latitude, and lying between 20 degrees and
80 degrees west longitude.’ Reference to a map will show that this
includes the area in which the present Expedition will work.
“How the Continent will be crossed.
“The Weddell Sea ship, with all the members of the Expedition
operating from that base, will leave Buenos Ayres in October
1914, and endeavour to land in November in latitude 78 degrees
south.
“Should this be done, the Trans-continental party will set out on
their 1800-mile journey at once, in the hope of accomplishing
the march across the Pole and reaching the Ross Sea base in five
months. Should the landing be made too late in the season, the
party will go into winter quarters, lay out depots during the autumn
and the following spring, and as early as possible in 1915 set out
on the journey.
“The Trans-continental party will be led by Sir Ernest Shackleton,
and will consist of six men. It will take 100 dogs with sledges,
and two motor-sledges with aerial propellers. The equipment will
embody everything that the experience of the leader and his expert
advisers can suggest. When this party has reached the area of the
Pole, after covering 800 miles of unknown ground, it will strike due
north towards the head of the Beardmore Glacier, and there it is
hoped to meet the outcoming party from the Ross Sea. Both will join
up and make for the Ross Sea base, where the previous Expedition had
its winter quarters.
“In all, fourteen men will be landed by the Endurance on the
Weddell Sea. Six will set out on the Trans-continental journey,
three will go westward, three eastward, and two remain at the base
carrying on the work already outlined.
“The Aurora will land six men at the Ross Sea base. They will
lay down depots on the route of the Trans-continental party, and
make a march south to assist that party, and to make geological
and other observations as already described.
“Should the Trans-continental party succeed, as is hoped, in
crossing during the first season, its return to civilization
may be expected about April 1915. The other sections in April
1916.
“The Ships of the Expedition.
“The two ships for the Expedition have now been selected.
“The Endurance, the ship which will take the Trans-continental
party to the Weddell Sea, and will afterwards explore along an
unknown coast-line, is a new vessel, specially constructed for
Polar work under the supervision of a committee of Polar explorers.
She was built by Christensen, the famous Norwegian constructor of
sealing vessels, at Sandefjord. She is barquentine rigged, and
has triple-expansion engines giving her a speed under steam of nine
to ten knots. To enable her to stay longer at sea, she will carry
oil fuel as well as coal. She is of about 350 tons, and built of
selected pine, oak, and greenheart. This fine vessel, equipped,
has cost the Expedition £14,000.
“The Aurora, the ship which will take out the Ross Sea party,
has been bought from Dr. Mawson. She is similar in all respects
to the Terra Nova, of Captain Scott’s last Expedition. She
had extensive alterations made by the Government authorities in
Australia to fit her for Dr. Mawson’s Expedition, and is now at
Hobart, Tasmania, where the Ross Sea party will join her in
October next.”
I started the preparations in the middle of 1913, but no public
announcement was made until January 13, 1914. For the last six
months of 1913 I was engaged in the necessary preliminaries, solid
mule work, showing nothing particular to interest the public, but
essential for an Expedition that had to have a ship on each side
of the Continent, with a land journey of eighteen hundred miles to
be made, the first nine hundred miles to be across an absolutely
unknown land mass.
On January 1, 1914, having received a promised financial support
sufficient to warrant the announcement of the Expedition, I made it
public.
The first result of this was a flood of applications from all classes
of the community to join the adventure. I received nearly five
thousand applications, and out of these were picked fifty-six men.
In March, to my great disappointment and anxiety, the promised
financial help did not materialize, and I was now faced with the
fact that I had contracted for a ship and stores, and had engaged the
staff, and I was not in possession of funds to meet these liabilities.
I immediately set about appealing for help, and met with generous
response from all sides. I cannot here give the names of all who
supported my application, but whilst taking this opportunity of
thanking every one for their support, which came from parts as far
apart as the interior of China, Japan, New Zealand, and Australia,
I must particularly refer to the munificent donation of £24,000
from the late Sir James Caird, and to one of £10,000 from the
British Government. I must also thank Mr. Dudley Docker, who enabled
me to complete the purchase of the Endurance, and Miss Elizabeth
Dawson Lambton, who since 1901 has always been a firm friend to
Antarctic exploration, and who again, on this occasion, assisted
largely. The Royal Geographical Society made a grant of £1000;
and last, but by no means least, I take this opportunity of
tendering my grateful thanks to Dame Janet Stancomb Wills, whose
generosity enabled me to equip the Endurance efficiently, especially
as regards boats (which boats were the means of our ultimate safety),
and who not only, at the inception of the Expedition, gave financial
help, but also continued it through the dark days when we were
overdue, and funds were required to meet the need of the dependents
of the Expedition.
The only return and privilege an explorer has in the way of
acknowledgment for the help accorded him is to record on the
discovered lands the names of those to whom the Expedition owes
its being.
Owing to the exigencies of the war the publication of this book
has been long delayed, and the detailed maps must come with the
scientific monographs. I have the honour to place on the
new land the names of the above and other generous donors to the
Expedition. The two hundred miles of new coast-line I have called
Caird Coast. Also, as a more personal note, I named the three
ship’s boats, in which we ultimately escaped from the grip of the
ice, after the three principal donors to the Expedition—the James
Caird, the Stancomb Wills and the Dudley Docker. The two last-named
are still on the desolate sandy spit of Elephant Island, where
under their shelter twenty-two of my comrades eked out a bare existence
for four and a half months.
The James Caird is now in Liverpool, having been brought home from
South Georgia after her adventurous voyage across the sub-Antarctic
ocean.
Most of the Public Schools of England and Scotland helped the Expedition
to purchase the dog teams, and I named a dog after each school that
helped. But apart from these particular donations I again thank the
many people who assisted us.
So the equipment and organization went on. I purchased the Aurora
from Sir Douglas Mawson, and arranged for Mackintosh to go to
Australia and take charge of her, there sending sledges, equipment
and most of the stores from this side, but depending somewhat on the
sympathy and help of Australia and New Zealand for coal and certain
other necessities, knowing that previously these two countries had
always generously supported the exploration of what one might call
their hinterland.
Towards the end of July all was ready, when suddenly the war clouds
darkened over Europe.
It had been arranged for the Endurance to proceed to Cowes, to be
inspected by His Majesty on the Monday of Cowes week. But on Friday
I received a message to say that the King would not be able to go to
Cowes. My readers will remember how suddenly came the menace of war.
Naturally, both my comrades and I were greatly exercised as to the
probable outcome of the danger threatening the peace of the world.
We sailed from London on Friday, August 1, 1914, and anchored off
Southend all Saturday. On Sunday afternoon I took the ship off
Margate, growing hourly more anxious as the ever-increasing
rumours spread; and on Monday morning I went ashore and read in
the morning paper the order for general mobilization.
I immediately went on board and mustered all hands and told them
that I proposed to send a telegram to the Admiralty offering the
ships, stores, and, if they agreed, our own services to the
country in the event of war breaking out. All hands immediately
agreed, and I sent off a telegram in which everything was placed
at the disposal of the Admiralty. We only asked that, in the event
of the declaration of war, the Expedition might be considered as a
single unit, so as to preserve its homogeneity. There were enough
trained and experienced men amongst us to man a destroyer. Within
an hour I received a laconic wire from the Admiralty saying “Proceed.”
Within two hours a longer wire came from Mr. Winston Churchill, in which
we were thanked for our offer, and saying that the authorities desired
that the Expedition, which had the full sanction and support of the
Scientific and Geographical Societies, should go on.
So, according to these definite instructions, the Endurance sailed
to Plymouth. On Tuesday the King sent for me and handed me the Union
Jack to carry on the Expedition. That night, at midnight, war broke
out. On the following Saturday, August 8, the Endurance sailed from
Plymouth, obeying the direct order of the Admiralty. I make particular
reference to this phase of the Expedition as I am aware that there was
a certain amount of criticism of the Expedition having left the country,
and regarding this I wish further to add that the preparation of the
Expedition had been proceeding for over a year, and large sums of money
had been spent. We offered to give the Expedition up without even
consulting the donors of this money, and but few thought that the war
would last through these five years and involve the whole world.
The Expedition was not going on a peaceful cruise to the South Sea
Islands, but to a most dangerous, difficult, and strenuous work that
has nearly always involved a certain percentage of loss of life.
Finally, when the Expedition did return, practically the whole of
those members who had come unscathed through the dangers of the
Antarctic took their places in the wider field of battle, and the
percentage of casualties amongst the members of this Expedition is
high.
The voyage out to Buenos Ayres was uneventful, and on October 26 we
sailed from that port for South Georgia, the most southerly outpost
of the British Empire. Here, for a month, we were engaged in final
preparation. The last we heard of the war was when we left Buenos
Ayres. Then the Russian Steam-Roller was advancing. According to
many the war would be over within six months. And so we left, not
without regret that we could not take our place there, but secure
in the knowledge that we were taking part in a strenuous campaign
for the credit of our country.
Apart from private individuals and societies I here acknowledge
most gratefully the assistance rendered by the Dominion
Government of New Zealand and the Commonwealth Government of
Australia at the start of the Ross Sea section of the Expedition;
and to the people of New Zealand and the Dominion Government I
tender my most grateful thanks for their continued help, which
was invaluable during the dark days before the relief of the Ross
Sea Party.
Mr. James Allen (acting Premier), the late Mr. McNab (Minister of
Marine), Mr. Leonard Tripp, Mr. Mabin, and Mr. Toogood, and
many others have laid me under a debt of gratitude that can
never be repaid.
This is also the opportunity for me to thank the Uruguayan
Government for their generous assistance in placing the government
trawler, Instituto de Pesca, for the second attempt at the relief
of my men on Elephant Island.
Finally, it was the Chilian Government that was directly
responsible for the rescue of my comrades. This southern
Republic was unwearied in its efforts to make a successful
rescue, and the gratitude of our whole party is due to them.
I especially mention the sympathetic attitude of Admiral Muñoz
Hurtado, head of the Chilian Navy, and Captain Luis Pardo, who
commanded the Yelcho on our last and successful venture.
Sir Daniel Gooch came with us as far as South Georgia. I owe
him my special thanks for his help with the dogs, and we all
regretted losing his cheery presence, when we sailed for the
South.
INTO THE WEDDELL SEA
I decided to leave South Georgia about December 5, and in the
intervals of final preparation scanned again the plans for the
voyage to winter quarters. What welcome was the Weddell Sea
preparing for us? The whaling captains at South Georgia were
generously ready to share with me their knowledge of the waters
in which they pursued their trade, and, while confirming earlier
information as to the extreme severity of the ice conditions in
this sector of the Antarctic, they were able to give advice that
was worth attention.
It will be convenient to state here briefly some of the considerations
that weighed with me at that time and in the weeks that followed.
I knew that the ice had come far north that season and, after
listening to the suggestions of the whaling captains, had decided
to steer to the South Sandwich Group, round Ultima Thule, and work
as far to the eastward as the fifteenth meridian west longitude
before pushing south. The whalers emphasized the difficulty of
getting through the ice in the neighbourhood of the South Sandwich
Group. They told me they had often seen the floes come right up to
the group in the summer-time, and they thought the Expedition would
have to push through heavy pack in order to reach the Weddell Sea.
Probably the best time to get into the Weddell Sea would be the
end of February or the beginning of March. The whalers had gone
right round the South Sandwich Group and they were familiar with
the conditions. The predictions they made induced me to take the
deck-load of coal, for if we had to fight our way through to Coats’
Land we would need every ton of fuel the ship could carry.
I hoped that by first moving to the east as far as the fifteenth
meridian west we would be able to go south through looser ice,
pick up Coats’ Land and finally reach Vahsel Bay, where Filchner
made his attempt at landing in 1912. Two considerations were
occupying my mind at this juncture. I was anxious for certain
reasons to winter the Endurance in the Weddell Sea, but the
difficulty of finding a safe harbour might be very great. If no
safe harbour could be found, the ship must winter at South
Georgia. It seemed to me hopeless now to think of making the
journey across the continent in the first summer, as the season
was far advanced and the ice conditions were likely to prove
unfavourable. In view of the possibility of wintering the ship
in the ice, we took extra clothing from the stores at the various
stations in South Georgia.
The other question that was giving me anxious thought was the size
of the shore party. If the ship had to go out during the winter,
or if she broke away from winter quarters, it would be preferable
to have only a small, carefully selected party of men ashore after
the hut had been built and the stores landed. These men could proceed
to lay out depots by man-haulage and make short journeys with the dogs,
training them for the long early march in the following spring.
The majority of the scientific men would live aboard the ship, where
they could do their work under good conditions. They would be able
to make short journeys if required, using the Endurance as a base.
All these plans were based on an expectation that the finding of winter
quarters was likely to be difficult. If a really safe base could
be established on the continent, I would adhere to the original
programme of sending one party to the south, one to the west
round the head of the Weddell Sea towards Graham Land, and one
to the east towards Enderby Land.
We had worked out details of distances, courses, stores required,
and so forth. Our sledging ration, the result of experience as well
as close study, was perfect. The dogs gave promise, after training,
of being able to cover fifteen to twenty miles a day with loaded
sledges. The trans-continental journey, at this rate, should be
completed in 120 days unless some unforeseen obstacle intervened.
We longed keenly for the day when we could begin this march, the
last great adventure in the history of South Polar exploration,
but a knowledge of the obstacles that lay between us and our
starting-point served as a curb on impatience. Everything depended
upon the landing. If we could land at Filchner’s base there was no
reason why a band of experienced men should not winter there in
safety. But the Weddell Sea was notoriously inhospitable and
already we knew that its sternest face was turned toward us.
All the conditions in the Weddell Sea are unfavourable from the
navigator’s point of view. The winds are comparatively light,
and consequently new ice can form even in the summer-time.
The absence of strong winds has the additional effect of allowing
the ice to accumulate in masses, undisturbed. Then great quantities
of ice sweep along the coast from the east under the influence of
the prevailing current, and fill up the bight of the Weddell Sea
as they move north in a great semicircle. Some of this ice
doubtless describes almost a complete circle, and is held up
eventually, in bad seasons, against the South Sandwich Islands.
The strong currents, pressing the ice masses against the coasts,
create heavier pressure than is found in any other part of the
Antarctic. This pressure must be at least as severe as the pressure
experienced in the congested North Polar basin, and I am inclined
to think that a comparison would be to the advantage of the Arctic.
All these considerations naturally had a bearing upon our immediate
problem, the penetration of the pack and the finding of a safe
harbour on the continental coast.
The day of departure arrived. I gave the order to heave
anchor at 8.45 a.m. on December 5, 1914, and the clanking of the
windlass broke for us the last link with civilization. The morning
was dull and overcast, with occasional gusts of snow and sleet, but
hearts were light aboard the Endurance. The long days of preparation
were over and the adventure lay ahead.
We had hoped that some steamer from the north would bring news of
war and perhaps letters from home before our departure. A ship
did arrive on the evening of the 4th, but she carried no letters,
and nothing useful in the way of information could be gleaned from
her. The captain and crew were all stoutly pro-German, and the
“news” they had to give took the unsatisfying form of accounts
of British and French reverses. We would have been glad to have
had the latest tidings from a friendlier source. A year and a
half later we were to learn that the Harpoon, the steamer which
tends the Grytviken station, had arrived with mail for us not more
than two hours after the Endurance had proceeded down the coast.
The bows of the Endurance were turned to the south, and the good
ship dipped to the south-westerly swell. Misty rain fell during
the forenoon, but the weather cleared later in the day, and we had
a good view of the coast of South Georgia as we moved under steam
and sail to the south-east. The course was laid to carry us clear
of the island and then south of South Thule, Sandwich Group. The
wind freshened during the day, and all square sail was set, with
the foresail reefed in order to give the look-out a clear view
ahead; for we did not wish to risk contact with a “growler,” one
of those treacherous fragments of ice that float with surface
awash. The ship was very steady in the quarterly sea, but
certainly did not look as neat and trim as she had done when
leaving the shores of England four months earlier. We had filled
up with coal at Grytviken, and this extra fuel was stored on deck,
where it impeded movement considerably. The carpenter had built a
false deck, extending from the poop-deck to the chart-room. We had
also taken aboard a ton of whale-meat for the dogs. The big
chunks of meat were hung up in the rigging, out of reach but not
out of sight of the dogs, and as the Endurance rolled and pitched,
they watched with wolfish eyes for a windfall.
I was greatly pleased with the dogs, which were tethered about
the ship in the most comfortable positions we could find for them.
They were in excellent condition, and I felt that the Expedition
had the right tractive-power. They were big, sturdy animals,
chosen for endurance and strength, and if they were as keen to
pull our sledges as they were now to fight one another all would
be well. The men in charge of the dogs were doing their work
enthusiastically, and the eagerness they showed to study the natures
and habits of their charges gave promise of efficient handling and
good work later on.
During December 6 the Endurance made good progress on a south-easterly
course. The northerly breeze had freshened during
the night and had brought up a high following sea. The weather
was hazy, and we passed two bergs, several growlers, and numerous
lumps of ice. Staff and crew were settling down to the routine.
Bird life was plentiful, and we noticed Cape pigeons, whale-birds,
terns, mollymauks, nellies, sooty, and wandering albatrosses in
the neighbourhood of the ship. The course was laid for the passage
between Sanders Island and Candlemas Volcano. December 7 brought
the first check. At six o’clock that morning the sea, which had
been green in colour all the previous day, changed suddenly to a
deep indigo. The ship was behaving well in a rough sea, and some
members of the scientific staff were transferring to the bunkers
the coal we had stowed on deck. Sanders Island and Candlemas were
sighted early in the afternoon, and the Endurance passed between
them at 6 p.m. Worsley’s observations indicated that Sanders Island
was, roughly, three miles east and five miles north of the charted
position. Large numbers of bergs, mostly tabular in form, lay to
the west of the islands, and we noticed that many of them were
yellow with diatoms. One berg had large patches of red-brown soil
down its sides. The presence of so many bergs was ominous,
and immediately after passing between the islands we encountered
stream-ice. All sail was taken in and we proceeded slowly under
steam. Two hours later, fifteen miles north-east of Sanders
Island, the Endurance was confronted by a belt of heavy pack-ice,
half a mile broad and extending north and south. There was clear
water beyond, but the heavy south-westerly swell made the pack
impenetrable in our neighbourhood. This was disconcerting.
The noon latitude had been 57° 26´ S., and I had
not expected to find pack-ice nearly so far north, though the whalers
had reported pack-ice right up to South Thule.
The situation became dangerous that night. We pushed into the pack
in the hope of reaching open water beyond, and found ourselves
after dark in a pool which was growing smaller and smaller. The
ice was grinding around the ship in the heavy swell, and I watched
with some anxiety for any indication of a change of wind to the east,
since a breeze from that quarter would have driven us towards
the land. Worsley and I were on deck all night, dodging the pack.
At 3 a.m. we ran south, taking advantage of some openings that had
appeared, but met heavy rafted pack-ice, evidently old; some of it
had been subjected to severe pressure. Then we steamed north-west
and saw open water to the north-east. I put the Endurance’s head
for the opening, and, steaming at full speed, we got clear. Then
we went east in the hope of getting better ice, and five hours later,
after some dodging, we rounded the pack and were able to set sail
once more. This initial tussle with the pack had been exciting at
times. Pieces of ice and bergs of all sizes were heaving and
jostling against each other in the heavy south-westerly swell.
In spite of all our care the Endurance struck large lumps stem on,
but the engines were stopped in time and no harm was done. The
scene and sounds throughout the day were very fine. The swell
was dashing against the sides of huge bergs and leaping right to
the top of their icy cliffs. Sanders Island lay to the south,
with a few rocky faces peering through the misty, swirling clouds
that swathed it most of the time, the booming of the sea running
into ice-caverns, the swishing break of the swell on the loose pack,
and the graceful bowing and undulating of the inner pack to the
steeply rolling swell, which here was robbed of its break by the
masses of ice to windward.
We skirted the northern edge of the pack in clear weather with a
light south-westerly breeze and an overcast sky. The bergs were
numerous. During the morning of December 9 an easterly breeze
brought hazy weather with snow, and at 4.30 p.m. we encountered
the edge of pack-ice in lat. 58° 27´ S., long.
22° 08´ W. It was one-year-old ice interspersed
with older pack, all heavily snow-covered and lying west-south-west
to east-north-east. We entered the pack at 5 p.m., but could not
make progress, and cleared it again at 7.40 p.m. Then we steered
east-north-east and spent the rest of the night rounding the pack.
During the day we had seen adelie and ringed penguins, also several
humpback and finner whales. An ice-blink to the westward indicated
the presence of pack in that direction. After rounding the pack we
steered S. 40° E., and at noon on the 10th had reached lat.
58° 28´ S., long. 20° 28´ W. Observations
showed the compass variation to be 1½° less than the chart
recorded. I kept the Endurance on the course till midnight,
when we entered loose open ice about ninety miles south-east of our
noon position. This ice proved to fringe the pack, and progress
became slow. There was a long easterly swell with a light northerly
breeze, and the weather was clear and fine. Numerous bergs lay
outside the pack.
The Endurance steamed through loose open ice till 8 a.m. on the
11th, when we entered the pack in lat. 59° 46´ S.,
long. 18° 22´ W. We could have gone farther east,
but the pack extended far in that direction, and an effort to circle
it might have involved a lot of northing. I did not wish to lose
the benefit of the original southing. The extra miles would not have
mattered to a ship with larger coal capacity than the Endurance
possessed, but we could not afford to sacrifice miles unnecessarily.
The pack was loose and did not present great difficulties at this
stage. The foresail was set in order to take advantage of the
northerly breeze. The ship was in contact with the ice occasionally
and received some heavy blows. Once or twice she was brought up
all standing against solid pieces, but no harm was done. The chief
concern was to protect the propeller and rudder. If a collision
seemed to be inevitable the officer in charge would order “slow”
or “half speed” with the engines, and put the helm over so as to
strike floe a glancing blow. Then the helm would be put over towards
the ice with the object of throwing the propeller clear of it, and
the ship would forge ahead again. Worsley, Wild, and I, with three
officers, kept three watches while we were working through the
pack, so that we had two officers on deck all the time. The
carpenter had rigged a six-foot wooden semaphore on the bridge to
enable the navigating officer to give the seamen or scientists at
the wheel the direction and the exact amount of helm required.
This device saved time, as well as the effort of shouting. We were
pushing through this loose pack all day, and the view from the crow’s-nest
gave no promise of improved conditions ahead. A Weddell seal
and a crab-eater seal were noticed on the floes, but we did not
pause to secure fresh meat. It was important that we should make
progress towards our goal as rapidly as possible, and there was
reason to fear that we should have plenty of time to spare later
on if the ice conditions continued to increase in severity.
On the morning of December 12 we were working through loose pack
which later became thick in places. The sky was overcast and
light snow was falling. I had all square sail set at 7 a.m. in
order to take advantage of the northerly breeze, but it had to
come in again five hours later when the wind hauled round to the
west. The noon position was lat. 60° 26´ S., long.
17° 58´ W., and the run for the twenty-four hours
had been only 33 miles. The ice was still badly congested, and
we were pushing through narrow leads and occasional openings with
the floes often close abeam on either side. Antarctic, snow and
stormy petrels, fulmars, white-rumped terns, and adelies were
around us. The quaint little penguins found the ship a cause
of much apparent excitement and provided a lot of amusement aboard.
One of the standing jokes was that all the adelies on the floe
seemed to know Clark, and when he was at the wheel rushed along
as fast as their legs could carry them, yelling out “Clark! Clark!”
and apparently very indignant and perturbed that he never waited
for them or even answered them.
We found several good leads to the south in the evening, and
continued to work southward throughout the night and the following
day. The pack extended in all directions as far as the eye could
reach. The noon observation showed the run for the twenty-four
hours to be 54 miles, a satisfactory result under the conditions.
Wild shot a young Ross seal on the floe, and we manoeuvred the ship
alongside. Hudson jumped down, bent a line on to the seal, and the
pair of them were hauled up. The seal was 4 ft. 9 in. long and
weighed about ninety pounds. He was a young male and proved very
good eating, but when dressed and minus the blubber made little
more than a square meal for our twenty-eight men, with a few scraps
for our breakfast and tea. The stomach contained only amphipods
about an inch long, allied to those found in the whales at
Grytviken.
The conditions became harder on December 14. There was a misty
haze, and occasional falls of snow. A few bergs were in sight.
The pack was denser than it had been on the previous days. Older
ice was intermingled with the young ice, and our progress became
slower. The propeller received several blows in the early
morning, but no damage was done. A platform was rigged under the
jib-boom in order that Hurley might secure some kinematograph
pictures of the ship breaking through the ice. The young ice did
not present difficulties to the Endurance, which was able to smash
a way through, but the lumps of older ice were more formidable
obstacles, and conning the ship was a task requiring close
attention. The most careful navigation could not prevent an
occasional bump against ice too thick to be broken or pushed aside.
The southerly breeze strengthened to a moderate south-westerly
gale during the afternoon, and at 8 p.m. we hove to, stem against
a floe, it being impossible to proceed without serious risk of
damage to rudder or propeller. I was interested to notice that,
although we had been steaming through the pack for three days,
the north-westerly swell still held with us. It added to the
difficulties of navigation in the lanes, since the ice was
constantly in movement.
The Endurance remained against the floe for the next twenty-four
hours, when the gale moderated. The pack extended to the horizon
in all directions and was broken by innumerable narrow lanes.
Many bergs were in sight, and they appeared to be travelling
through the pack in a south-westerly direction under the current
influence. Probably the pack itself was moving north-east with
the gale. Clark put down a net in search of specimens, and at
two fathoms it was carried south-west by the current and fouled
the propeller. He lost the net, two leads, and a line. Ten
bergs drove to the south through the pack during the twenty-four
hours. The noon position was 61° 31´ S., long.
18° 12´ W. The gale had moderated at 8 p.m., and
we made five miles to the south before midnight and then we
stopped at the end of a long lead, waiting till the weather cleared.
It was during this short run that the captain, with semaphore
hard-a-port, shouted to the scientist at the wheel: “Why in
Paradise don’t you port!” The answer came in indignant tones:
“I am blowing my nose.”
The Endurance made some progress on the following day. Long
leads of open water ran towards the south-west, and the ship
smashed at full speed through occasional areas of young ice till
brought up with a heavy thud against a section of older floe.
Worsley was out on the jib-boom end for a few minutes while Wild
was conning the ship, and he came back with a glowing account of
a novel sensation. The boom was swinging high and low and from
side to side, while the massive bows of the ship smashed through
the ice, splitting it across, piling it mass on mass and then
shouldering it aside. The air temperature was 37° Fahr.,
pleasantly warm, and the water temperature 29° Fahr. We
continued to advance through fine long leads till 4 a.m. on
December 17, when the ice became difficult again. Very large
floes of six-months-old ice lay close together. Some of these
floes presented a square mile of unbroken surface, and among
them were patches of thin ice and several floes of heavy old ice.
Many bergs were in sight, and the course became devious. The
ship was blocked at one point by a wedge-shaped piece of floe,
but we put the ice-anchor through it, towed it astern, and
proceeded through the gap. Steering under these conditions
required muscle as well as nerve. There was a clatter aft during
the afternoon, and Hussey, who was at the wheel, explained that
“The wheel spun round and threw me over the top of it!” The noon
position was lat. 62° 13´ S., long. 18°
53´ W., and the run for the preceding twenty-four hours had
been 32 miles in a south-westerly direction. We saw three blue
whales during the day and one emperor penguin, a 58-lb. bird, which
was added to the larder.
The morning of December 18 found the Endurance proceeding amongst
large floes with thin ice between them. The leads were few. There
was a northerly breeze with occasional snow-flurries. We secured
three crab-eater seals—two cows and a bull. The bull was a fine
specimen, nearly white all over and 9 ft. 3 in. long; he weighed
600 lbs. Shortly before noon further progress was barred by heavy
pack, and we put an ice-anchor on the floe and banked the fires.
I had been prepared for evil conditions in the Weddell Sea, but had
hoped that in December and January, at any rate, the pack would be
loose, even if no open water was to be found. What we were actually
encountering was fairly dense pack of a very obstinate character.
Pack-ice might be described as a gigantic and interminable jigsaw-puzzle
devised by nature. The parts of the puzzle in loose pack
have floated slightly apart and become disarranged; at numerous
places they have pressed together again; as the pack gets closer
the congested areas grow larger and the parts are jammed harder
till finally it becomes “close pack,” when the whole of the jigsaw-puzzle
becomes jammed to such an extent that with care and labour
it can be traversed in every direction on foot. Where the parts
do not fit closely there is, of course, open water, which freezes
over, in a few hours after giving off volumes of “frost-smoke.”
In obedience to renewed pressure this young ice “rafts,” so
forming double thicknesses of a toffee-like consistency. Again
the opposing edges of heavy floes rear up in slow and almost silent
conflict, till high “hedgerows” are formed round each part of the
puzzle. At the junction of several floes chaotic areas of piled-up
blocks and masses of ice are formed. Sometimes 5-ft. to 6-ft. piles
of evenly shaped blocks of ice are seen so neatly laid that it seems
impossible for them to be Nature’s work. Again, a winding canyon
may be traversed between icy walls 6 ft. to 10 ft. high, or a dome
may be formed that under renewed pressure bursts upward like a
volcano. All the winter the drifting pack changes—grows by
freezing, thickens by rafting, and corrugates by pressure. If,
finally, in its drift it impinges on a coast, such as the western
shore of the Weddell Sea, terrific pressure is set up and an inferno
of ice-blocks, ridges, and hedgerows results, extending possibly for
150 or 200 miles off shore. Sections of pressure ice may drift
away subsequently and become embedded in new ice.
I have given this brief explanation here in order that the reader
may understand the nature of the ice through which we pushed our
way for many hundreds of miles. Another point that may require
to be explained was the delay caused by wind while we were in the
pack. When a strong breeze or moderate gale was blowing the ship
could not safely work through any except young ice, up to about
two feet in thickness. As ice of that nature never extended for
more than a mile or so, it followed that in a gale in the pack we
had always to lie to. The ship was 3 ft. 3 in. down by the stern,
and while this saved the propeller and rudder a good deal, it made
the Endurance practically unmanageable in close pack when the wind
attained a force of six miles an hour from ahead, since the air
currents had such a big surface forward to act upon. The pressure
of wind on bows and the yards of the foremast would cause the bows
to fall away, and in these conditions the ship could not be steered
into the narrow lanes and leads through which we had to thread our
way. The falling away of the bows, moreover, would tend to bring
the stern against the ice, compelling us to stop the engines in
order to save the propeller. Then the ship would become unmanageable
and drift away, with the possibility of getting excessive sternway
on her and so damaging rudder or propeller, the Achilles’ heel of a
ship in pack-ice.
While we were waiting for the weather to moderate and the ice to
open, I had the Lucas sounding-machine rigged over the rudder-trunk
and found the depth to be 2810 fathoms. The bottom sample was lost
owing to the line parting 60 fathoms from the end. During the
afternoon three adelie penguins approached the ship across the floe
while Hussey was discoursing sweet music on the banjo. The
solemn-looking little birds appeared to appreciate “It’s a Long
Way to Tipperary,” but they fled in horror when Hussey treated
them to a little of the music that comes from Scotland. The shouts
of laughter from the ship added to their dismay, and they made off
as fast as their short legs would carry them. The pack opened
slightly at 6.15 p.m., and we proceeded through lanes for three
hours before being forced to anchor to a floe for the night. We
fired a Hjort mark harpoon, No. 171, into a blue whale on this
day. The conditions did not improve during December 19. A fresh
to strong northerly breeze brought haze and snow, and after
proceeding for two hours the Endurance was stopped again by
heavy floes. It was impossible to manoeuvre the ship in the ice
owing to the strong wind, which kept the floes in movement and
caused lanes to open and close with dangerous rapidity. The noon
observation showed that we had made six miles to the south-east in
the previous twenty-four hours. All hands were engaged during the
day in rubbing shoots off our potatoes, which were found to be
sprouting freely. We remained moored to a floe over the following
day, the wind not having moderated; indeed, it freshened to a gale
in the afternoon, and the members of the staff and crew took
advantage of the pause to enjoy a vigorously contested game of
football on the level surface of the floe alongside the ship.
Twelve bergs were in sight at this time. The noon position was
lat. 62° 42´ S., long. 17° 54´ W.,
showing that we had drifted about six miles in a north-easterly
direction.
Monday, December 21, was beautifully fine, with a gentle west-north-westerly
breeze. We made a start at 3 a.m. and proceeded
through the pack in a south-westerly direction. At noon we had
gained seven miles almost due east, the northerly drift of the
pack having continued while the ship was apparently moving to
the south. Petrels of several species, penguins, and seals were
plentiful, and we saw four small blue whales. At noon we entered
a long lead to the southward and passed around and between nine
splendid bergs. One mighty specimen was shaped like the Rock of
Gibraltar but with steeper cliffs, and another had a natural dock
that would have contained the Aquitania. A spur of ice closed
the entrance to the huge blue pool. Hurley brought out his
kinematograph-camera, in order to make a record of these bergs.
Fine long leads running east and south-east among bergs were found
during the afternoon, but at midnight the ship was stopped by
small, heavy ice-floes, tightly packed against an unbroken plain
of ice. The outlook from the mast-head was not encouraging.
The big floe was at least 15 miles long and 10 miles wide.
The edge could not be seen at the widest part, and the area of
the floe must have been not less than 150 square miles. It
appeared to be formed of year-old ice, not very thick and with
very few hummocks or ridges in it. We thought it must have been
formed at sea in very calm weather and drifted up from the south-east.
I had never seen such a large area of unbroken ice in
the Ross Sea.
We waited with banked fires for the strong easterly breeze to
moderate or the pack to open. At 6.30 p.m. on December 22 some
lanes opened and we were able to move towards the south again.
The following morning found us working slowly through the pack,
and the noon observation gave us a gain of 19 miles S. 41°
W. for the seventeen and a half hours under steam. Many year-old
adelies, three crab-eaters, six sea-leopards, one Weddell and two
blue whales were seen. The air temperature, which had been down
to 25° Fahr. on December 21, had risen to 34° Fahr.
While we were working along leads to the southward in the afternoon,
we counted fifteen bergs. Three of these were table-topped, and
one was about 70 ft high and 5 miles long. Evidently it had come
from a barrier-edge. The ice became heavier but slightly more open,
and we had a calm night with fine long leads of open water. The
water was so still that new ice was forming on the leads. We had
a run of 70 miles to our credit at noon on December 24, the position
being lat. 64° 32´ S., long. 17° 17´ W.
All the dogs except eight had been named. I do not know who had
been responsible for some of the names, which seemed to represent
a variety of tastes. They were as follows Rugby, Upton Bristol,
Millhill, Songster, Sandy, Mack, Mercury, Wolf, Amundsen, Hercules,
Hackenschmidt, Samson, Sammy, Skipper, Caruso, Sub, Ulysses, Spotty,
Bosun, Slobbers, Sadie, Sue, Sally, Jasper, Tim, Sweep, Martin,
Splitlip, Luke, Saint, Satan, Chips, Stumps, Snapper, Painful, Bob,
Snowball, Jerry, Judge, Sooty, Rufus, Sidelights, Simeon, Swanker,
Chirgwin, Steamer, Peter, Fluffy, Steward, Slippery, Elliott, Roy,
Noel, Shakespeare, Jamie, Bummer, Smuts, Lupoid, Spider, and Sailor.
Some of the names, it will be noticed, had a descriptive flavour.
Heavy floes held up the ship from midnight till 6 a.m. on
December 25, Christmas Day. Then they opened a little and we made
progress till 11.30 a.m., when the leads closed again. We had
encountered good leads and workable ice during the early part of the
night, and the noon observation showed that our run for the twenty-four
hours was the best since we entered the pack a fortnight earlier.
We had made 71 miles S. 4° W. The ice held us up till the
evening, and then we were able to follow some leads for a couple of
hours before the tightly packed floes and the increasing wind
compelled a stop. The celebration of Christmas was not forgotten.
Grog was served at midnight to all on deck. There was grog again
at breakfast, for the benefit of those who had been in their bunks
at midnight. Lees had decorated the wardroom with flags and had a
little Christmas present for each of us. Some of us had presents
from home to open. Later there was a really splendid dinner,
consisting of turtle soup, whitebait, jugged hare, Christmas pudding,
mince-pies, dates, figs and crystallized fruits, with rum and stout
as drinks. In the evening everybody joined in a “sing-song.”
Hussey had made a one-stringed violin, on which, in the words of
Worsley, he “discoursed quite painlessly.” The wind was
increasing to a moderate south-easterly gale and no advance could
be made, so we were able to settle down to the enjoyments of
the evening.
The weather was still bad on December 26 and 27, and the Endurance
remained anchored to a floe. The noon position on the 26th was
lat. 65° 43´ S., long. 17° 36´ W.
We made another sounding on this day with the Lucas machine and
found bottom at 2819 fathoms. The specimen brought up was a
terrigenous blue mud (glacial deposit) with some radiolaria.
Every one took turns at the work of heaving in, two men working
together in ten-minute spells.
Sunday, December 27, was a quiet day aboard. The southerly gale
was blowing the snow in clouds off the floe and the temperature had
fallen to 23° Fahr. The dogs were having an uncomfortable
time in their deck quarters. The wind had moderated by the
following morning, but it was squally with snow-flurries, and I
did not order a start till 11 p.m. The pack was still close, but
the ice was softer and more easily broken. During the pause the
carpenter had rigged a small stage over the stern. A man was
stationed there to watch the propeller and prevent it striking
heavy ice, and the arrangement proved very valuable. It saved the
rudder as well as the propeller from many blows.
The high winds that had prevailed for four and a half days gave way
to a gentle southerly breeze in the evening of December 29. Owing
to the drift we were actually eleven miles farther north than we
had been on December 25. But we made fairly good progress on the
30th in fine, clear weather. The ship followed a long lead to the
south-east during the afternoon and evening, and at 11 p.m. we
crossed the Antarctic Circle. An examination of the horizon
disclosed considerable breaks in the vast circle of pack-ice,
interspersed with bergs of different sizes. Leads could be traced
in various directions, but I looked in vain for an indication of
open water. The sun did not set that night, and as it was
concealed behind a bank of clouds we had a glow of crimson and gold
to the southward, with delicate pale green reflections in the water
of the lanes to the south-east.
The ship had a serious encounter with the ice on the morning of
December 31. We were stopped first by floes closing around us,
and then about noon the Endurance got jammed between two floes
heading east-north-east. The pressure heeled the ship over six
degrees while we were getting an ice-anchor on to the floe in order
to heave astern and thus assist the engines, which were running at
full speed. The effort was successful. Immediately afterwards,
at the spot where the Endurance had been held, slabs of ice 50 ft.
by 15 ft. and 4 ft. thick were forced ten or twelve feet up on
the lee floe at an angle of 45°. The pressure was severe,
and we were not sorry to have the ship out of its reach. The noon
position was lat. 66° 47´ S., long. 15° 52´ W.,
and the run for the preceding twenty-four hours was
51 miles S. 29° E.
“Since noon the character of the pack has improved,” wrote Worsley
on this day. “Though the leads are short, the floes are rotten
and easily broken through if a good place is selected with care
and judgment. In many cases we find large sheets of young ice
through which the ship cuts for a mile or two miles at a stretch.
I have been conning and working the ship from the crow’s-nest
and find it much the best place, as from there one can see ahead
and work out the course beforehand, and can also guard the rudder
and propeller, the most vulnerable parts of a ship in the ice.
At midnight, as I was sitting in the ‘tub’ I heard a clamorous
noise down on the deck, with ringing of bells, and realized that
it was the New Year.” Worsley came down from his lofty seat and
met Wild, Hudson, and myself on the bridge, where we shook hands
and wished one another a happy and successful New Year. Since
entering the pack on December 11 we had come 480 miles, through
loose and close pack-ice. We had pushed and fought the little ship
through, and she had stood the test well, though the propeller had
received some shrewd blows against hard ice and the vessel had been
driven against the floe until she had fairly mounted up on it and
slid back rolling heavily from side to side. The rolling had been
more frequently caused by the operation of cracking through thickish
young ice, where the crack had taken a sinuous course. The ship,
in attempting to follow it, struck first one bilge and then the
other, causing her to roll six or seven degrees. Our advance through
the pack had been in a S. 10° E. direction, and I estimated
that the total steaming distance had exceeded 700 miles. The first
100 miles had been through loose pack, but the greatest hindrances
had been three moderate south-westerly gales, two lasting for three
days each and one for four and a half days. The last 250 miles had
been through close pack alternating with fine long leads and
stretches of open water.
During the weeks we spent manoeuvring to the south through the
tortuous mazes of the pack it was necessary often to split floes
by driving the ship against them. This form of attack was effective
against ice up to three feet in thickness, and the process is
interesting enough to be worth describing briefly. When the way
was barred by a floe of moderate thickness we would drive the ship
at half speed against it, stopping the engines just before the
impact. At the first blow the Endurance would cut a V-shaped
nick in the face of the floe, the slope of her cutwater often causing
her bows to rise till nearly clear of the water, when she would
slide backwards, rolling slightly. Watching carefully that loose
lumps of ice did not damage the propeller, we would reverse the
engines and back the ship off 200 to 300 yds. She would then be
driven full speed into the V, taking care to hit the centre
accurately. The operation would be repeated until a short dock was
cut, into which the ship, acting as a large wedge, was driven. At
about the fourth attempt, if it was to succeed at all, the floe
would yield. A black, sinuous line, as though pen-drawn on white
paper, would appear ahead, broadening as the eye traced it back to
the ship. Presently it would be broad enough to receive her, and
we would forge ahead. Under the bows and alongside, great slabs
of ice were being turned over and slid back on the floe, or driven
down and under the ice or ship. In thus way the Endurance would
split a 2-ft. to 3-ft. floe a square mile in extent. Occasionally
the floe, although cracked across, would be so held by other floes
that it would refuse to open wide, and so gradually would bring the
ship to a standstill. We would then go astern for some distance
and again drive her full speed into the crack, till finally the floe
would yield to the repeated onslaughts.
NEW LAND
The first day of the New Year (January 1, 1915) was cloudy, with
a gentle northerly breeze and occasional snow-squalls. The condition
of the pack improved in the evening, and after 8 p.m. we forged ahead
rapidly through brittle young ice, easily broken by the ship. A
few hours later a moderate gale came up from the east, with
continuous snow. After 4 a.m. on the 2nd we got into thick old
pack-ice, showing signs of heavy pressure. It was much hummocked,
but large areas of open water and long leads to the south-west
continued until noon. The position then was lat. 69° 49´
S., long. 15° 42´ W., and the run for the
twenty-four hours had been 124 miles S. 3° W. This was
cheering.
The heavy pack blocked the way south after midday. It would have
been almost impossible to have pushed the ship into the ice, and
in any case the gale would have made such a proceeding highly
dangerous. So we dodged along to the west and north, looking for
a suitable opening towards the south. The good run had given me
hope of sighting the land on the following day, and the delay was
annoying. I was growing anxious to reach land on account of the
dogs, which had not been able to get exercise for four weeks, and
were becoming run down. We passed at least two hundred bergs
during the day, and we noticed also large masses of hummocky bay-ice
and ice-foot. One floe of bay-ice had black earth upon it,
apparently basaltic in origin, and there was a large berg with a
broad band of yellowish brown right through it. The stain may
have been volcanic dust. Many of the bergs had quaint shapes.
There was one that exactly resembled a large two-funnel liner,
complete in silhouette except for smoke. Later in the day we
found an opening in the pack and made 9 miles to the south-west,
but at 2 a.m. on January 3 the lead ended in hummocky ice,
impossible to penetrate. A moderate easterly gale had come up
with snow-squalls, and we could not get a clear view in any
direction. The hummocky ice did not offer a suitable anchorage
for the ship, and we were compelled to dodge up and down for
ten hours before we were able to make fast to a small floe under
the lee of a berg 120 ft. high. The berg broke the wind and
saved us drifting fast to leeward. The position was lat. 69°
59´ S., long. 17° 31´ W. We made a
move again at 7 p.m., when we took in the ice-anchor and proceeded
south, and at 10 p.m. we passed a small berg that the ship had
nearly touched twelve hours previously. Obviously we were not
making much headway. Several of the bergs passed during this day
were of solid blue ice, indicating true glacier origin.
By midnight of the 3rd we had made 11 miles to the south, and
then came to a full stop in weather so thick with snow that we
could not learn if the leads and lanes were worth entering.
The ice was hummocky, but, fortunately, the gale was decreasing,
and after we had scanned all the leads and pools within our reach
we turned back to the north-east. Two sperm and two large blue
whales were sighted, the first we had seen for 260 miles. We saw
also petrels, numerous adelies, emperors, crab-eaters, and sea-leopards.
The clearer weather of the morning showed us that the
pack was solid and impassable from the south-east to the south-west,
and at 10 a.m. on the 4th we again passed within five yards of
the small berg that we had passed twice on the previous day. We had
been steaming and dodging about over an area of twenty square miles
for fifty hours, trying to find an opening to the south, south-east,
or south-west, but all the leads ran north, north-east, or north-west.
It was as though the spirits of the Antarctic were pointing us to
the backward track—the track we were determined not to follow.
Our desire was to make easting as well as southing so as to reach
the land, if possible, east of Ross’s farthest South and well east
of Coats’ Land. This was more important as the prevailing winds
appeared to be to easterly, and every mile of easting would count.
In the afternoon we went west in some open water, and by 4 p.m.
we were making west-south-west with more water opening up ahead.
The sun was shining brightly, over three degrees high at midnight,
and we were able to maintain this direction in fine weather till
the following noon. The position then was lat. 70° 28´
S., long. 20° 16´ W., and the run had been 62 miles S.
62° W. At 8 a.m. there had been open water from north round
by west to south-west, but impenetrable pack to the south and east.
At 3 p.m. the way to the south-west and west-north-west was
absolutely blocked, and as we experienced a set to the west, I did
not feel justified in burning more of the reduced stock of coal to
go west or north. I took the ship back over our course for four
miles, to a point where some looser pack gave faint promise of a
way through; but, after battling for three hours with very heavy
hummocked ice and making four miles to the south, we were brought
up by huge blocks and floes of very old pack. Further effort
seemed useless at that time, and I gave the order to bank fires
after we had moored the Endurance to a solid floe. The weather
was clear, and some enthusiastic football-players had a game on
the floe until, about midnight, Worsley dropped through a hole
in rotten ice while retrieving the ball. He had to be retrieved
himself.
Solid pack still barred the way to the south on the following
morning (January 6). There was some open water north of the floe,
but as the day was calm and I did not wish to use coal in a
possibly vain search for an opening to the southward, I kept
the ship moored to the floe. This pause in good weather gave an
opportunity to exercise the dogs, which were taken on to the
floe by the men in charge of them. The excitement of the
animals was intense. Several managed to get into the water,
and the muzzles they were wearing did not prevent some hot fights.
Two dogs which had contrived to slip their muzzles fought
themselves into an icy pool and were hauled out still locked in a
grapple. However, men and dogs enjoyed the exercise. A sounding
gave a depth of 2400 fathoms, with a blue mud bottom. The wind
freshened from the west early the next morning, and we started to
skirt the northern edge of the solid pack in an easterly direction
under sail. We had cleared the close pack by noon, but the outlook
to the south gave small promise of useful progress, and I was anxious
now to make easting. We went north-east under sail, and after making
thirty-nine miles passed a peculiar berg that we had been abreast
of sixty hours earlier. Killer-whales were becoming active around
us, and I had to exercise caution in allowing any one to leave the
ship. These beasts have a habit of locating a resting seal by
looking over the edge of a floe and then striking through the ice
from below in search of a meal; they would not distinguish between
seal and man.
The noon position on January 8 was lat. 70° 0´ S.,
long. 19° 09´ W. We had made 66 miles in a north-easterly
direction during the preceding twenty-four hours. The
course during the afternoon was east-south-east through loose pack
and open water, with deep hummocky floes to the south. Several
leads to the south came in view, but we held on the easterly course.
The floes were becoming looser, and there were indications of open
water ahead. The ship passed not fewer than five hundred bergs
that day, some of them very large. A dark water-sky extended
from east to south-south-east on the following morning, and the
Endurance, working through loose pack at half speed, reached open
water just before noon. A rampart berg 150 ft. high and a quarter
of a mile long lay at the edge of the loose pack, and we sailed
over a projecting foot of this berg into rolling ocean, stretching
to the horizon. The sea extended from a little to the west of
south, round by east to north-north-east, and its welcome promise
was supported by a deep water-sky to the south. I laid a course
south by east in an endeavour to get south and east of Ross’s
farthest south (lat. 71° 30´ S.).
We kept the open water for a hundred miles, passing many bergs but
encountering no pack. Two very large whales, probably blue
whales, came up close to the ship, and we saw spouts in all
directions. Open water inside the pack in that latitude might have
the appeal of sanctuary to the whales, which are harried by man
farther north. The run southward in blue water, with a path
clear ahead and the miles falling away behind us, was a joyful
experience after the long struggle through the ice-lanes. But,
like other good things, our spell of free movement had to end.
The Endurance encountered the ice again at 1 a.m. on the 10th.
Loose pack stretched to east and south, with open water to the west
and a good watersky. It consisted partly of heavy hummocky ice
showing evidence of great pressure, but contained also many thick,
flat floes evidently formed in some sheltered bay and never
subjected to pressure or to much motion. The swirl of the ship’s
wash brought diatomaceous scum from the sides of this ice. The
water became thick with diatoms at 9 a.m., and I ordered a cast
to be made. No bottom was found at 210 fathoms. The Endurance
continued to advance southward through loose pack that morning.
We saw the spouts of numerous whales and noticed some hundreds
of crab-eaters lying on the floes. White-rumped terns, Antarctic
petrels and snow petrels were numerous, and there was a colony of
adelies on a low berg. A few killer-whales, with their characteristic
high dorsal fin, also came in view. The noon position was lat.
72° 02´ S., long. 16° 07´ W., and the run
for the twenty-four hours had been 136 miles S. 6° E.
We were now in the vicinity of the land discovered by Dr. W. S.
Bruce, leader of the Scotia Expedition, in 1904, and named by him
Coats’ Land. Dr. Bruce encountered an ice-barrier in lat. 72°
18´ S., long. 10° W., stretching from north-east to
south-west. He followed the barrier-edge to the south-west for
150 miles and reached lat. 74° 1´ S., long. 22° W.
He saw no naked rock, but his description of rising slopes of snow
and ice, with shoaling water off the barrier-wall, indicated clearly
the presence of land. It was up those slopes, at a point as far
south as possible, that I planned to begin the march across the
Antarctic continent. All hands were watching now for the coast
described by Dr. Bruce, and at 5 p.m. the look-out reported an
appearance of land to the south-south-east. We could see a gentle
snow-slope rising to a height of about one thousand feet. It seemed
to be an island or a peninsula with a sound on its south side,
and the position of its most northerly point was about 72°
34´ S., 16° 40´ W. The Endurance was
passing through heavy loose pack, and shortly before midnight
she broke into a lead of open sea along a barrier-edge. A
sounding within one cable’s length of the barrier-edge gave no
bottom with 210 fathoms of line. The barrier was 70 ft. high,
with cliffs of about 40 ft. The Scotia must have passed this point
when pushing to Bruce’s farthest south on March 6, 1904, and I knew
from the narrative of that voyage, as well as from our own
observation, that the coast trended away to the south-west. The
lead of open water continued along the barrier-edge, and we pushed
forward without delay.
An easterly breeze brought cloud and falls of snow during the
morning of January 11. The barrier trended south-west by south,
and we skirted it for fifty miles until 11 am. The cliffs in the
morning were 20 ft. high, and by noon they had increased to 110
and 115 ft. The brow apparently rose 20 to 30 ft. higher. We
were forced away from the barrier once for three hours by a line
of very heavy pack-ice. Otherwise there was open water along the
edge, with high loose pack to the west and north-west. We noticed
a seal bobbing up and down in an apparent effort to swallow a
long silvery fish that projected at least eighteen inches from its
mouth. The noon position was lat. 73° 13´ S., long.
20° 43´ W., and a sounding then gave 155 fathoms at
a distance of a mile from the barrier. The bottom consisted of
large igneous pebbles. The weather then became thick, and I held
away to the westward, where the sky had given indications of open
water, until 7 p.m., when we laid the ship alongside a floe in
loose pack. Heavy snow was falling, and I was anxious lest the
westerly wind should bring the pack hard against the coast and
jam the ship. The Nimrod had a narrow escape from a misadventure
of this kind in the Ross Sea early in 1908.
We made a start again at 5 a.m. the next morning (January 12) in
overcast weather with mist and snow-showers, and four hours later
broke through loose pack-ice into open water. The view was
obscured, but we proceeded to the south-east and had gained 24
miles by noon, when three soundings in lat. 74° 4´ S.,
long. 22° 48´ W. gave 95, 128, and 103 fathoms, with
a bottom of sand, pebbles, and mud. Clark got a good haul of
biological specimens in the dredge. The Endurance was now close
to what appeared to be the barrier, with a heavy pack-ice foot
containing numerous bergs frozen in and possibly aground. The
solid ice turned away towards the north-west, and we followed the
edge for 48 miles N. 60° W. to clear it.
Now we were beyond the point reached by the Scotia, and the land
underlying the ice-sheet we were skirting was new. The northerly
trend was unexpected, and I began to suspect that we were really
rounding a huge ice-tongue attached to the true barrier-edge and
extending northward. Events confirmed this suspicion. We skirted
the pack all night, steering north-west; then went west by north
till 4 a.m. and round to south-west. The course at 8 a.m. on
the 13th was south-south-west. The barrier at midnight was low and
distant, and at 8 a.m. there was merely a narrow ice-foot about
two hundred yards across separating it from the open water. By
noon there was only an occasional shelf of ice-foot. The barrier
in one place came with an easy sweep to the sea. We could have
landed stores there without difficulty. We made a sounding 400
ft. off the barrier but got no bottom at 676 fathoms. At 4 p.m.,
still following the barrier to the south-west, we reached a corner
and found it receding abruptly to the south-east. Our way was
blocked by very heavy pack, and after spending two hours in a
vain search for an opening, we moored the Endurance to a floe and
banked fires. During that day we passed two schools of seals,
swimming fast to the north-west and north-north-east. The animals
swam in close order, rising and blowing like porpoises, and we
wondered if there was any significance in their journey northward
at that time of the year. Several young emperor penguins had
been captured and brought aboard on the previous day. Two of them
were still alive when the Endurance was brought alongside the floe.
They promptly hopped on to the ice, turned round, bowed gracefully
three times, and retired to the far side of the floe. There is
something curiously human about the manners and movements of these
birds. I was concerned about the dogs. They were losing condition
and some of them appeared to be ailing. One dog had to be shot on
the 12th. We did not move the ship on the 14th. A breeze came
from the east in the evening, and under its influence the pack began
to work off shore. Before midnight the close ice that had barred
our way had opened and left a lane along the foot of the barrier.
I decided to wait for the morning, not wishing to risk getting caught
between the barrier and the pack in the event of the wind changing.
A sounding gave 1357 fathoms, with a bottom of glacial mud. The
noon observation showed the position to be lat. 74° 09´
S., long. 27° 16´ W. We cast off at 6 a.m. on the 15th
in hazy weather with a north-easterly breeze, and proceeded along
the barrier in open water. The course was south-east for sixteen
miles, then south-south-east. We now had solid pack to windward,
and at 3 p.m. we passed a bight probably ten miles deep and running
to the north-east. A similar bight appeared at 6 p.m. These deep
cuts strengthened the impression we had already formed that for
several days we had been rounding a great mass of ice, at least
fifty miles across, stretching out from the coast and possibly
destined to float away at some time in the future. The soundings—roughly,
200 fathoms at the landward side and 1300 fathoms at the
seaward side—suggested that this mighty projection was afloat.
Seals were plentiful. We saw large numbers on the pack and several
on low parts of the barrier, where the slope was easy. The ship
passed through large schools of seals swimming from the barrier
to the pack off shore. The animals were splashing and blowing
around the Endurance, and Hurley made a record of this unusual
sight with the kinematograph-camera.
The barrier now stretched to the south-west again. Sail was set to
a fresh easterly breeze, but at 7 p.m. it had to be furled, the
Endurance being held up by pack-ice against the barrier for an
hour. We took advantage of the pause to sound and got 268 fathoms
with glacial mud and pebbles. Then a small lane appeared ahead.
We pushed through at full speed, and by 8.30 p.m. the Endurance
was moving southward with sails set in a fine expanse of open
water. We continued to skirt the barrier in clear weather. I was
watching for possible landing-places, though as a matter of fact I
had no intention of landing north of Vahsel Bay, in Luitpold Land,
except under pressure of necessity. Every mile gained towards the
south meant a mile less sledging when the time came for the
overland journey.
Shortly before midnight on the 15th we came abreast of the
northern edge of a great glacier or overflow from the inland ice,
projecting beyond the barrier into the sea. It was 400 or 500 ft.
high, and at its edge was a large mass of thick bay-ice. The bay
formed by the northern edge of this glacier would have made an
excellent landing-place. A flat ice-foot nearly three feet above
sea-level looked like a natural quay. From this ice-foot a snow-slope
rose to the top of the barrier. The bay was protected
from the south-easterly wind and was open only to the northerly
wind, which is rare in those latitudes. A sounding gave 80
fathoms, indicating that the glacier was aground. I named the
place Glacier Bay, and had reason later to remember it with regret.
The Endurance steamed along the front of this ice-flow for about
seventeen miles. The glacier showed huge crevasses and high
pressure ridges, and appeared to run back to ice-covered slopes or
hills 1000 or 2000 ft. high. Some bays in its front were filled
with smooth ice, dotted with seals and penguins. At 4 a.m. on the
16th we reached the edge of another huge glacial overflow from the
ice-sheet. The ice appeared to be coming over low hills and was
heavily broken. The cliff-face was 250 to 350 ft. high, and the
ice surface two miles inland was probably 2000 ft. high. The
cliff-front showed a tide-mark of about 6 ft., proving that it was
not afloat. We steamed along the front of this tremendous glacier
for 40 miles and then, at 8.30 a.m., we were held up by solid
pack-ice, which appeared to be held by stranded bergs. The depth,
two cables off the barrier-cliff, was 134 fathoms. No further
advance was possible that day, but the noon observation, which gave
the position as lat. 76° 27´ S. long. 28° 51´
W., showed that we had gained 124 miles to the south-west
during the preceding twenty-four hours. The afternoon was not
without incident. The bergs in the neighbourhood were very large,
several being over 200 ft. high, and some of them were firmly
aground, showing tidemarks. A barrier-berg bearing north-west
appeared to be about 25 miles long. We pushed the ship against
a small banded berg, from which Wordie secured several large
lumps of biotite granite. While the Endurance was being held
slow ahead against the berg a loud crack was heard, and the
geologist had to scramble aboard at once. The bands on this
berg were particularly well defined; they were due to morainic
action in the parent glacier. Later in the day the easterly wind
increased to a gale. Fragments of floe drifted past at about two
knots, and the pack to leeward began to break up fast. A low berg
of shallow draught drove down into the grinding pack and, smashing
against two larger stranded bergs, pushed them off the bank. The
three went away together pell-mell. We took shelter under the
lee of a large stranded berg.
A blizzard from the east-north-east prevented us leaving the
shelter of the berg on the following day (Sunday, January 17).
The weather was clear, but the gale drove dense clouds of snow
off the land and obscured the coast-line most of the time.
“The land, seen when the air is clear, appears higher than we
thought it yesterday; probably it rises to 3000 ft. above the
head of the glacier. Caird Coast, as I have named it, connects
Coats’ Land, discovered by Bruce in 1904, with Luitpold Land,
discovered by Filchner in 1912. The northern part is similar in
character to Coats’ Land. It is fronted by an undulating barrier,
the van of a mighty ice-sheet that is being forced outward from
the high interior of the Antarctic Continent and apparently is
sweeping over low hills, plains, and shallow seas as the great
Arctic ice-sheet once pressed over Northern Europe. The barrier
surface, seen from the sea, is of a faint golden brown colour.
It terminates usually in cliffs ranging from 10 to 300 ft. in
height, but in a very few places sweeps down level with the sea.
The cliffs are of dazzling whiteness, with wonderful blue shadows.
Far inland higher slopes can be seen, appearing like dim blue or
faint golden fleecy clouds. These distant slopes have increased
in nearness and clearness as we have come to the south-west, while
the barrier cliffs here are higher and apparently firmer. We are
now close to the junction with Luitpold Land. At this southern end
of the Caird Coast the ice-sheet, undulating over the hidden and
imprisoned land, is bursting down a steep slope in tremendous
glaciers, bristling with ridges and spikes of ice and seamed by
thousands of crevasses. Along the whole length of the coast we
have seen no bare land or rock. Not as much as a solitary nunatak
has appeared to relieve the surface of ice and snow. But the
upward sweep of the ice-slopes towards the horizon and the ridges,
terraces, and crevasses that appear as the ice approaches the sea
tell of the hills and valleys that lie below.”
The Endurance lay under the lee of the stranded berg until 7 a.m.
on January 18. The gale had moderated by that time, and we
proceeded under sail to the south-west through a lane that had
opened along the glacier-front. We skirted the glacier till 9.30
a.m., when it ended in two bays, open to the north-west but
sheltered by stranded bergs to the west. The coast beyond trended
south-south-west with a gentle land-slope.
“The pack now forces us to go west 14 miles, when we break through
a long line of heavy brash mixed with large lumps and ‘growlers’
We do this under the fore-topsail only, the engines being stopped
to protect the propeller. This takes us into open water, where we
make S. 50° W. for 24 miles. Then we again encounter pack
which forces us to the north-west for 10 miles, when we are brought
up by heavy snow-lumps, brash, and large, loose floes. The
character of the pack shows change. The floes are very thick and
are covered by deep snow. The brash between the floes is so thick
and heavy that we cannot push through without a great expenditure of
power, and then for a short distance only. We therefore lie to for
a while to see if the pack opens at all when this north-east wind
ceases.”
Our position on the morning of the 19th was lat. 76° 34´
S., long. 31° 30´ W. The weather was good,
but no advance could be made. The ice had closed around the ship
during the night, and no water could be seen in any direction from
the deck. A few lanes were in sight from the mast-head. We sounded
in 312 fathoms, finding mud, sand, and pebbles. The land showed
faintly to the east. We waited for the conditions to improve, and
the scientists took the opportunity to dredge for biological and
geological specimens. During the night a moderate north-easterly
gale sprang up, and a survey of the position on the 20th showed
that the ship was firmly beset. The ice was packed heavily and
firmly all round the Endurance in every direction as far as the
eye could reach from the masthead. There was nothing to be done
till the conditions changed, and we waited through that day and
the succeeding days with increasing anxiety. The east-north-easterly
gale that had forced us to take shelter behind the stranded
berg on the 16th had veered later to the north-east, and it
continued with varying intensity until the 22nd. Apparently this
wind had crowded the ice into the bight of the Weddell Sea, and
the ship was now drifting south-west with the floes which had
enclosed it. A slight movement of the ice round the ship caused
the rudder to become dangerously jammed on the 21st, and we had
to cut away the ice with ice-chisels, heavy pieces of iron with
6-ft. wooden hafts. We kept steam up in readiness for a move if
the opportunity offered, and the engines running full speed ahead
helped to clear the rudder. Land was in sight to the east and
south about sixteen miles distant on the 22nd. The land-ice
seemed to be faced with ice-cliffs at most points, but here and
there slopes ran down to sea-level. Large crevassed areas in
terraces parallel with the coast showed where the ice was moving
down over foot-hills. The inland ice appeared for the most part
to be undulating, smooth, and easy to march over, but many crevasses
might have been concealed from us by the surface snow or by the
absence of shadows. I thought that the land probably rose to a
height of 5000 ft. forty or fifty miles inland. The accurate
estimation of heights and distances in the Antarctic is always
difficult, owing to the clear air, the confusing monotony of
colouring, and the deceptive effect of mirage and refraction.
The land appeared to increase in height to the southward, where
we saw a line of land or barrier that must have been seventy miles,
and possibly was even more distant.
Sunday, January 24, was a clear sunny day, with gentle easterly
and southerly breezes. No open water could be seen from
the mast-head, but there was a slight water-sky to the west and
north-west. “This is the first time for ten days that the wind
has varied from north-east and east, and on five of these days it
has risen to a gale. Evidently the ice has become firmly packed
in this quarter, and we must wait patiently till a southerly gale
occurs or currents open the ice. We are drifting slowly. The
position to-day was 76° 49´ S., 33° 51´
W. Worsley and James, working on the floe with a Kew magnetometer,
found the variation to be six degrees west.”
Just before midnight a crack developed in the ice five yards wide
and a mile long, fifty yards ahead of the ship. The crack had
widened to a quarter of a mile by 10 a.m. on the 25th, and for three
hours we tried to force the ship into this opening with engines at
full speed ahead and all sails set. The sole effect was to wash
some ice away astern and clear the rudder, and after convincing
myself that the ship was firmly held I abandoned the attempt.
Later in the day Crean and two other men were over the side on a
stage chipping at a large piece of ice that had got under the ship
and appeared to be impeding her movement. The ice broke away
suddenly, shot upward and overturned, pinning Crean between the
stage and the haft of the heavy 11-ft. iron pincher. He was
in danger for a few moments, but we got him clear, suffering merely
from a few bad bruises. The thick iron bar had been bent against
him to an angle of 45 degrees.
The days that followed were uneventful. Moderate breezes from the
east and south-west had no apparent effect upon the ice, and the
ship remained firmly held. On the 27th, the tenth day of
inactivity, I decided to let the fires out. We had been burning
half a ton of coal a day to keep steam in the boilers, and as the
bunkers now contained only 67 tons, representing thirty-three
days’ steaming, we could not afford to continue this expenditure
of fuel. Land still showed to the east and south when the horizon
was clear. The biologist was securing some interesting specimens
with the hand-dredge at various depths. A sounding on the 26th
gave 360 fathoms, and another on the 29th 449 fathoms. The drift
was to the west, and an observation on the 31st (Sunday) showed
that the ship had made eight miles during the week. James and
Hudson rigged the wireless in the hope of hearing the monthly
message from the Falkland Islands. This message would be due
about 3.20 a.m. on the following morning, but James was doubtful
about hearing anything with our small apparatus at a distance of
1630 miles from the dispatching station. We heard nothing, as a
matter of fact, and later efforts were similarly unsuccessful.
The conditions would have been difficult even for a station of
high power.
We were accumulating gradually a stock of seal meat during these
days of waiting. Fresh meat for the dogs was needed, and
seal-steaks and liver made a very welcome change from the ship’s
rations aboard the Endurance. Four crab-eaters and three Weddells,
over a ton of meat for dog and man, fell to our guns on February 2,
and all hands were occupied most of the day getting the carcasses
back to the ship over the rough ice. We rigged three sledges for
man-haulage and brought the seals about two miles, the sledging
parties being guided among the ridges and pools by semaphore from
the crow’s-nest. Two more seals were sighted on the far side of
a big pool, but I did not allow them to be pursued. Some of the
ice was in a treacherous condition, with thin films hiding cracks
and pools, and I did not wish to risk an accident.
A crack about four miles long opened in the floe to the stern of
the ship on the 3rd. The narrow lane in front was still open,
but the prevailing light breezes did not seem likely to produce
any useful movement in the ice. Early on the morning of the 5th
a north-easterly gale sprang up, bringing overcast skies and
thick snow. Soon the pack was opening and closing without much
loosening effect. At noon the ship gave a sudden start and heeled
over three degrees. Immediately afterwards a crack ran from the
bows to the lead ahead and another to the lead astern. I thought
it might be possible to reeve the ship through one of these leads
towards open water, but we could see no water through the thick
snow; and before steam was raised, and while the view was still
obscured, the pack closed again. The northerly gale had given
place to light westerly breezes on the 6th. The pack seemed to be
more solid than ever. It stretched almost unbroken to the horizon
in every direction, and the situation was made worse by very low
temperatures in succeeding days. The temperature was down to zero
on the night of the 7th and was two degrees below zero on the 8th.
This cold spell in midsummer was most unfortunate from our point
of view, since it cemented the pack and tightened the grip of the
ice upon the ship. The slow drift to the south-west continued,
and we caught occasional glimpses of distant uplands on the eastern
horizon. The position on the 7th was lat. 76° 57´ S.,
long. 35° 7´ W. Soundings on the 6th and 8th found
glacial mud at 630 and 529 fathoms.
The Endurance was lying in a pool covered by young ice on the 9th.
The solid floes had loosened their grip on the ship itself, but
they were packed tightly all around. The weather was foggy.
We felt a slight northerly swell coming through the pack, and the
movement gave rise to hope that there was open water near to us.
At 11 a.m. a long crack developed in the pack, running east and
west as far as we could see through the fog, and I ordered steam
to be raised in the hope of being able to break away into this lead.
The effort failed. We could break the young ice in the pool, but
the pack defied us. The attempt was renewed on the 11th, a fine
clear day with blue sky. The temperature was still low, —2°
Fahr. at midnight. After breaking through some young ice the
Endurance became jammed against soft floe. The engines running
full speed astern produced no effect until all hands joined in
“sallying” ship. The dog-kennels amidships made it necessary for
the people to gather aft, where they rushed from side to side in
a mass in the confined space around the wheel. This was a ludicrous
affair, the men falling over one another amid shouts of laughter
without producing much effect on the ship. She remained fast,
while all hands jumped at the word of command, but finally
slid off when the men were stamping hard at the double. We were
now in a position to take advantage of any opening that might
appear. The ice was firm around us, and as there seemed small
chance of making a move that day, I had the motor crawler and
warper put out on the floe for a trial run. The motor worked
most successfully, running at about six miles an hour over slabs
and ridges of ice hidden by a foot or two of soft snow. The
surface was worse than we would expect to face on land or barrier-ice.
The motor warped itself back on a 500-fathom steel wire and
was taken aboard again.
“From the mast-head the mirage is continually giving us false alarms.
Everything wears an aspect of unreality. Icebergs hang upside down
in the sky; the land appears as layers of silvery or golden
cloud. Cloud-banks look like land, icebergs masquerade as islands
or nunataks, and the distant barrier to the south is thrown into
view, although it really is outside our range of vision. Worst of
all is the deceptive appearance of open water, caused by the
refraction of distant water, or by the sun shining at an angle on
a field of smooth snow or the face of ice-cliffs below the
horizon.”
The second half of February produced no important change in our
situation. Early in the morning of the 14th I ordered a good head
of steam on the engines and sent all hands on to the floe with
ice-chisels, prickers, saws, and picks. We worked all day and
throughout most of the next day in a strenuous effort to get the
ship into the lead ahead. The men cut away the young ice before
the bows and pulled it aside with great energy. After twenty-four
hours’ labour we had got the ship a third of the way to the lead.
But about 400 yards of heavy ice, including old rafted pack, still
separated the Endurance from the water, and reluctantly I had
to admit that further effort was useless. Every opening we made
froze up again quickly owing to the unseasonably low temperature.
The young ice was elastic and prevented the ship delivering a strong,
splitting blow to the floe, while at the same time it held the older
ice against any movement. The abandonment of the attack was a great
disappointment to all hands. The men had worked long hours without
thought of rest, and they deserved success. But the task was beyond
our powers. I had not abandoned hope of getting clear, but was
counting now on the possibility of having to spend a winter in the
inhospitable arms of the pack. The sun, which had been above the
horizon for two months, set at midnight on the 17th, and, although
it would not disappear until April, its slanting rays warned us of
the approach of winter. Pools and leads appeared occasionally, but
they froze over very quickly.
We continued to accumulate a supply of seal meat and blubber,
and the excursions across the floes to shoot and bring in the seals
provided welcome exercise for all hands. Three crab-eater cows
shot on the 21st were not accompanied by a bull, and blood was to
be seen about the hole from which they had crawled. We surmised
that the bull had become the prey of one of the killer-whales.
These aggressive creatures were to be seen often in the lanes and
pools, and we were always distrustful of their ability or
willingness to discriminate between seal and man. A lizard-like
head would show while the killer gazed along the floe with wicked
eyes. Then the brute would dive, to come up a few moments later,
perhaps, under some unfortunate seal reposing on the ice. Worsley
examined a spot where a killer had smashed a hole 8 ft. by 12 ft.
in 12½ in. of hard ice, covered by 2½ in. of snow. Big blocks of
ice had been tossed on to the floe surface. Wordie, engaged in
measuring the thickness of young ice, went through to his waist one
day just as a killer rose to blow in the adjacent lead. His
companions pulled him out hurriedly.
On the 22nd the Endurance reached the farthest south point of her
drift, touching the 77th parallel of latitude in long. 35° W.
The summer had gone; indeed the summer had scarcely been with us at
all. The temperatures were low day and night, and the pack was
freezing solidly around the ship. The thermometer recorded 10°
below zero Fahr. at 2 a.m. on the 22nd. Some hours earlier we
had watched a wonderful golden mist to the southward, where the
rays of the declining sun shone through vapour rising from the ice.
All normal standards of perspective vanish under such conditions,
and the low ridges of the pack, with mist lying between them, gave
the illusion of a wilderness of mountain-peaks like the Bernese
Oberland. I could not doubt now that the Endurance was confined
for the winter. Gentle breezes from the east, south, and south-west
did not disturb the hardening floes. The seals were disappearing
and the birds were leaving us. The land showed still in fair weather
on the distant horizon, but it was beyond our reach now, and regrets
for havens that lay behind us were vain.
“We must wait for the spring, which may bring us better fortune.
If I had guessed a month ago that the ice would grip us here, I
would have established our base at one of the landing-places at
the great glacier. But there seemed no reason to anticipate then
that the fates would prove unkind. This calm weather with intense
cold in a summer month is surely exceptional. My chief anxiety is
the drift. Where will the vagrant winds and currents carry the ship
during the long winter months that are ahead of us? We will go west,
no doubt, but how far? And will it be possible to break out of the
pack early in the spring and reach Vahsel Bay or some other suitable
landing-place? These are momentous questions for us.”
On February 24 we ceased to observe ship routine, and the Endurance
became a winter station. All hands were on duty during the day and
slept at night, except a watchman who looked after the dogs and
watched for any sign of movement in the ice. We cleared a space of
10 ft. by 20 ft. round the rudder and propeller, sawing through ice
2 ft. thick, and lifting the blocks with a pair of tongs made by the
carpenter. Crean used the blocks to make an ice-house for the dog
Sally, which had added a little litter of pups to the strength of
the expedition. Seals appeared occasionally, and we killed all that
came within our reach. They represented fuel as well as food for men
and dogs. Orders were given for the after-hold to be cleared and
the stores checked, so that we might know exactly how we stood for
a siege by an Antarctic winter. The dogs went off the ship on the
following day. Their kennels were placed on the floe along the
length of a wire rope to which the leashes were fastened.
The dogs seemed heartily glad to leave the ship, and yelped
loudly and joyously as they were moved to their new quarters.
We had begun the training of teams, and already there was keen
rivalry between the drivers. The flat floes and frozen leads
in the neighbourhood of the ship made excellent training grounds.
Hockey and football on the floe were our chief recreations, and
all hands joined in many a strenuous game. Worsley took a
party to the floe on the 26th and started building a line of
igloos and “dogloos” round the ship. These little buildings were
constructed, Esquimaux fashion, of big blocks of ice, with thin
sheets for the roofs. Boards or frozen sealskins were placed over
all, snow was piled on top and pressed into the joints, and then
water was thrown over the structures to make everything firm.
The ice was packed down flat inside and covered with snow for the
dogs, which preferred, however, to sleep outside except when the
weather was extraordinarily severe. The tethering of the dogs
was a simple matter. The end of a chain was buried about eight
inches in the snow, some fragments of ice were pressed around it,
and a little water poured over all. The icy breath of the Antarctic
cemented it in a few moments. Four dogs which had been ailing
were shot. Some of the dogs were suffering badly from worms,
and the remedies at our disposal, unfortunately, were not effective.
All the fit dogs were being exercised in the sledges, and they
took to the work with enthusiasm. Sometimes their eagerness to
be off and away produced laughable results, but the drivers
learned to be alert. The wireless apparatus was still rigged,
but we listened in vain for the Saturday-night time signals from
New Year Island, ordered for our benefit by the Argentine
Government. On Sunday the 28th, Hudson waited at 2 a.m. for
the Port Stanley monthly signals, but could hear nothing.
Evidently the distances were too great for our small plant.
WINTER MONTHS
The month of March opened with a severe north-easterly gale. Five
Weddells and two crab-eaters were shot on the floe during the morning
of March 1, and the wind, with fine drifting snow, sprang up while
the carcasses were being brought in by sledging parties. The men
were compelled to abandon some of the blubber and meat, and they
had a struggle to get back to the ship over the rough ice in the
teeth of the storm. This gale continued until the 3rd, and all
hands were employed clearing out the ’tween decks, which was to be
converted into a living- and dining-room for officers and scientists.
The carpenter erected in this room the stove that had been intended
for use in the shore hut, and the quarters were made very snug.
The dogs appeared indifferent to the blizzard. They emerged
occasionally from the drift to shake themselves and bark, but were
content most of the time to lie, curled into tight balls, under the
snow. One of the old dogs, Saint, died on the night of the 2nd,
and the doctors reported that the cause of death was appendicitis.
When the gale cleared we found that the pack had been driven in
from the north-east and was now more firmly consolidated than
before. A new berg, probably fifteen miles in length, had appeared
on the northern horizon. The bergs within our circle of vision had
all become familiar objects, and we had names for some of them.
Apparently they were all drifting with the pack. The sighting of
a new berg was of more than passing interest, since in that
comparatively shallow sea it would be possible for a big berg to
become stranded. Then the island of ice would be a centre of
tremendous pressure and disturbance amid the drifting pack. We had
seen something already of the smashing effect of a contest between
berg and floe, and had no wish to have the helpless Endurance
involved in such a battle of giants. During the 3rd the seal meat
and blubber was re-stowed on hummocks around the ship. The frozen
masses had been sinking into the floe. Ice, though hard and solid
to the touch, is never firm against heavy weights. An article left
on the floe for any length of time is likely to sink into the
surface-ice. Then the salt water will percolate through and the
article will become frozen into the body of the floe.
Clear weather followed the gale, and we had a series of mock suns
and parhelia. Minus temperatures were the rule, 21° below
zero Fahr. being recorded on the 6th. We made mattresses for the
dogs by stuffing sacks with straw and rubbish, and most of the
animals were glad to receive this furnishing in their kennels.
Some of them had suffered through the snow melting with the heat
of their bodies and then freezing solid. The scientific members
of the expedition were all busy by this time. The meteorologist
had got his recording station, containing anemometer, barograph,
and thermograph, rigged over the stern. The geologist was making
the best of what to him was an unhappy situation; but was not
altogether without material. The pebbles found in the penguins
were often of considerable interest, and some fragments of rock
were brought up from the sea floor with the sounding-lead and the
drag-net. On the 7th Wordie and Worsley found some small pebbles,
a piece of moss, a perfect bivalve shell, and some dust on a berg
fragment, and brought their treasure-trove proudly to the ship.
Clark was using the drag-net frequently in the leads and secured
good hauls of plankton, with occasional specimens of greater
scientific interest. Seals were not plentiful, but our store of
meat and blubber grew gradually. All hands ate seal meat with
relish and would not have cared to become dependent on the ship’s
tinned meat. We preferred the crab-eater to the Weddell, which is
a very sluggish beast. The crab-eater seemed cleaner and healthier.
The killer-whales were still with us. On the 8th we examined a
spot where the floe-ice had been smashed up by a blow from beneath,
delivered presumably by a large whale in search of a breathing-place.
The force that had been exercised was astonishing. Slabs of ice 3 ft.
thick, and weighing tons, had been tented upwards over a circular
area with a diameter of about 25 ft., and cracks radiated outwards
for more than 20 ft.
The quarters in the ’tween decks were completed by the 10th, and
the men took possession of the cubicles that had been built. The
largest cubicle contained Macklin, McIlroy, Hurley, and Hussey and
it was named “The Billabong.” Clark and Wordie lived opposite in
a room called “Auld Reekie.” Next came the abode of “The Nuts”
or engineers, followed by “The Sailors’ Rest,” inhabited by
Cheetham and McNeish. “The Anchorage” and “The Fumarole” were
on the other side. The new quarters became known as “The Ritz,”
and meals were served there instead of in the ward room. Breakfast
was at 9 a.m., lunch at 1 p.m., tea at 4 p.m., and dinner at 6 p.m.
Wild, Marston, Crean, and Worsley established themselves in
cubicles in the wardroom, and by the middle of the month all hands
had settled down to the winter routine. I lived alone aft.
Worsley, Hurley, and Wordie made a journey to a big berg, called
by us the Rampart Berg, on the 11th. The distance out was 7½
miles, and the party covered a total distance of about 17 miles.
Hurley took some photographs and Wordie came back rejoicing with
a little dust and some moss.
“Within a radius of one mile round the berg there is thin young ice,
strong enough to march over with care,” wrote Worsley. “The area
of dangerous pressure, as regards a ship, does not seem to extend
for more than a quarter of a mile from the berg. Here there are
cracks and constant slight movement, which becomes exciting to the
traveller when he feels a piece of ice gradually upending beneath
his feet. Close to the berg the pressure makes all sorts of quaint
noises. We heard tapping as from a hammer, grunts, groans and
squeaks, electric trams running, birds singing, kettles boiling
noisily, and an occasional swish as a large piece of ice, released
from pressure, suddenly jumped or turned over. We noticed all
sorts of quaint effects, such as huge bubbles or domes of ice,
40 ft. across and 4 or 5 ft. high. Large sinuous pancake-sheets
were spread over the floe in places, and in one spot we counted
five such sheets, each about 2½ in. thick, imbricated under
one another. They look as though made of barley-sugar and are
very slippery.”
The noon position on the 14th was lat. 76° 54´ S.,
long. 36° 10´ W. The land was visible faintly to
the south-east, distant about 36 miles. A few small leads could
be seen from the ship, but the ice was firm in our neighbourhood.
The drift of the Endurance was still towards the north-west.
I had the boilers blown down on the 15th, and the consumption of
2 cwt. of coal per day to keep the boilers from freezing then
ceased. The bunkers still contained 52 tons of coal, and the daily
consumption in the stoves was about 2½ cwt. There would not be
much coal left for steaming purposes in the spring, but I
anticipated eking out the supply with blubber. A moderate gale
from the north-east on the 17th brought fine, penetrating
snow. The weather cleared in the evening, and a beautiful crimson sunset
held our eyes. At the same time the ice-cliffs of the land were
thrown up in the sky by mirage, with an apparent reflection in
open water, though the land itself could not be seen definitely.
The effect was repeated in an exaggerated form on the following
day, when the ice-cliffs were thrown up above the horizon in double
and treble parallel lines, some inverted. The mirage was due
probably to lanes of open water near the land. The water would
be about 30° warmer than the air and would cause warmed
strata to ascend. A sounding gave 606 fathoms, with a bottom of
glacial mud. Six days later, on the 24th, the depth was 419 fathoms.
We were drifting steadily, and the constant movement, coupled with
the appearance of lanes near the land, convinced me that we must
stay by the ship till she got clear. I had considered the
possibility of making a landing across the ice in the spring,
but the hazards of such an undertaking would be too great.
The training of the dogs in sledge teams was making progress.
The orders used by the drivers were “Mush” (Go on), “Gee” (Right),
“Haw” (Left), and “Whoa” (Stop). These are the words that the
Canadian drivers long ago adopted, borrowing them originally from
England. There were many fights at first, until the dogs learned
their positions and their duties, but as days passed drivers and
teams became efficient. Each team had its leader, and efficiency
depended largely on the willingness and ability of this dog to
punish skulking and disobedience. We learned not to interfere
unless the disciplinary measures threatened to have a fatal
termination. The drivers could sit on the sledge and jog along
at ease if they chose. But the prevailing minus temperatures
made riding unpopular, and the men preferred usually to run or
walk alongside the teams. We were still losing dogs through
sickness, due to stomach and intestinal worms.
Dredging for specimens at various depths was one of the duties
during these days. The dredge and several hundred fathoms of wire
line made a heavy load, far beyond the unaided strength of the
scientists. On the 23rd, for example, we put down a 2 ft. dredge
and 650 fathoms of wire. The dredge was hove in four hours later
and brought much glacial mud, several pebbles and rock fragments,
three sponges, some worms, brachiapods, and foraminiferae. The
mud was troublesome. It was heavy to lift, and as it froze
rapidly when brought to the surface, the recovery of the specimens
embedded in it was difficult. A haul made on the 26th brought a
prize for the geologist in the form of a lump of sandstone
weighing 75 lbs., a piece of fossiliferous limestone, a fragment of
striated shale, sandstone-grit, and some pebbles. Hauling in the
dredge by hand was severe work, and on the 24th we used the
Girling tractor-motor, which brought in 500 fathoms of line in
thirty minutes, including stops. One stop was due to water having
run over the friction gear and frozen. It was a day or two later
that we heard a great yell from the floe and found Clark dancing
about and shouting Scottish war-cries. He had secured his first
complete specimen of an Antarctic fish, apparently a new species.
Mirages were frequent. Barrier-cliffs appeared all around us
on the 29th, even in places where we knew there was deep water.
“Bergs and pack are thrown up in the sky and distorted into the
most fantastic shapes. They climb, trembling, upwards, spreading
out into long lines at different levels, then contract and fall
down, leaving nothing but an uncertain, wavering smudge which comes
and goes. Presently the smudge swells and grows, taking shape
until it presents the perfect inverted reflection of a berg on
the horizon, the shadow hovering over the substance. More smudges
appear at different points on the horizon. These spread out into
long lines till they meet, and we are girdled by lines of shining
snow-cliffs, laved at their bases by waters of illusion in which
they appear to be faithfully reflected. So the shadows come and
go silently, melting away finally as the sun declines to the west.
We seem to be drifting helplessly in a strange world of unreality.
It is reassuring to feel the ship beneath one’s feet and to look
down at the familiar line of kennels and igloos on the solid floe.”
The floe was not so solid as it appeared. We had reminders
occasionally that the greedy sea was very close, and that the floe
was but a treacherous friend, which might open suddenly beneath us.
Towards the end of the month I had our store of seal meat and
blubber brought aboard. The depth as recorded by a sounding on
the last day of March was 256 fathoms. The continuous shoaling
from 606 fathoms in a drift of 39 miles N. 26° W. in thirty
days was interesting. The sea shoaled as we went north, either to
east or to west, and the fact suggested that the contour-lines ran
east and west, roughly. Our total drift between January 19, when
the ship was frozen in, and March 31, a period of seventy-one days,
had been 95 miles in a N. 80° W. direction. The icebergs
around us had not changed their relative positions.
The sun sank lower in the sky, the temperatures became lower,
and the Endurance felt the grip of the icy hand of winter.
Two north-easterly gales in the early part of April assisted to
consolidate the pack. The young ice was thickening rapidly, and
though leads were visible occasionally from the ship, no opening
of a considerable size appeared in our neighbourhood. In the early
morning of April 1 we listened again for the wireless signals
from Port Stanley. The crew had lashed three 20-ft. rickers to
the mast-heads in order to increase the spread of our aerials,
but still we failed to hear anything. The rickers had to come down
subsequently, since we found that the gear could not carry the
accumulating weight of rime. Soundings proved that the sea
continued to shoal as the Endurance drifted to the north-west.
The depth on April 2 was 262 fathoms, with a bottom of glacial mud.
Four weeks later a sounding gave 172 fathoms. The presence of
grit in the bottom samples towards the end of the month suggested
that we were approaching land again.
The month was not uneventful. During the night of the 3rd we
heard the ice grinding to the eastward, and in the morning we saw
that young ice was rafted 8 to 10 ft. high in places. This was
the first murmur of the danger that was to reach menacing
proportions in later months. The ice was heard grinding and
creaking during the 4th and the ship vibrated slightly. The
movement of the floe was sufficiently pronounced to interfere with
the magnetic work. I gave orders that accumulations of snow, ice,
and rubbish alongside the Endurance should be shovelled away, so
that in case of pressure there would be no weight against the
topsides to check the ship rising above the ice. All hands were
busy with pick and shovel during the day, and moved many tons of
material. Again, on the 9th, there were signs of pressure. Young
ice was piled up to a height of 11 ft. astern of the ship, and the
old floe was cracked in places. The movement was not serious, but
I realized that it might be the beginning of trouble for the
Expedition. We brought certain stores aboard and provided space on
deck for the dogs in case they had to be removed from the floe at
short notice. We had run a 500-fathom steel wire round the ship,
snow-huts, and kennels, with a loop out to the lead ahead, where
the dredge was used. This wire was supported on ice-pillars, and
it served as a guide in bad weather when the view was obscured by
driving snow and a man might have lost himself altogether. I had
this wire cut in five places, since otherwise it might have been
dragged across our section of the floe with damaging effect in the
event of the ice splitting suddenly.
The dogs had been divided into six teams of nine dogs each. Wild,
Crean, Macklin, McIlroy, Marston, and Hurley each had charge of a
team, and were fully responsible for the exercising, training, and
feeding of their own dogs. They called in one of the surgeons when
an animal was sick. We were still losing some dogs through worms,
and it was unfortunate that the doctors had not the proper remedies.
Worm-powders were to have been provided by the expert Canadian dog-driver
I had engaged before sailing for the south, and when this man
did not join the Expedition the matter was overlooked. We had fifty-four
dogs and eight pups early in April, but several were ailing, and
the number of mature dogs was reduced to fifty by the end of the month.
Our store of seal meat amounted now to about 5000 lbs., and I calculated
that we had enough meat and blubber to feed the dogs for ninety days
without trenching upon the sledging rations. The teams were working
well, often with heavy loads. The biggest dog was Hercules, who
tipped the beam at 86 lbs. Samson was 11 lbs. lighter, but he justified
his name one day by starting off at a smart pace with a sledge
carrying 200 lbs. of blubber and a driver.
A new berg that was going to give us some cause for anxiety made
its appearance on the 14th. It was a big berg, and we noticed as
it lay on the north-west horizon that it had a hummocky, crevassed
appearance at the east end. During the day this berg increased
its apparent altitude and changed its bearing slightly.
Evidently it was aground and was holding its position against the
drifting pack. A sounding at 11 a.m. gave 197 fathoms, with a
hard stony or rocky bottom. During the next twenty-four hours
the Endurance moved steadily towards the crevassed berg, which
doubled its altitude in that time. We could see from the mast-head
that the pack was piling and rafting against the mass of ice, and
it was easy to imagine what would be the fate of the ship if she
entered the area of disturbance. She would be crushed like an
egg-shell amid the shattering masses.
Worsley was in the crow’s-nest on the evening of the 15th,
watching for signs of land to the westward, and he reported an
interesting phenomenon. The sun set amid a glow of prismatic
colours on a line of clouds just above the horizon. A minute later
Worsley saw a golden glow, which expanded as he watched it, and
presently the sun appeared again and rose a semi-diameter clear
above the western horizon. He hailed Crean, who from a position
on the floe 90 ft. below the crow’s-nest also saw the re-born sun.
A quarter of an hour later from the deck Worsley saw the sun set a
second time. This strange phenomenon was due to mirage or refraction.
We attributed it to an ice-crack to the westward, where the band of
open water had heated a stratum of air.
The drift of the pack was not constant, and during the succeeding
days the crevassed berg alternately advanced and receded as the
Endurance moved with the floe. On Sunday, April 18, it was only
seven miles distant from the ship.
“It is a large berg, about three-quarters of a mile long on the
side presented to us and probably well over 200 ft. high. It is
heavily crevassed, as though it once formed the serac portion of
a glacier. Two specially wide and deep chasms across it from
south-east to north-west give it the appearance of having broken
its back on the shoal-ground. Huge masses of pressure-ice are
piled against its cliffs to a height of about 60 ft., showing
the stupendous force that is being brought to bear upon it by
the drifting pack. The berg must be very firmly aground. We
swing the arrow on the current-meter frequently and watch with
keen attention to see where it will come to rest. Will it point
straight for the berg, showing that our drift is in that direction?
It swings slowly round. It points to the north-east end of the berg,
then shifts slowly to the centre and seems to stop; but it moves
again and swings 20 degrees clear of our enemy to the south-west. . . .
We notice that two familiar bergs, the Rampart Berg and the Peak
Berg, have moved away from the ship. Probably they also have
grounded or dragged on the shoal.”
A strong drift to the westward during the night of the 18th relieved
our anxiety by carrying the Endurance to the lee of the crevassed
berg, which passed out of our range of vision before the end of the
month.
We said good-bye to the sun on May 1 and entered the period of
twilight that would be followed by the darkness of midwinter.
The sun by the aid of refraction just cleared the horizon at noon
and set shortly before 2 p.m. A fine aurora in the evening was
dimmed by the full moon, which had risen on April 27 and would not
set again until May 6. The disappearance of the sun is apt to be
a depressing event in the polar regions, where the long months of
darkness involve mental as well as physical strain. But the
Endurance’s company refused to abandon their customary cheerfulness,
and a concert in the evening made the Ritz a scene of noisy merriment,
in strange contrast with the cold, silent world that lay outside.
“One feels our helplessness as the long winter night closes upon us.
By this time, if fortune had smiled upon the Expedition, we would have
been comfortably and securely established in a shore base, with
depots laid to the south and plans made for the long march in the
spring and summer. Where will we make a landing now? It is not
easy to forecast the future. The ice may open in the spring, but
by that time we will be far to the north-west. I do not think we
shall be able to work back to Vahsel Bay. There are possible
landing-places on the western coast of the Weddell Sea, but can we
reach any suitable spot early enough to attempt the overland journey
next year? Time alone will tell. I do not think any member of
the Expedition is disheartened by our disappointment. All hands
are cheery and busy, and will do their best when the time
for action comes. In the meantime we must wait.”
The ship’s position on Sunday, May 2, was lat. 75°
23´ S., long. 42° 14´ W. The temperature
at noon was 5° below zero Fahr., and the sky was overcast.
A seal was sighted from the mast-head at lunch-time, and five men,
with two dog teams, set off after the prize. They had an
uncomfortable journey outward in the dim, diffused light, which
cast no shadows and so gave no warning of irregularities in the
white surface. It is a strange sensation to be running along on
apparently smooth snow and to fall suddenly into an unseen hollow,
or bump against a ridge.
“After going out three miles to the eastward,” wrote Worsley in
describing this seal-hunt, “we range up and down but find nothing,
until from a hummock I fancy I see something apparently a mile away,
but probably little more than half that distance. I ran for it,
found the seal, and with a shout brought up the others at the double.
The seal was a big Weddell, over 10 ft. long and weighing more than
800 lbs. But Soldier, one of the team leaders, went for its throat
without a moment’s hesitation, and we had to beat off the dogs
before we could shoot the seal. We caught five or six gallons of
blood in a tin for the dogs, and let the teams have a drink of
fresh blood from the seal. The light was worse than ever on our
return, and we arrived back in the dark. Sir Ernest met us with
a lantern and guided us into the lead astern and thence to the
ship.”
This was the first seal we had secured since March 19, and the
meat and blubber made a welcome addition to the stores.
Three emperor penguins made their appearance in a lead west of the
ship on May 3. They pushed their heads through the young ice
while two of the men were standing by the lead. The men imitated
the emperor’s call and walked slowly, penguin fashion, away from
the lead. The birds in succession made a magnificent leap 3 ft.
clear from the water on to the young ice. Thence they tobogganed
to the bank and followed the men away from the lead. Their
retreat was soon cut off by a line of men.
“We walk up to them, talking loudly and assuming a threatening
aspect. Notwithstanding our bad manners, the three birds turn
towards us, bowing ceremoniously. Then, after a closer inspection,
they conclude that we are undesirable acquaintances and make off
across the floe. We head them off and finally shepherd them close
to the ship, where the frenzied barking of the dogs so frightens
them that they make a determined effort to break through the line.
We seize them. One bird of philosophic mien goes quietly, led by
one flipper. The others show fight, but all are imprisoned in an
igloo for the night. . . . In the afternoon we see five emperors
in the western lead and capture one. Kerr and Cheetham fight a
valiant action with two large birds. Kerr rushes at one, seizes
it, and is promptly knocked down by the angered penguin, which
jumps on his chest before retiring. Cheetham comes to Kerr’s
assistance; and between them they seize another penguin, bind
his bill and lead him, muttering muffled protests, to the ship
like an inebriated old man between two policemen. He weighs 85 lbs.,
or 5 lbs. less than the heaviest emperor captured previously.
Kerr and Cheetham insist that he is nothing to the big fellow who
escaped them.”
This penguin’s stomach proved to be filled with freshly caught fish
up to 10 in. long. Some of the fish were of a coastal or littoral
variety. Two more emperors were captured on the following day, and,
while Wordie was leading one of them towards the ship, Wild came
along with his team. The dogs, uncontrollable in a moment, made a
frantic rush for the bird, and were almost upon him when their
harness caught upon an ice-pylon, which they had tried to pass on
both sides at once. The result was a seething tangle of dogs,
traces, and men, and an overturned sled, while the penguin, three
yards away, nonchalantly and indifferently surveyed the disturbance.
He had never seen anything of the kind before and had no idea at
all that the strange disorder might concern him. Several cracks
had opened in the neighbourhood of the ship, and the emperor penguins,
fat and glossy of plumage, were appearing in considerable numbers.
We secured nine of them on May 6, an important addition to our supply
of fresh food.
The sun, which had made “positively his last appearance” seven
days earlier, surprised us by lifting more than half its disk
above the horizon on May 8. A glow on the northern horizon
resolved itself into the sun at 11 a.m. that day. A quarter of
an hour later the unseasonable visitor disappeared again, only
to rise again at 11.40 a.m., set at 1 p.m., rise at 1.10 p.m.,
and set lingeringly at 1.20 p.m. These curious phenomena were due
to refraction, which amounted to 2° 37´ at 1.20 p.m.
The temperature was 15° below zero Fahr. and we calculated
that the refraction was 2° above normal. In other words,
the sun was visible 120 miles farther south than the refraction
tables gave it any right to be. The navigating officer naturally
was aggrieved. He had informed all hands on May 1 that they would
not see the sun again for seventy days, and now had to endure the
jeers of friends who affected to believe that his observations were
inaccurate by a few degrees.
The Endurance was drifting north-north-east under the influence of
a succession of westerly and south-westerly breezes. The ship’s
head, at the same time, swung gradually to the left, indicating that
the floe in which she was held was turning. During the night of
the 14th a very pronounced swing occurred, and when daylight came
at noon on the 15th we observed a large lead running from the north-west
horizon towards the ship till it struck the western lead,
circling ahead of the ship, then continuing to the south-south-east.
A lead astern connected with this new lead on either side of the
Endurance, thus separating our floe completely from the main body
of the pack. A blizzard from the south-east swept down during the
16th. At 1 p.m. the blizzard lulled for five minutes; then the wind
jumped round to the opposite quarter and the barometer rose suddenly.
The centre of a cyclonic movement had passed over us, and the compass
recorded an extraordinarily rapid swing of the floe. I could see
nothing through the mist and snow, and I thought it possible that a
magnetic storm or a patch of local magnetic attraction had caused
the compass, and not the floe, to swing, Our floe was now about
2½ miles long north and south and 3 miles wide east and west.
The month of May passed with few incidents of importance. Hurley,
our handy man, installed our small electric-lighting plant and
placed lights for occasional use in the observatory, the
meteorological station, and various other points. We could not
afford to use the electric lamps freely. Hurley also rigged two
powerful lights on poles projecting from the ship to port and
starboard. These lamps would illuminate the “dogloos” brilliantly
on the darkest winter’s day and would be invaluable in the event
of the floe breaking during the dark days of winter. We could
imagine what it would mean to get fifty dogs aboard without lights
while the floe was breaking and rafting under our feet. May 24,
Empire Day, was celebrated with the singing of patriotic songs
in the Ritz, where all hands joined in wishing a speedy victory
for the British arms. We could not know how the war was progressing,
but we hoped that the Germans had already been driven from France
and that the Russian armies had put the seal on the Allies’ success.
The war was a constant subject of discussion aboard the Endurance,
and many campaigns were fought on the map during the long months of
drifting. The moon in the latter part of May was sweeping
continuously through our starlit sky in great high circles.
The weather generally was good, with constant minus temperatures.
The log on May 27 recorded:
“Brilliantly fine clear weather with bright moonlight throughout.
The moon’s rays are wonderfully strong, making midnight seem as
light as an ordinary overcast midday in temperate climes. The great
clearness of the atmosphere probably accounts for our having eight
hours of twilight with a beautiful soft golden glow to the
northward. A little rime and glazed frost are found aloft. The
temperature is —20° Fahr. A few wisps of cirrus-cloud are
seen and a little frost-smoke shows in one or two directions, but
the cracks and leads near the ship appear to have frozen over again.”
Crean had started to take the pups out for runs, and it was very
amusing to see them with their rolling canter just managing to keep
abreast by the sledge and occasionally cocking an eye with an
appealing look in the hope of being taken aboard for a ride. As
an addition to their foster-father, Crean, the pups had adopted
Amundsen. They tyrannized over him most unmercifully. It was a
common sight to see him, the biggest dog in the pack, sitting out
in the cold with an air of philosophic resignation while a corpulent
pup occupied the entrance to his “dogloo.” The intruder was
generally the pup Nelson, who just showed his forepaws and face,
and one was fairly sure to find Nelly, Roger, and Toby coiled up
comfortably behind him. At hoosh-time Crean had to stand by
Amundsen’s food, since otherwise the pups would eat the big dog’s
ration while he stood back to give them fair play. Sometimes
their consciences would smite them and they would drag round a
seal’s head, half a penguin, or a large lump of frozen meat or
blubber to Amundsen’s kennel for rent. It was interesting to watch
the big dog play with them, seizing them by throat or neck in what
appeared to be a fierce fashion, while really quite gentle with them,
and all the time teaching them how to hold their own in the world
and putting them up to all the tricks of dog life.
The drift of the Endurance in the grip of the pack continued
without incident of importance through June. Pressure was reported
occasionally, but the ice in the immediate vicinity of the ship
remained firm. The light was now very bad except in the period
when the friendly moon was above the horizon. A faint twilight
round about noon of each day reminded us of the sun, and assisted
us in the important work of exercising the dogs. The care of the
teams was our heaviest responsibility in those days. The movement
of the floes was beyond all human control, and there was nothing
to be gained by allowing one’s mind to struggle with the problems
of the future, though it was hard to avoid anxiety at times.
The conditioning and training of the dogs seemed essential,
whatever fate might be in store for us, and the teams were taken
out by their drivers whenever the weather permitted. Rivalries
arose, as might have been expected, and on the 15th of the month
a great race, the “Antarctic Derby,” took place. It was a notable
event. The betting had been heavy, and every man aboard the ship
stood to win or lose on the result of the contest. Some money
had been staked, but the wagers that thrilled were those involving
stores of chocolate and cigarettes. The course had been laid off
from Khyber Pass, at the eastern end of the old lead ahead of the
ship, to a point clear of the jib-boom, a distance of about 700
yds. Five teams went out in the dim noon twilight, with a zero
temperature and an aurora flickering faintly to the southward.
The starting signal was to be given by the flashing of a light on
the meteorological station. I was appointed starter, Worsley was
judge, and James was timekeeper. The bos’n, with a straw hat added
to his usual Antarctic attire, stood on a box near the winning-post,
and was assisted by a couple of shady characters to shout the odds,
which were displayed on a board hung around his neck—6 to 4 on
Wild, “evens” on Crean, 2 to 1 against Hurley, 6 to 1 against Macklin,
and 8 to 1 against McIlroy. Canvas handkerchiefs fluttered from an
improvised grand stand, and the pups, which had never seen such
strange happenings before, sat round and howled with excitement.
The spectators could not see far in the dim light, but they heard
the shouts of the drivers as the teams approached and greeted the
victory of the favourite with a roar of cheering that must have
sounded strange indeed to any seals or penguins that happened to
be in our neighbourhood. Wild’s time was 2 min. 16 sec., or at
the rate of 10½ miles per hour for the course.
We celebrated Midwinter’s Day on the 22nd. The twilight extended
over a period of about six hours that day, and there was a good
light at noon from the moon, and also a northern glow with wisps
of beautiful pink cloud along the horizon. A sounding gave 262
fathoms with a mud bottom. No land was in sight from the mast-head,
although our range of vision extended probably a full degree to
the westward. The day was observed as a holiday, necessary work
only being undertaken, and, after the best dinner the cook could
provide, all hands gathered in the Ritz, where speeches, songs,
and toasts occupied the evening. After supper at midnight we sang
“God Save the King” and wished each other all success in the days
of sunshine and effort that lay ahead. At this time the Endurance
was making an unusually rapid drift to the north under the influence
of a fresh southerly to south-westerly breeze. We travelled 39
miles to the north in five days before a breeze that only once
attained the force of a gale and then for no more than an hour.
The absence of strong winds, in comparison with the almost unceasing
winter blizzards of the Ross Sea, was a feature of the Weddell Sea
that impressed itself upon me during the winter months.
Another race took place a few days after the “Derby.” The two crack
teams, driven by Hurley and Wild, met in a race from Khyber Pass.
Wild’s team, pulling 910 lbs., or 130 lbs. per dog, covered the 700
yds. in 2 min. 9 sec., or at the rate of 11.1 miles per hour.
Hurley’s team, with the same load, did the run in 2 min. 16 sec.
The race was awarded by the judge to Hurley owing to Wild failing
to “weigh in” correctly. I happened to be a part of the load on
his sledge, and a skid over some new drift within fifty yards of
the winning post resulted in my being left on the snow. It should
be said in justice to the dogs that this accident, while justifying
the disqualification, could not have made any material difference
in the time.
The approach of the returning sun was indicated by beautiful
sunrise glows on the horizon in the early days of July. We
had nine hours’ twilight on the 10th, and the northern sky, low to
the horizon, was tinted with gold for about seven hours. Numerous
cracks and leads extended in all directions to within 300 yds. of
the ship. Thin wavering black lines close to the northern horizon
were probably distant leads refracted into the sky. Sounds of
moderate pressure came to our ears occasionally, but the ship was
not involved. At midnight on the 11th a crack in the lead ahead of
the Endurance opened out rapidly, and by 2 a.m. was over 200 yds.
wide in places with an area of open water to the south-west.
Sounds of pressure were heard along this lead, which soon closed to
a width of about 30 yds. and then froze over. The temperature at
that time was —23° Fahr.
The most severe blizzard we had experienced in the Weddell Sea
swept down upon the Endurance on the evening of the 13th, and
by breakfast-time on the following morning the kennels to the
windward, or southern side of the ship were buried under 5 ft.
of drift. I gave orders that no man should venture beyond the
kennels. The ship was invisible at a distance of fifty yards,
and it was impossible to preserve one’s sense of direction
in the raging wind and suffocating drift. To walk against the
gale was out of the question. Face and eyes became snowed up
within two minutes, and serious frost-bites would have been the
penalty of perseverance. The dogs stayed in their kennels for
the most part, the “old stagers” putting out a paw occasionally
in order to keep open a breathing-hole. By evening the gale
had attained a force of 60 or 70 miles an hour, and the ship
was trembling under the attack. But we were snug enough in our
quarters aboard until the morning of the 14th, when all hands
turned out to shovel the snow from deck and kennels. The wind was
still keen and searching, with a temperature of something like
—30° Fahr., and it was necessary for us to be on guard against
frost-bite. At least 100 tons of snow were piled against the bows
and port side, where the weight of the drift had forced the floe
downward. The lead ahead had opened out during the night, cracked
the pack from north to south and frozen over again, adding 300 yds.
to the distance between the ship and “Khyber Pass.” The
breakdown gang had completed its work by lunch-time. The gale
was then decreasing and the three-days-old moon showed as a red
crescent on the northern horizon. The temperature during the
blizzard had ranged from —21° to —33.5° Fahr.
It is usual for the temperature to rise during a blizzard, and
the failure to produce any Föhn effect of this nature suggested
an absence of high land for at least 200 miles to the south and
south-west. The weather did not clear until the 16th. We saw then
that the appearance of the surrounding pack had been altered
completely by the blizzard. The “island” floe containing the
Endurance still stood fast, but cracks and masses of ice thrown
up by pressure could be seen in all directions. An area of open
water was visible on the horizon to the north, with a water
indication in the northern sky.
The ice-pressure, which was indicated by distant rumblings and
the appearance of formidable ridges, was increasingly a cause of
anxiety. The areas of disturbance were gradually approaching the
ship. During July 21 we could bear the grinding and crashing of
the working floes to the south-west and west and could see cracks
opening, working, and closing ahead.
“The ice is rafting up to a height of 10 or 15 ft. in places, the
opposing floes are moving against one another at the rate of about
200 yds. per hour. The noise resembles the roar of heavy, distant
surf. Standing on the stirring ice one can imagine it is disturbed
by the breathing and tossing of a mighty giant below.”
Early on the afternoon of the 22nd a 2-ft. crack, running south-west
and north-east for a distance of about two miles, approached to
within 35 yds. of the port quarter. I had all the sledges brought
aboard and set a special watch in case it became necessary to get
the dogs off the floe in a hurry. This crack was the result of
heavy pressure 300 yds. away on the port bow, where huge blocks of
ice were piled up in wild and threatening confusion. The pressure
at that point was enormous. Blocks weighing many tons were raised
15 ft. above the level of the floe. I arranged to divide the night
watches with Worsley and Wild, and none of us had much rest.
The ship was shaken by heavy bumps, and we were on the alert to see
that no dogs had fallen into cracks. The morning light showed
that our island had been reduced considerably during the night.
Our long months of rest and safety seemed to be at an end, and a
period of stress had begun.
During the following day I had a store of sledging provisions,
oil, matches, and other essentials placed on the upper deck handy
to the starboard quarter boat, so as to be in readiness for a
sudden emergency. The ice was grinding and working steadily to
the southward, and in the evening some large cracks appeared on the
port quarter, while a crack alongside opened out to 15 yds. The
blizzard seemed to have set the ice in strong movement towards the
north, and the south-westerly and west-south-westerly winds that
prevailed two days out of three maintained the drift. I hoped that
this would continue unchecked, since our chance of getting clear of
the pack early in the spring appeared to depend upon our making a
good northing. Soundings at this time gave depths of from 186 to
190 fathoms, with a glacial mud bottom. No land was in sight.
The light was improving. A great deal of ice-pressure was heard
and observed in all directions during the 25th, much of it close
to the port quarter of the ship. On the starboard bow huge blocks
of ice, weighing many tons and 5 ft. in thickness, were pushed up
on the old floe to a height of 15 to 20 ft. The floe that held the
Endurance was swung to and fro by the pressure during the day,
but came back to the old bearing before midnight.
“The ice for miles around is much looser. There are numerous cracks
and short leads to the north-east and south-east. Ridges are being
forced up in all directions, and there is a water-sky to the south-east.
It would be a relief to be able to make some effort on our
own behalf; but we can do nothing until the ice releases our ship.
If the floes continue to loosen, we may break out within the next
few weeks and resume the fight. In the meantime the pressure
continues, and it is hard to foresee the outcome. Just before noon
to-day (July 26) the top of the sun appeared by refraction for
one minute, seventy-nine days after our last sunset. A few minutes
earlier a small patch of the sun had been thrown up on one of the
black streaks above the horizon. All hands are cheered by the
indication that the end of the winter darkness is near. . . .
Clark finds that with returning daylight the diatoms are again
appearing. His nets and line are stained a pale yellow, and much
of the newly formed ice has also a faint brown or yellow tinge.
The diatoms cannot multiply without light, and the ice formed since
February can be distinguished in the pressure-ridges by its clear
blue colour. The older masses of ice are of a dark earthy brown,
dull yellow, or reddish brown.”
The break-up of our floe came suddenly on Sunday, August 1, just
one year after the Endurance left the South-West India Docks on
the voyage to the Far South. The position was lat. 72°
26´ S., long. 48° 10´ W. The morning brought
a moderate south-westerly gale with heavy snow, and at 8 a.m.,
after some warning movements of the ice, the floe cracked 40 yds.
off the starboard bow. Two hours later the floe began to break up
all round us under pressure and the ship listed over 10 degrees to
starboard. I had the dogs and sledges brought aboard at once and
the gangway hoisted. The animals behaved well. They came aboard
eagerly as though realizing their danger, and were placed in their
quarters on deck without a single fight occurring. The pressure
was cracking the floe rapidly, rafting it close to the slip and
forcing masses of ice beneath the keel. Presently the Endurance
listed heavily to port against the gale, and at the same time was
forced ahead, astern, and sideways several times by the grinding
floes. She received one or two hard nips, but resisted them
without as much as a creak. It looked at one stage as if the ship
was to be made the plaything of successive floes, and I was
relieved when she came to a standstill with a large piece of our
old “dock” under the starboard bilge. I had the boats cleared
away ready for lowering, got up some additional stores, and set
a double watch. All hands were warned to stand by, get what
sleep they could, and have their warmest clothing at hand.
Around us lay the ruins of “Dog Town” amid the debris of pressure-ridges.
Some of the little dwellings had been crushed flat beneath
blocks of ice; others had been swallowed and pulverized when the
ice opened beneath them and closed again. It was a sad sight,
but my chief concern just then was the safety of the rudder, which
was being attacked viciously by the ice. We managed to pole away
a large lump that had become jammed between the rudder and the
stern-post, but I could see that damage had been done, though
a close examination was not possible that day.
After the ship had come to a standstill in her new position very
heavy pressure was set up. Some of the trenails were started and
beams buckled slightly under the terrific stresses. But the
Endurance had been built to withstand the attacks of the ice,
and she lifted bravely as the floes drove beneath her. The
effects of the pressure around us were awe-inspiring. Mighty
blocks of ice, gripped between meeting floes, rose slowly till
they jumped like cherry-stones squeezed between thumb and finger.
The pressure of millions of tons of moving ice was crushing and
smashing inexorably. If the ship was once gripped firmly her
fate would be sealed.
The gale from the south-west blew all night and moderated during
the afternoon of the 2nd to a stiff breeze. The pressure had
almost ceased. Apparently the gale had driven the southern pack
down upon us, causing congestion in our area; the pressure had
stopped when the whole of the pack got into motion. The gale had
given us some northing, but it had dealt the Endurance what might
prove to be a severe blow. The rudder had been driven hard over
to starboard and the blade partially torn away from the
rudder-head. Heavy masses of ice were still jammed against the
stern, and it was impossible to ascertain the extent of the damage
at that time. I felt that it would be impossible in any case to
effect repairs in the moving pack. The ship lay steady all
night, and the sole sign of continuing pressure was an occasional
slight rumbling shock. We rigged shelters and kennels for the dogs
inboard.
The weather on August 3 was overcast and misty. We had nine hours
of twilight, with good light at noon. There was no land in sight
for ten miles from the mast-head. The pack as far as the eye could
reach was in a condition of chaos, much rafted and consolidated,
with very large pressure-ridges in all directions. At 9 p.m.
a rough altitude of Canopus gave the latitude as 71°
55´ 17´´ S. The drift, therefore, had been about
37 miles to the north in three days. Four of the poorest dogs
were shot this day. They were suffering severely from worms,
and we could not afford to keep sick dogs under the changed
conditions. The sun showed through the clouds on the northern
horizon for an hour on the 4th. There was no open water to be seen
from aloft in any direction. We saw from the masthead to west-south-west
an appearance of barrier, land, or a very long iceberg,
about 20 odd miles away, but the horizon clouded over before we
could determine its nature. We tried twice to make a sounding that
day, but failed on each occasion. The Kelvin machine gave no bottom
at the full length of the line, 370 fathoms. After much labour we
made a hole in the ice near the stern-post large enough for the
Lucas machine with a 32-lb. lead; but this appeared to be too light.
The machine stopped at 452 fathoms, leaving us in doubt as to whether
bottom had been reached. Then in heaving up we lost the lead, the
thin wire cutting its way into the ice and snapping. All hands
and the carpenter were busy this day making and placing kennels
on the upper deck, and by nightfall all the dogs were comfortably
housed, ready for any weather. The sun showed through the clouds
above the northern horizon for nearly an hour.
The remaining days of August were comparatively uneventful. The
ice around the ship froze firm again and little movement occurred
in our neighbourhood. The training of the dogs, including the
puppies, proceeded actively, and provided exercise as well as
occupation. The drift to the north-west continued steadily.
We had bad luck with soundings, the weather interfering at times
and the gear breaking on several occasions, but a big increase in
the depth showed that we had passed over the edge of the Weddell
Sea plateau. A sounding of about 1700 fathoms on August 10 agreed
fairly well with Filchner’s 1924 fathoms, 130 miles east of our
then position. An observation at noon of the 8th had given us lat.
71° 23´ S., long. 49° 13´ W. Minus
temperatures prevailed still, but the daylight was increasing.
We captured a few emperor penguins which were making their way
to the south-west. Ten penguins taken on the 19th were all
in poor condition, and their stomachs contained nothing but
stones and a few cuttle-fish beaks. A sounding on the 17th gave
1676 fathoms, 10 miles west of the charted position of Morell Land.
No land could be seen from the mast-head, and I decided that
Morell Land must be added to the long list of Antarctic islands
and continental coasts that on close investigation have resolved
themselves into icebergs. On clear days we could get an extended
view in all directions from the mast-head, and the line of the
pack was broken only by familiar bergs. About one hundred bergs
were in view on a fine day, and they seemed practically the same
as when they started their drift with us nearly seven months
earlier. The scientists wished to inspect some of the neighbouring
bergs at close quarters, but sledge travelling outside the well-trodden
area immediately around the ship proved difficult and
occasionally dangerous. On August 20, for example, Worsley,
Hurley, and Greenstreet started off for the Rampart Berg and got
on to a lead of young ice that undulated perilously beneath their
feet. A quick turn saved them.
A wonderful mirage of the Fata Morgana type was visible on
August 20. The day was clear and bright, with a blue sky overhead
and some rime aloft.
“The distant pack is thrown up into towering barrier-like cliffs,
which are reflected in blue lakes and lanes of water at their base.
Great white and golden cities of Oriental appearance at close
intervals along these clifftops indicate distant bergs, some not
previously known to us. Floating above these are wavering violet
and creamy lines of still more remote bergs and pack. The lines
rise and fall, tremble, dissipate, and reappear in an endless
transformation scene. The southern pack and bergs, catching
the sun’s rays, are golden, but to the north the ice-masses
are purple. Here the bergs assume changing forms, first a
castle, then a balloon just clear of the horizon, that changes
swiftly into an immense mushroom, a mosque, or a cathedral. The
principal characteristic is the vertical lengthening of the object,
a small pressure-ridge being given the appearance of a line of
battlements or towering cliffs. The mirage is produced by
refraction and is intensified by the columns of comparatively
warm air rising from several cracks and leads that have opened
eight to twenty miles away north and south.”
We noticed this day that a considerable change had taken place
in our position relative to the Rampart Berg. It appeared that
a big lead had opened and that there had been some differential
movement of the pack. The opening movement might presage renewed
pressure. A few hours later the dog teams, returning from exercise,
crossed a narrow crack that had appeared ahead of the ship. This
crack opened quickly to 60 ft. and would have given us trouble if
the dogs had been left on the wrong side. It closed on the 25th
and pressure followed in its neighbourhood.
On August 24 we were two miles north of the latitude of Morell’s
farthest south, and over 10° of longitude, or more than 200
miles, west of his position. From the mast-head no land could be
seen within twenty miles, and no land of over 500 ft. altitude could
have escaped observation on our side of long. 52° W. A
sounding of 1900 fathoms on August 25 was further evidence of the
non-existence of New South Greenland. There was some movement of
the ice near the ship during the concluding days of the month. All
hands were called out in the night of August 26, sounds of pressure
having been followed by the cracking of the ice alongside the ship,
but the trouble did not develop immediately. Late on the night of
the 31st the ice began to work ahead of the ship and along the port
side. Creaking and groaning of timbers, accompanied by loud
snapping sounds fore and aft, told their story of strain.
The pressure continued during the following day, beams and deck
planks occasionally buckling to the strain. The ponderous floes
were grinding against each other under the influence of wind and
current, and our ship seemed to occupy for the time being an
undesirable position near the centre of the disturbance; but she
resisted staunchly and showed no sign of water in the bilges,
although she had not been pumped out for six months. The pack
extended to the horizon in every direction. I calculated that we
were 250 miles from the nearest known land to the westward, and
more than 500 miles from the nearest outpost of civilization,
Wilhelmina Bay. I hoped we would not have to undertake a march
across the moving ice-fields. The Endurance we knew to be
stout and true; but no ship ever built by man could live if taken
fairly in the grip of the floes and prevented from rising to the
surface of the grinding ice. These were anxious days. In the
early morning of September 2 the ship jumped and shook to the
accompaniment of cracks and groans, and some of the men who had
been in the berths hurried on deck. The pressure eased a little
later in the day, when the ice on the port side broke away from
the ship to just abaft the main rigging. The Endurance was
still held aft and at the rudder, and a large mass of ice could
be seen adhering to the port bow, rising to within three feet of
the surface. I wondered if this ice had got its grip by piercing
the sheathing.
LOSS OF THE ENDURANCE
The ice did not trouble us again seriously until the end of
September, though during the whole month the floes were seldom
entirely without movement. The roar of pressure would come to us
across the otherwise silent ice-fields, and bring with it a threat
and a warning. Watching from the crow’s-nest, we could see
sometimes the formation of pressure-ridges. The sunshine glittered
on newly riven ice-surfaces as the masses of shattered floe rose
and fell away from the line of pressure. The area of disturbance
would advance towards us, recede, and advance again. The routine
of work and play on the Endurance proceeded steadily. Our plans
and preparations for any contingency that might arise during the
approaching summer had been made, but there seemed always plenty
to do in and about our prisoned ship. Runs with the dogs and
vigorous games of hockey and football on the rough snow-covered
floe kept all hands in good fettle. The record of one or two of
these September days will indicate the nature of our life and our
surroundings:
“September 4.—Temperature, —14.1° Fahr. Light easterly
breeze, blue sky, and stratus clouds. During forenoon notice a
distinct terra-cotta or biscuit colour in the stratus clouds to the
north. This travelled from east to west and could conceivably
have come from some of the Graham Land volcanoes, now about 300
miles distant to the north-west. The upper current of air probably
would come from that direction. Heavy rime. Pack unbroken and
unchanged as far as visible. No land for 22 miles. No animal
life observed.”
“September 7.—Temperature, —10.8° Fahr. Moderate
easterly to southerly winds, overcast and misty, with light
snow till midnight, when weather cleared. Blue sky and fine
clear weather to noon. Much rime aloft. Thick fresh snow on
ship and floe that glistens brilliantly in the morning sunlight.
Little clouds of faint violet-coloured mist rise from the lower
and brinier portions of the pack, which stretches unbroken to the
horizon. Very great refraction all round. A tabular berg about
fifty feet high ten miles west is a good index of the amount of
refraction. On ordinary days it shows from the mast-head,
clear-cut against the sky; with much refraction, the pack beyond
at the back of it lifts up into view; to-day a broad expanse of
miles of pack is seen above it. Numerous other bergs generally
seen in silhouette are, at first sight, lost, but after a closer
scrutiny they appear as large lumps or dark masses well below the
horizon. Refraction generally results in too big an altitude when
observing the sun for position, but to-day, the horizon is thrown
up so much that the altitude is about 12´ too small. No land
visible for twenty miles. No animal life observed. Lower Clark’s
tow-net with 566 fathoms of wire, and hoist it up at two and a half
miles an hour by walking across the floe with the wire. Result
rather meagre—jelly-fish and some fish larvae. Exercise dogs in
sledge teams. The young dogs, under Crean’s care, pull as well,
though not so strongly, as the best team in the pack. Hercules
for the last fortnight or more has constituted himself leader of
the orchestra. Two or three times in the twenty-four hours he
starts a howl—a deep, melodious howl—and in about thirty
seconds he has the whole pack in full song, the great deep,
booming, harmonious song of the half-wolf pack.”
By the middle of September we were running short of fresh meat
for the dogs. The seals and penguins seemed to have abandoned our
neighbourhood altogether. Nearly five months had passed since we
killed a seal, and penguins had been seen seldom. Clark, who was
using his trawl as often as possible, reported that there was a
marked absence of plankton in the sea, and we assumed that the
seals and the penguins had gone in search of their accustomed food.
The men got an emperor on the 23rd. The dogs, which were having
their sledging exercise, became wildly excited when the penguin,
which had risen in a crack, was driven ashore, and the best efforts
of the drivers failed to save it alive. On the following day Wild,
Hurley, Macklin, and McIlroy took their teams to the Stained Berg,
about seven miles west of the ship, and on their way back got a
female crab-eater, which they killed, skinned, and left to be
picked up later. They ascended to the top of the berg, which lay
in about lat. 69° 30´ S., long. 51° W., and from an
elevation of 110 ft. could see no land. Samples of the discoloured
ice from the berg proved to contain dust with black gritty particles
or sand-grains. Another seal, a bull Weddell, was secured on the
26th. The return of seal-life was opportune, since we had nearly
finished the winter supply of dog-biscuit and wished to be able to
feed the dogs on meat. The seals meant a supply of blubber,
moreover, to supplement our small remaining stock of coal when the
time came to get up steam again. We initiated a daylight-saving
system on this day by putting forward the clock one hour.
“This is really pandering to the base but universal passion that
men, and especially seafarers, have for getting up late, otherwise
we would be honest and make our routine earlier instead of flogging
the clock.”
During the concluding days of September the roar of the pressure
grew louder, and I could see that the area of disturbance was
rapidly approaching the ship. Stupendous forces were at work and
the fields of firm ice around the Endurance were being diminished
steadily. September 30 was a bad day. It began well, for we got
two penguins and five seals during the morning. Three other seals
were seen. But at 3 p.m. cracks that had opened during the night
alongside the ship commenced to work in a lateral direction. The
ship sustained terrific pressure on the port side forward, the
heaviest shocks being under the forerigging. It was the worst
squeeze we had experienced. The decks shuddered and jumped, beams
arched, and stanchions buckled and shook. I ordered all hands
to stand by in readiness for whatever emergency might arise.
Even the dogs seemed to feel the tense anxiety of the moment.
But the ship resisted valiantly, and just when it appeared that
the limit of her strength was being reached the huge floe that was
pressing down upon us cracked across and so gave relief.
“The behaviour of our ship in the ice has been magnificent,”
wrote Worsley. “Since we have been beset her staunchness and
endurance have been almost past belief again and again. She has
been nipped with a million-ton pressure and risen nobly, falling
clear of the water out on the ice. She has been thrown to and fro
like a shuttlecock a dozen times. She has been strained, her
beams arched upwards, by the fearful pressure; her very sides
opened and closed again as she was actually bent and curved along
her length, groaning like a living thing. It will be sad if such
a brave little craft should be finally crushed in the remorseless,
slowly strangling grip of the Weddell pack after ten months of
the bravest and most gallant fight ever put up by a ship.”
The Endurance deserved all that could be said in praise of her.
Shipwrights had never done sounder or better work; but how long
could she continue the fight under such conditions? We were
drifting into the congested area of the western Weddell Sea,
the worst portion of the worst sea in the world, where the pack,
forced on irresistibly by wind and current, impinges on the
western shore and is driven up in huge corrugated ridges and
chaotic fields of pressure. The vital question for us was whether
or not the ice would open sufficiently to release us, or at least
give us a chance of release, before the drift carried us into the
most dangerous area. There was no answer to be got from the silent
bergs and the grinding floes, and we faced the month of October
with anxious hearts.
The leads in the pack appeared to have opened out a little on
October 1, but not sufficiently to be workable even if we had been
able to release the Endurance from the floe. The day was calm,
cloudy and misty in the forenoon and clearer in the afternoon,
when we observed well-defined parhelia. The ship was subjected to
slight pressure at intervals. Two bull crab-eaters climbed on to
the floe close to the ship and were shot by Wild. They were both
big animals in prime condition, and I felt that there was no more
need for anxiety as to the supply of fresh meat for the dogs.
Seal-liver made a welcome change in our own menu. The two bulls
were marked, like many of their kind, with long parallel scars
about three inches apart, evidently the work of the killers.
A bull we killed on the following day had four parallel scars,
sixteen inches long, on each side of its body; they were fairly
deep and one flipper had been nearly torn away. The creature
must have escaped from the jaws of a killer by a very small
margin. Evidently life beneath the pack is not always monotonous.
We noticed that several of the bergs in the neighbourhood of
the ship were changing their relative positions more than
they had done for months past. The floes were moving.
Our position on Sunday, October 3, was lat. 69° 14´ S.,
long. 51° 8´ W. During the night the floe holding the ship
aft cracked in several places, and this appeared to have eased the
strain on the rudder. The forenoon was misty, with falls of snow,
but the weather cleared later in the day and we could see that the
pack was breaking. New leads had appeared, while several old leads
had closed. Pressure-ridges had risen along some of the cracks.
The thickness of the season’s ice, now about 230 days old, was
4 ft. 5 in. under 7 or 8 in. of snow. This ice had been slightly
thicker in the early part of September, and I assumed that some
melting had begun below. Clark had recorded plus temperatures at
depths of 150 and 200 fathoms in the concluding days of September.
The ice obviously had attained its maximum thickness by direct
freezing, and the heavier older floes had been created by the
consolidation of pressure-ice and the overlapping of floes under
strain. The air temperatures were still low, —24.5° Fahr. being
recorded on October 4.
The movement of the ice was increasing. Frost-smoke from opening
cracks was showing in all directions during October 6. It had the
appearance in one place of a great prairie fire, rising from the
surface and getting higher as it drifted off before the wind in
heavy, dark, rolling masses. At another point there was the
appearance of a train running before the wind, the smoke rising
from the locomotive straight upwards; and the smoke columns
elsewhere gave the effect of warships steaming in line ahead.
During the following day the leads and cracks opened to such an
extent that if the Endurance could have been forced forward
for thirty yards we could have proceeded for two or three miles;
but the effort did not promise any really useful result. The
conditions did not change materially during the rest of that week.
The position on Sunday, October 10, was lat. 69° 21´ S.,
long. 50° 34´ W. A thaw made things uncomfortable for us
that day. The temperature had risen from —10° Fahr. to
+29.8° Fahr., the highest we had experienced since
January, and the ship got dripping wet between decks. The upper
deck was clear of ice and snow and the cabins became unpleasantly
messy. The dogs, who hated wet, had a most unhappy air.
Undoubtedly one grows to like familiar conditions. We had lived
long in temperatures that would have seemed distressingly low
in civilized life, and now we were made uncomfortable by a degree
of warmth that would have left the unaccustomed human being still
shivering. The thaw was an indication that winter was over,
and we began preparations for reoccupying the cabins on the main
deck. I had the shelter-house round the stern pulled down on
the 11th and made other preparations for working the ship as soon
as she got clear. The carpenter had built a wheel-house
over the wheel aft as shelter in cold and heavy weather. The ice
was still loosening and no land was visible for twenty miles.
The temperature remained relatively high for several days. All
hands moved to their summer quarters in the upper cabins on the 12th,
to the accompaniment of much noise and laughter. Spring was in the
air, and if there were no green growing things to gladden our eyes,
there were at least many seals, penguins, and even whales
disporting themselves in the leads. The time for renewed action
was coming, and though our situation was grave enough, we were
facing the future hopefully. The dogs were kept in a state of
uproar by the sight of so much game. They became almost frenzied
when a solemn-looking emperor penguin inspected them gravely from
some point of vantage on the floe and gave utterance to an
apparently derisive “Knark!” At 7 p.m. on the 13th the ship
broke free of the floe on which she had rested to starboard
sufficiently to come upright. The rudder freed itself, but the
propeller was found to be athwartship, having been forced into that
position by the floe some time after August 1. The water was very
clear and we could see the rudder, which appeared to have suffered
only a slight twist to port at the water-line. It moved quite
freely. The propeller, as far as we could see, was intact, but it
could not be moved by the hand-gear, probably owing to a film of
ice in the stern gland and sleeve. I did not think it advisable
to attempt to deal with it at that stage. The ship had not been
pumped for eight months, but there was no water and not much ice
in the bilges. Meals were served again in the wardroom that day.
The south-westerly breeze freshened to a gale on the 14th, and the
temperature fell from +31° Fahr. to —1° Fahr. At
midnight the ship came free from the floe and drifted rapidly astern.
Her head fell off before the wind until she lay nearly at right-angles
across the narrow lead. This was a dangerous position for
rudder and propeller. The spanker was set, but the weight of the
wind on the ship gradually forced the floes open until the
Endurance swung right round and drove 100 yds. along the
lead. Then the ice closed and at 3 a.m. we were fast again.
The wind died down during the day and the pack opened for five
or six miles to the north. It was still loose on the following
morning, and I had the boiler pumped up with the intention of
attempting to clear the propeller; but one of the manholes
developed a leak, the packing being perished by cold or loosened
by contraction, and the boiler had to be emptied out again.
The pack was rather closer on Sunday the 17th. Top-sails and
head-sails were set in the afternoon, and with a moderate north-easterly
breeze we tried to force the ship ahead out of the
lead; but she was held fast. Later that day heavy pressure
developed. The two floes between which the Endurance was lying
began to close and the ship was subjected to a series of
tremendously heavy strains. In the engine-room, the weakest
point, loud groans, crashes, and hammering sounds were heard.
The iron plates on the floor buckled up and overrode with loud
clangs. Meanwhile the floes were grinding off each other’s
projecting points and throwing up pressure-ridges. The ship
stood the strain well for nearly an hour and then, to my great
relief, began to rise with heavy jerks and jars. She lifted
ten inches forward and three feet four inches aft, at the same
time heeling six degrees to port. The ice was getting below us
and the immediate danger had passed. The position was lat. 69°
19´ S., long. 50° 40´ W.
The next attack of the ice came on the afternoon of October 18th.
The two floes began to move laterally, exerting great pressure on
the ship. Suddenly the floe on the port side cracked and huge
pieces of ice shot up from under the port bilge. Within a few
seconds the ship heeled over until she had a list of thirty
degrees to port, being held under the starboard bilge by the
opposing floe. The lee boats were now almost resting on the floe.
The midship dog-kennels broke away and crashed down on to the lee
kennels, and the howls and barks of the frightened dogs assisted
to create a perfect pandemonium. Everything movable on deck and
below fell to the lee side, and for a few minutes it looked as if
the Endurance would be thrown upon her beam ends. Order was
soon restored. I had all fires put out and battens nailed on the
deck to give the dogs a foothold and enable people to get about.
Then the crew lashed all the movable gear. If the ship had heeled
any farther it would have been necessary to release the lee boats
and pull them clear, and Worsley was watching to give the alarm.
Hurley meanwhile descended to the floe and took some photographs
of the ship in her unusual position. Dinner in the wardroom that
evening was a curious affair. Most of the diners had to sit on
the deck, their feet against battens and their plates on their
knees. At 8 p.m. the floes opened, and within a few minutes
the Endurance was nearly upright again. Orders were given for
the ice to be chipped clear of the rudder. The men poled the
blocks out of the way when they had been detached from the floe
with the long ice-chisels, and we were able to haul the ship’s
stern into a clear berth. Then the boiler was pumped up.
This work was completed early in the morning of October 19,
and during that day the engineer lit fires and got up steam
very slowly, in order to economize fuel and avoid any strain
on the chilled boilers by unequal heating. The crew cut up all
loose lumber, boxes, etc., and put them in the bunkers for fuel.
The day was overcast, with occasional snowfalls, the temperature
+12° Fahr. The ice in our neighbourhood was quiet, but
in the distance pressure was at work. The wind freshened in the
evening, and we ran a wire-mooring astern. The barometer at 11 p.m.
stood at 28.96, the lowest since the gales of July. An uproar
among the dogs attracted attention late in the afternoon, and we
found a 25-ft. whale cruising up and down in our pool. It pushed
its head up once in characteristic killer fashion, but we judged
from its small curved dorsal fin that it was a specimen of
Balaenoptera acutorostrata, not Orca gladiator.
A strong south-westerly wind was blowing on October 20 and the
pack was working. The Endurance was imprisoned securely in the
pool, but our chance might come at any time. Watches were set so
as to be ready for working ship. Wild and Hudson, Greenstreet and
Cheetham, Worsley and Crean, took the deck watches, and the Chief
Engineer and Second Engineer kept watch and watch with three of the
A.B.’s for stokers. The staff and the forward hands, with the
exception of the cook, the carpenter and his mate, were on “watch
and watch”—that is, four hours on deck and four hours below, or
off duty. The carpenter was busy making a light punt, which might
prove useful in the navigation of lanes and channels. At 11 a.m.
we gave the engines a gentle trial turn astern. Everything worked
well after eight months of frozen inactivity, except that the
bilge-pump and the discharge proved to be frozen up; they were
cleared with some little difficulty. The engineer reported that to
get steam he had used one ton of coal, with wood-ashes and blubber.
The fires required to keep the boiler warm consumed one and a
quarter to one and a half hundred-weight of coal per day. We had
about fifty tons of coal remaining in the bunkers.
October 21 and 22 were days of low temperature, which caused the
open leads to freeze over. The pack was working, and ever and anon
the roar of pressure came to our ears. We waited for the next move
of the gigantic forces arrayed against us. The 23rd brought a
strong north-westerly wind, and the movement of the floes and
pressure-ridges became more formidable. Then on Sunday, October
24, there came what for the Endurance was the beginning of the end.
The position was lat. 69° 11´ S., long. 51° 5´ W. We
had now twenty-two and a half hours of daylight, and throughout the
day we watched the threatening advance of the floes. At 6.45 p.m.
the ship sustained heavy pressure in a dangerous position. The
attack of the ice is illustrated roughly in the appended diagram.
The shaded portions represent the pool, covered with new ice that
afforded no support to the ship, and the arrows indicate the
direction of the pressure exercised by the thick floes and pressure-ridges.
The onslaught was all but irresistible. The Endurance
groaned and quivered as her starboard quarter was forced against
the floe, twisting the sternpost and starting the heads and ends
of planking. The ice had lateral as well as forward movement,
and the ship was twisted and actually bent by the stresses.
She began to leak dangerously at once.
I had the pumps rigged, got up steam, and started the bilge-pumps
at 8 p.m. The pressure by that time had relaxed. The ship was
making water rapidly aft, and the carpenter set to work to make
a coffer-dam astern of the engines. All hands worked, watch
and watch, throughout the night, pumping ship and helping the
carpenter. By morning the leak was being kept in check. The
carpenter and his assistants caulked the coffer-dam with strips
of blankets and nailed strips over the seams wherever possible.
The main or hand pump was frozen up and could not be used at once.
After it had been knocked out Worsley, Greenstreet, and Hudson
went down in the bunkers and cleared the ice from the bilges.
“This is not a pleasant job,” wrote Worsley. “We have to dig
a hole down through the coal while the beams and timbers groan
and crack all around us like pistol-shots. The darkness is
almost complete, and we mess about in the wet with half-frozen
hands and try to keep the coal from slipping back into the bilges.
The men on deck pour buckets of boiling water from the galley down
the pipe as we prod and hammer from below, and at last we get the
pump clear, cover up the bilges to keep the coal out, and rush on
deck, very thankful to find ourselves safe again in the open air.”
Monday, October 25, dawned cloudy and misty, with a minus
temperature and a strong south-easterly breeze. All hands were
pumping at intervals and assisting the carpenter with the coffer-dam.
The leak was being kept under fairly easily, but the outlook
was bad. Heavy pressure-ridges were forming in all directions,
and though the immediate pressure upon the ship was not severe,
I realized that the respite would not be prolonged. The pack within
our range of vision was being subjected to enormous compression,
such as might be caused by cyclonic winds, opposing ocean currents,
or constriction in a channel of some description. The pressure-ridges,
massive and threatening, testified to the overwhelming
nature of the forces that were at work. Huge blocks of ice,
weighing many tons, were lifted into the air and tossed aside as
other masses rose beneath them. We were helpless intruders in a
strange world, our lives dependent upon the play of grim elementary
forces that made a mock of our puny efforts. I scarcely dared hope
now that the Endurance would live, and throughout that anxious
day I reviewed again the plans made long before for the sledging
journey that we must make in the event of our having to take to
the ice. We were ready, as far as forethought could make us,
for every contingency. Stores, dogs, sledges, and equipment were
ready to be moved from the ship at a moment’s notice.
The following day brought bright clear weather, with a blue sky.
The sunshine was inspiriting. The roar of pressure could be heard
all around us. New ridges were rising, and I could see as the day
wore on that the lines of major disturbance were drawing nearer to
the ship. The Endurance suffered some strains at intervals.
Listening below, I could hear the creaking and groaning of her
timbers, the pistol-like cracks that told of the starting of a
trenail or plank, and the faint, indefinable whispers of our ship’s
distress. Overhead the sun shone serenely; occasional fleecy clouds
drifted before the southerly breeze, and the light glinted and
sparkled on the million facets of the new pressure-ridges. The day
passed slowly. At 7 p.m. very heavy pressure developed, with
twisting strains that racked the ship fore and aft. The butts
of planking were opened four and five inches on the starboard side,
and at the same time we could see from the bridge that the ship
was bending like a bow under titanic pressure. Almost like a
living creature, she resisted the forces that would crush her;
but it was a one-sided battle. Millions of tons of ice pressed
inexorably upon the little ship that had dared the challenge of
the Antarctic. The Endurance was now leaking badly, and at
9 p.m. I gave the order to lower boats, gear, provisions, and
sledges to the floe, and move them to the flat ice a little way
from the ship. The working of the ice closed the leaks slightly
at midnight, but all hands were pumping all night. A strange
occurrence was the sudden appearance of eight emperor penguins
from a crack 100 yds. away at the moment when the pressure upon
the ship was at its climax. They walked a little way towards us,
halted, and after a few ordinary calls proceeded to utter weird
cries that sounded like a dirge for the ship. None of us had
ever before heard the emperors utter any other than the most
simple calls or cries, and the effect of this concerted effort
was almost startling.
Then came a fateful day—Wednesday, October 27.
The position was lat. 69° 5´ S., long. 51° 30´ W.
The temperature was —8.5° Fahr., a gentle southerly breeze
was blowing and the sun shone in a clear sky.
“After long months of ceaseless anxiety and strain, after times
when hope beat high and times when the outlook was black indeed,
the end of the Endurance has come. But though we have been
compelled to abandon the ship, which is crushed beyond all hope
of ever being righted, we are alive and well, and we have stores
and equipment for the task that lies before us. The task is to
reach land with all the members of the Expedition. It is hard
to write what I feel. To a sailor his ship is more than a
floating home, and in the Endurance I had centred ambitions,
hopes, and desires. Now, straining and groaning, her timbers
cracking and her wounds gaping, she is slowly giving up her
sentient life at the very outset of her career. She is
crushed and abandoned after drifting more than 570 miles in
a north-westerly direction during the 281 days since she became
locked in the ice. The distance from the point where she
became beset to the place where she now rests mortally hurt in
the grip of the floes is 573 miles, but the total drift through
all observed positions has been 1186 miles, and probably we actually
covered more than 1500 miles. We are now 346 miles from Paulet
Island, the nearest point where there is any possibility of
finding food and shelter. A small hut built there by the Swedish
expedition in 1902 is filled with stores left by the Argentine
relief ship. I know all about those stores, for I purchased them
in London on behalf of the Argentine Government when they asked me
to equip the relief expedition. The distance to the nearest
barrier west of us is about 180 miles, but a party going there
would still be about 360 miles from Paulet Island and there would
be no means of sustaining life on the barrier. We could not take
from here food enough for the whole journey; the weight would be
too great.
“This morning, our last on the ship, the weather was clear,
with a gentle south-south-easterly to south-south-westerly breeze.
From the crow’s-nest there was no sign of land of any sort. The
pressure was increasing steadily, and the passing hours brought no
relief or respite for the ship. The attack of the ice reached its
climax at 4 p.m. The ship was hove stern up by the pressure, and
the driving floe, moving laterally across the stern, split the
rudder and tore out the rudder-post and stern-post. Then, while
we watched, the ice loosened and the Endurance sank a little.
The decks were breaking upwards and the water was pouring in below.
Again the pressure began, and at 5 p.m. I ordered all hands on to
the ice. The twisting, grinding floes were working their will
at last on the ship. It was a sickening sensation to feel the
decks breaking up under one’s feet, the great beams bending and
then snapping with a noise like heavy gunfire. The water was
overmastering the pumps, and to avoid an explosion when it reached
the boilers I had to give orders for the fires to be drawn and the
steam let down. The plans for abandoning the ship in case of
emergency had been made well in advance, and men and dogs
descended to the floe and made their way to the comparative safety
of an unbroken portion of the floe without a hitch. Just before
leaving, I looked down the engine-room skylight as I stood on the
quivering deck, and saw the engines dropping sideways as the stays
and bed-plates gave way. I cannot describe the impression of
relentless destruction that was forced upon me as I looked down and
around. The floes, with the force of millions of tons of moving
ice behind them, were simply annihilating the ship.”
Essential supplies had been placed on the floe about 100 yds. from
the ship, and there we set about making a camp for the night. But
about 7 p.m., after the tents were up, the ice we were occupying
became involved in the pressure and started to split and smash
beneath our feet. I had the camp moved to a bigger floe about 200
yds. away, just beyond the bow of the ship. Boats, stores, and
camp equipment had to be conveyed across a working pressure-ridge.
The movement of the ice was so slow that it did not interfere much
with our short trek, but the weight of the ridge had caused the
floes to sink on either side and there were pools of water there.
A pioneer party with picks and shovels had to build a snow-causeway
before we could get all our possessions across. By
8 p.m. the camp had been pitched again. We had two pole-tents
and three hoop-tents. I took charge of the small pole-tent,
No. 1, with Hudson, Hurley, and James as companions; Wild had
the small hoop-tent, No. 2, with Wordie, McNeish, and McIlroy.
These hoop-tents are very easily shifted and set up. The eight
forward hands had the large hoop-tent, No. 3; Crean had charge
of No. 4 hoop-tent with Hussey, Marston, and Cheetham; and Worsley
had the other pole-tent, No. 5, with Greenstreet, Lees, Clark,
Kerr, Rickenson, Macklin, and Blackborrow, the last named being
the youngest of the forward hands.
“To-night the temperature has dropped to —16° Fahr., and
most of the men are cold and uncomfortable. After the tents had
been pitched I mustered all hands and explained the position to
them briefly and, I hope, clearly. I have told them the distance
to the Barrier and the distance to Paulet Island, and have stated
that I propose to try to march with equipment across the ice in the
direction of Paulet Island. I thanked the men for the steadiness
and good morale they have shown in these trying circumstances,
and told them I had no doubt that, provided they continued to work
their utmost and to trust me, we will all reach safety in the end.
Then we had supper, which the cook had prepared at the big blubber-stove,
and after a watch had been set all hands except the watch
turned in.” For myself, I could not sleep. The destruction and
abandonment of the ship was no sudden shock. The disaster had been
looming ahead for many months, and I had studied my plans for all
contingencies a hundred times. But the thoughts that came to me
as I walked up and down in the darkness were not particularly
cheerful. The task now was to secure the safety of the party,
and to that I must bend my energies and mental power and apply
every bit of knowledge that experience of the Antarctic had given
me. The task was likely to be long and strenuous, and an ordered
mind and a clear programme were essential if we were to come
through without loss of life. A man must shape himself to a
new mark directly the old one goes to ground.
At midnight I was pacing the ice, listening to the grinding floe
and to the groans and crashes that told of the death-agony of the
Endurance, when I noticed suddenly a crack running across our floe
right through the camp. The alarm-whistle brought all hands
tumbling out, and we moved the tents and stores lying on what was
now the smaller portion of the floe to the larger portion. Nothing
more could be done at that moment, and the men turned in again;
but there was little sleep. Each time I came to the end of my
beat on the floe I could just see in the darkness the uprearing
piles of pressure-ice, which toppled over and narrowed still
further the little floating island we occupied. I did not notice
at the time that my tent, which had been on the wrong side of the
crack, had not been erected again. Hudson and James had managed
to squeeze themselves into other tents, and Hurley had wrapped
himself in the canvas of No. 1 tent. I discovered this about
5 a.m. All night long the electric light gleamed from the stern
of the dying Endurance. Hussey had left this light switched
on when he took a last observation, and, like a lamp in a
cottage window, it braved the night until in the early morning
the Endurance received a particularly violent squeeze.
There was a sound of rending beams and the light disappeared.
The connexion had been cut.
Morning came in chill and cheerless. All hands were stiff and
weary after their first disturbed night on the floe. Just at
daybreak I went over to the Endurance with Wild and Hurley, in
order to retrieve some tins of petrol that could be used to boil
up milk for the rest of the men. The ship presented a painful
spectacle of chaos and wreck. The jib-boom and bowsprit had
snapped off during the night and now lay at right angles to the
ship, with the chains, martingale, and bob-stay dragging them as
the vessel quivered and moved in the grinding pack. The ice had
driven over the forecastle and she was well down by the head. We
secured two tins of petrol with some difficulty, and postponed the
further examination of the ship until after breakfast. Jumping
across cracks with the tins, we soon reached camp, and built a
fireplace out of the triangular water-tight tanks we had ripped
from the lifeboat. This we had done in order to make more room.
Then we pierced a petrol-tin in half a dozen places with an ice-axe
and set fire to it. The petrol blazed fiercely under the five-gallon
drum we used as a cooker, and the hot milk was ready
in quick time. Then we three ministering angels went round the
tents with the life-giving drink, and were surprised and a trifle
chagrined at the matter-of-fact manner in which some of the men
accepted this contribution to their comfort. They did not quite
understand what work we had done for them in the early dawn,
and I heard Wild say, “If any of you gentlemen would like your
boots cleaned just put them outside.” This was his gentle way
of reminding them that a little thanks will go a long way on
such occasions.
The cook prepared breakfast, which consisted of biscuit and hoosh,
at 8 a.m., and I then went over to the Endurance again and made
a fuller examination of the wreck. Only six of the cabins had
not been pierced by floes and blocks of ice. Every one of the
starboard cabins had been crushed. The whole of the after part of
the ship had been crushed concertina fashion. The forecastle and
the Ritz were submerged, and the wardroom was three-quarters full
of ice. The starboard side of the wardroom had come away. The
motor-engine forward had been driven through the galley. Petrol-cases
that had been stacked on the fore-deck had been driven
by the floe through the wall into the wardroom and had carried
before them a large picture. Curiously enough, the glass of this
picture had not been cracked, whereas in the immediate
neighbourhood I saw heavy iron davits that had been twisted and
bent like the ironwork of a wrecked train. The ship was being
crushed remorselessly.
Under a dull, overcast sky I returned to camp and examined our
situation. The floe occupied by the camp was still subject to
pressure, and I thought it wise to move to a larger and apparently
stronger floe about 200 yds. away, off the starboard bow of the
ship. This camp was to become known as Dump Camp, owing to the
amount of stuff that was thrown away there. We could not afford
to carry unnecessary gear, and a drastic sorting of equipment
took place. I decided to issue a complete new set of Burberrys
and underclothing to each man, and also a supply of new socks.
The camp was transferred to the larger floe quickly, and I began
there to direct the preparations for the long journey across
the floes to Paulet Island or Snow Hill.
Hurley meanwhile had rigged his kinematograph-camera and was
getting pictures of the Endurance in her death-throes. While
he was engaged thus, the ice, driving against the standing rigging
and the fore-, main- and mizzen-masts, snapped the shrouds. The
foretop and topgallant-mast came down with a run and hung in
wreckage on the fore-mast, with the fore-yard vertical. The
main-mast followed immediately, snapping off about 10 ft. above
the main deck. The crow’s-nest fell within 10 ft. of where Hurley
stood turning the handle of his camera, but he did not stop the
machine, and so secured a unique, though sad, picture.
The issue of clothing was quickly accomplished. Sleeping-bags were
required also. We had eighteen fur bags, and it was necessary,
therefore, to issue ten of the Jaeger woollen bags in order to
provide for the twenty-eight men of the party. The woollen bags
were lighter and less warm than the reindeer bags, and so each man
who received one of them was allowed also a reindeer-skin to lie
upon. It seemed fair to distribute the fur bags by lot, but some
of us older hands did not join in the lottery. We thought we
could do quite as well with the Jaegers as with the furs. With
quick dispatch the clothing was apportioned, and then we turned one
of the boats on its side and supported it with two broken oars to
make a lee for the galley. The cook got the blubber-stove going,
and a little later, when I was sitting round the corner of the
stove, I heard one man say, “Cook, I like my tea strong.”
Another joined in, “Cook, I like mine weak.” It was pleasant
to know that their minds were untroubled, but I thought the time
opportune to mention that the tea would be the same for all hands
and that we would be fortunate if two months later we had any tea
at all. It occurred to me at the time that the incident had
psychological interest. Here were men, their home crushed,
the camp pitched on the unstable floes, and their chance of
reaching safety apparently remote, calmly attending to the
details of existence and giving their attention to such trifles
as the strength of a brew of tea.
During the afternoon the work continued. Every now and then we
heard a noise like heavy guns or distant thunder, caused by the
floes grinding together.
“The pressure caused by the congestion in this area of the pack
is producing a scene of absolute chaos. The floes grind stupendously,
throw up great ridges, and shatter one another mercilessly. The
ridges, or hedgerows, marking the pressure-lines that border the
fast-diminishing pieces of smooth floe-ice, are enormous. The ice
moves majestically, irresistibly. Human effort is not futile,
but man fights against the giant forces of Nature in a spirit of
humility. One has a sense of dependence on the higher Power.
To-day two seals, a Weddell and a crabeater, came close to the camp
and were shot. Four others were chased back into the water, for
their presence disturbed the dog teams, and this meant floggings
and trouble with the harness. The arrangement of the tents has
been completed and their internal management settled. Each tent
has a mess orderly, the duty being taken in turn on an alphabetical
rota. The orderly takes the hoosh-pots of his tent to the galley,
gets all the hoosh he is allowed, and, after the meal, cleans the
vessels with snow and stores them in sledge or boat ready for a
possible move.”
“October 29.—We passed a quiet night, although the pressure was
grinding around us. Our floe is a heavy one and it withstood the
blows it received. There is a light wind from the north-west to
north-north-west, and the weather is fine. We are twenty-eight
men with forty-nine dogs, including Sue’s and Sallie’s five
grown-up pups. All hands this morning were busy preparing gear,
fitting boats on sledges, and building up and strengthening the
sledges to carry the boats. . . . The main motor-sledge, with
a little fitting from the carpenter, carried our largest boat
admirably. For the next boat four ordinary sledges were lashed
together, but we were dubious as to the strength of this
contrivance, and as a matter of fact it broke down quickly under
strain. . . . The ship is still afloat, with the spurs of the
pack driven through her and holding her up. The forecastle-head
is under water, the decks are burst up by the pressure, the wreckage
lies around in dismal confusion, but over all the blue ensign flies
still.
“This afternoon Sallie’s three youngest pups, Sue’s Sirius, and
Mrs. Chippy, the carpenter’s cat, have to be shot. We could not
undertake the maintenance of weaklings under the new conditions.
Macklin, Crean, and the carpenter seemed to feel the loss of their
friends rather badly. We propose making a short trial journey
to-morrow, starting with two of the boats and the ten sledges.
The number of dog teams has been increased to seven, Greenstreet
taking charge of the new additional team, consisting of Snapper
and Sallie’s four oldest pups. We have ten working sledges to
relay with five teams. Wild’s and Hurley’s teams will haul the
cutter with the assistance of four men. The whaler and the other
boats will follow, and the men who are hauling them will be able
to help with the cutter at the rough places. We cannot hope to
make rapid progress, but each mile counts. Crean this afternoon
has a bad attack of snow-blindness.”
The weather on the morning of October 30 was overcast and misty,
with occasional falls of snow. A moderate north-easterly breeze
was blowing. We were still living on extra food, brought from the
ship when we abandoned her, and the sledging and boating rations
were intact. These rations would provide for twenty-eight men for
fifty-six days on full rations, but we could count on getting
enough seal and penguin meat to at least double this time. We
could even, if progress proved too difficult and too injurious to
the boats, which we must guard as our ultimate means of salvation,
camp on the nearest heavy floe, scour the neighbouring pack for
penguins and seals, and await the outward rift of the pack, to open
and navigable water.
“This plan would avoid the grave dangers we are now incurring of
getting entangled in impassable pressure-ridges and possibly
irretrievably damaging the boats, which are bound to suffer in
rough ice; it would also minimize the peril of the ice splitting
under us, as it did twice during the night at our first camp.
Yet I feel sure that it is the right thing to attempt a march,
since if we can make five or seven miles a day to the north-west
our chance of reaching safety in the months to come will be
increased greatly. There is a psychological aspect to the question
also. It will be much better for the men in general to feel that,
even though progress is slow, they are on their way to land than
it will be simply to sit down and wait for the tardy north-westerly
drift to take us out of this cruel waste of ice. We will make
an attempt to move. The issue is beyond my power either to
predict or to control.”
That afternoon Wild and I went out in the mist and snow to find a
road to the north-east. After many devious turnings to avoid the
heavier pressure-ridges, we pioneered a way for at least a mile
and a half. and then returned by a rather better route to the camp.
The pressure now was rapid in movement and our floe was suffering
from the shakes and jerks of the ice. At 3 p.m., after lunch,
we got under way, leaving Dump Camp a mass of debris. The order
was that personal gear must not exceed two pounds per man, and
this meant that nothing but bare necessaries was to be taken on
the march. We could not afford to cumber ourselves with
unnecessary weight. Holes had been dug in the snow for the
reception of private letters and little personal trifles,
the Lares and Penates of the members of the Expedition,
and into the privacy of these white graves were consigned much
of sentimental value and not a little of intrinsic worth.
I rather grudged the two pounds allowance per man, owing to
my keen anxiety to keep weights at a minimum, but some personal
belongings could fairly be regarded as indispensable. The
journey might be a long one, and there was a possibility of a
winter in improvised quarters on an inhospitable coast at the other
end. A man under such conditions needs something to occupy his
thoughts, some tangible memento of his home and people beyond the
seas. So sovereigns were thrown away and photographs were kept.
I tore the fly-leaf out of the Bible that Queen Alexandra had given
to the ship, with her own writing in it, and also the wonderful
page of Job containing the verse:
Out of whose womb came the ice?
And the hoary frost of Heaven, who hath gendered it?
The waters are hid as with a stone,
And the face of the deep is frozen. [Job 38:29–30]
The other Bible, which Queen Alexandra had given for the use of the
shore party, was down below in the lower hold in one of the cases
when the ship received her death-blow. Suitcases were thrown away;
these were retrieved later as material for making boots, and some
of them, marked “solid leather,” proved, to our disappointment,
to contain a large percentage of cardboard. The manufacturer would
have had difficulty in convincing us at the time that the deception
was anything short of criminal.
The pioneer sledge party, consisting of Wordie, Hussey, Hudson,
and myself, carrying picks and shovels, started to break a
road through the pressure-ridges for the sledges carrying the
boats. The boats, with their gear and the sledges beneath them,
weighed each more than a ton. The cutter was smaller than the
whaler, but weighed more and was a much more strongly built boat.
The whaler was mounted on the sledge part of the Girling tractor
forward and two sledges amidships and aft. These sledges were
strengthened with cross-timbers and shortened oars fore and aft.
The cutter was mounted on the aero-sledge. The sledges were the
point of weakness. It appeared almost hopeless to prevent them
smashing under their heavy loads when travelling over rough
pressure-ice which stretched ahead of us for probably 300 miles.
After the pioneer sledge had started the seven dog teams got off.
They took their sledges forward for half a mile, then went back
for the other sledges. Worsley took charge of the two boats, with
fifteen men hauling, and these also had to be relayed. It was
heavy work for dogs and men, but there were intervals of
comparative rest on the backward journey, after the first portion
of the load had been taken forward. We passed over two opening
cracks, through which killers were pushing their ugly snouts, and
by 5 p.m. had covered a mile in a north-north-westerly direction.
The condition of the ice ahead was chaotic, for since the morning
increased pressure had developed and the pack was moving and
crushing in all directions. So I gave the order to pitch camp for
the night on flat ice, which, unfortunately, proved to be young and
salty. The older pack was too rough and too deeply laden with
snow to offer a suitable camping-ground. Although we had gained
only one mile in a direct line, the necessary deviations made the
distance travelled at least two miles, and the relays brought the
distance marched up to six miles. Some of the dog teams had
covered at least ten miles. I set the watch from 6 p.m. to 7 a.m.,
one hour for each man in each tent in rotation.
During the night snow fell heavily, and the floor-cloths of the
tents got wet through, as the temperature had risen to +25°
Fahr. One of the things we hoped for in those days was a temperature
in the neighbourhood of zero, for then the snow surface would be hard,
we would not be troubled by damp, and our gear would not become
covered in soft snow. The killers were blowing all night, and
a crack appeared about 20 ft. from the camp at 2 a.m. The ice
below us was quite thin enough for the killers to break through
if they took a fancy to do so, but there was no other camping-ground
within our reach and we had to take the risk. When morning came
the snow was falling so heavily that we could not see more than
a few score yards ahead, and I decided not to strike camp.
A path over the shattered floes would be hard to find, and to
get the boats into a position of peril might be disastrous.
Rickenson and Worsley started back for Dump Camp at 7 a.m.
to get some wood and blubber for the fire, and an hour later
we had hoosh, with one biscuit each. At 10 a.m. Hurley and
Hudson left for the old camp in order to bring some additional
dog-pemmican, since there were no seals to be found near us.
Then, as the weather cleared, Worsley and I made a prospect to
the west and tried to find a practicable road. A large floe
offered a fairly good road for at least another mile to the
north-west, and we went back prepared for another move. The
weather cleared a little, and after lunch we struck camp.
I took Rickenson, Kerr, Wordie, and Hudson as a breakdown gang
to pioneer a path among the pressure-ridges. Five dog teams
followed. Wild’s and Hurley’s teams were hitched on to the
cutter and they started off in splendid style. They needed
to be helped only once; indeed fourteen dogs did as well or
even better than eighteen men. The ice was moving beneath
and around us as we worked towards the big floe, and where
this floe met the smaller ones there was a mass of pressed-up
ice, still in motion, with water between the ridges. But it is
wonderful what a dozen men can do with picks and shovels.
We could cut a road through a pressure-ridge about 14 ft. high
in ten minutes and leave a smooth, or comparatively smooth,
path for the sledges and teams.
OCEAN CAMP
In spite of the wet, deep snow and the halts occasioned by thus
having to cut our road through the pressure-ridges, we managed
to march the best part of a mile towards our goal, though the
relays and the deviations again made the actual distance
travelled nearer six miles. As I could see that the men were
all exhausted I gave the order to pitch the tents under the
lee of the two boats, which afforded some slight protection from
the wet snow now threatening to cover everything. While so
engaged one of the sailors discovered a small pool of water,
caused by the snow having thawed on a sail which was lying
in one of the boats. There was not much—just a sip each;
but, as one man wrote in his diary, “One has seen and tasted
cleaner, but seldom more opportunely found water.”
Next day broke cold and still with the same wet snow, and in the
clearing light I could see that with the present loose surface,
and considering how little result we had to show for all our
strenuous efforts of the past four days, it would be impossible
to proceed for any great distance. Taking into account also
the possibility of leads opening close to us, and so of our being
able to row north-west to where we might find land, I decided to
find a more solid floe and there camp until conditions were more
favourable for us to make a second attempt to escape from our icy
prison. To this end we moved our tents and all our gear to a thick,
heavy old floe about one and a half miles from the wreck and there
made our camp. We called this “Ocean Camp.” It was with the utmost
difficulty that we shifted our two boats. The surface was
terrible—like nothing that any of us had ever seen around us
before. We were sinking at times up to our hips, and everywhere
the snow was two feet deep.
I decided to conserve our valuable sledging rations, which would be
so necessary for the inevitable boat journey, as much as possible,
and to subsist almost entirely on seals and penguins.
A party was sent back to Dump Camp, near the ship, to collect as
much clothing, tobacco, etc., as they could find. The heavy snow
which had fallen in the last few days, combined with the thawing
and consequent sinking of the surface, resulted in the total
disappearance of a good many of the things left behind at this
dump. The remainder of the men made themselves as comfortable as
possible under the circumstances at Ocean Camp. This floating lump
of ice, about a mile square at first but later splitting into
smaller and smaller fragments, was to be our home for nearly two
months. During these two months we made frequent visits to the
vicinity of the ship and retrieved much valuable clothing and food
and some few articles of personal value which in our light-hearted
optimism we had thought to leave miles behind us on our dash across
the moving ice to safety.
The collection of food was now the all-important consideration.
As we were to subsist almost entirely on seals and penguins, which
were to provide fuel as well as food, some form of blubber-stove
was a necessity. This was eventually very ingeniously contrived
from the ship’s steel ash-shoot, as our first attempt with a large
iron oil-drum did not prove eminently successful. We could only
cook seal or penguin hooshes or stews on this stove, and so
uncertain was its action that the food was either burnt or only
partially cooked; and, hungry though we were, half-raw seal meat
was not very appetizing. On one occasion a wonderful stew made
from seal meat, with two or three tins of Irish stew that had been
salved from the ship, fell into the fire through the bottom of the
oil-drum that we used as a saucepan becoming burnt out on account
of the sudden intense heat of the fire below. We lunched that day
on one biscuit and a quarter of a tin of bully-beef each, frozen
hard.
This new stove, which was to last us during our stay at Ocean Camp,
was a great success. Two large holes were punched, with much
labour and few tools, opposite one another at the wider or top end
of the shoot. Into one of these an oil-drum was fixed, to be used
as the fireplace, the other hole serving to hold our saucepan.
Alongside this another hole was punched to enable two saucepans
to be boiled at a time; and farther along still a chimney made
from biscuit-tins completed a very efficient, if not a very elegant,
stove. Later on the cook found that he could bake a sort of flat
bannock or scone on this stove, but he was seriously hampered for
want of yeast or baking-powder.
An attempt was next made to erect some sort of a galley to protect
the cook against the inclemencies of the weather. The party which
I had sent back under Wild to the ship returned with, amongst other
things, the wheel-house practically complete. This, with the
addition of some sails and tarpaulins stretched on spars, made a
very comfortable storehouse and galley. Pieces of planking from
the deck were lashed across some spars stuck upright into the snow,
and this, with the ship’s binnacle, formed an excellent look-out
from which to look for seals and penguins. On this platform, too,
a mast was erected from which flew the King’s flag and the Royal
Clyde Yacht Club burgee.
I made a strict inventory of all the food in our possession,
weights being roughly determined with a simple balance made from
a piece of wood and some string, the counter-weight being a 60-lb.
box of provisions.
The dog teams went off to the wreck early each morning under Wild,
and the men made every effort to rescue as much as possible from
the ship. This was an extremely difficult task as the whole of
the deck forward was under a foot of water on the port side, and
nearly three feet on the starboard side. However, they managed
to collect large quantities of wood and ropes and some few cases
of provisions. Although the galley was under water, Bakewell
managed to secure three or four saucepans, which later proved
invaluable acquisitions. Quite a number of boxes of flour, etc.,
had been stowed in a cabin in the hold, and these we had been
unable to get out before we left the ship. Having, therefore,
determined as nearly as possible that portion of the deck
immediately above these cases, we proceeded to cut a hole with
large ice-chisels through the 3-in. planking of which it was
formed. As the ship at this spot was under 5 ft. of water and
ice, it was not an easy job. However, we succeeded in making
the hole sufficiently large to allow of some few cases to come
floating up. These were greeted with great satisfaction, and
later on, as we warmed to our work, other cases, whose upward
progress was assisted with a boat-hook, were greeted with either
cheers or groans according to whether they contained farinaceous
food or merely luxuries such as jellies. For each man by now
had a good idea of the calorific value and nutritive and
sustaining qualities of the various foods. It had a personal
interest for us all. In this way we added to our scanty
stock between two and three tons of provisions, about half of
which was farinaceous food, such as flour and peas, of which we
were so short. This sounds a great deal, but at one pound per day
it would only last twenty-eight men for three months. Previous to
this I had reduced the food allowance to nine and a half ounces per
man per day. Now, however, it could be increased, and “this
afternoon, for the first time for ten days, we knew what it was to
be really satisfied.”
I had the sledges packed in readiness with the special sledging
rations in case of a sudden move, and with the other food, allowing
also for prospective seals and penguins, I calculated a dietary
to give the utmost possible variety and yet to use our precious
stock of flour in the most economical manner. All seals and
penguins that appeared anywhere within the vicinity of the camp
were killed to provide food and fuel. The dog-pemmican we also
added to our own larder, feeding the dogs on the seals which we
caught, after removing such portions as were necessary for our
own needs. We were rather short of crockery, but small pieces
of venesta-wood served admirably as plates for seal steaks; stews
and liquids of all sorts were served in the aluminium sledging-mugs,
of which each man had one. Later on, jelly-tins and
biscuit-tin lids were pressed into service.
Monotony in the meals, even considering the circumstances in
which we found ourselves, was what I was striving to avoid, so
our little stock of luxuries, such as fish-paste, tinned herrings,
etc., was carefully husbanded and so distributed as to last as
long as possible. My efforts were not in vain, as one man states
in his diary: “It must be admitted that we are feeding very well
indeed, considering our position. Each meal consists of one course
and a beverage. The dried vegetables, if any, all go into the same
pot as the meat, and every dish is a sort of hash or stew, be it
ham or seal meat or half and half. The fact that we only have two
pots available places restrictions upon the number of things that
can be cooked at one time, but in spite of the limitation of
facilities, we always seem to manage to get just enough. The
milk-powder and sugar are necessarily boiled with the tea or cocoa.
“We are, of course, very short of the farinaceous element in our
diet, and consequently have a mild craving for more of it. Bread
is out of the question, and as we are husbanding the remaining
cases of our biscuits for our prospective boat journey, we are
eking out the supply of flour by making bannocks, of which we
have from three to four each day. These bannocks are made from
flour, fat, water, salt, and a little baking-powder, the dough
being rolled out into flat rounds and baked in about ten minutes on
a hot sheet of iron over the fire. Each bannock weighs about one
and a half to two ounces, and we are indeed lucky to be able to
produce them.”
A few boxes of army biscuits soaked with sea-water were
distributed at one meal. They were in such a state that they
would not have been looked at a second time under ordinary
circumstances, but to us on a floating lump of ice, over three
hundred miles from land, and that quite hypothetical, and with the
unplumbed sea beneath us, they were luxuries indeed. Wild’s tent
made a pudding of theirs with some dripping.
Although keeping in mind the necessity for strict economy with
our scanty store of food, I knew how important it was to keep the
men cheerful, and that the depression occasioned by our
surroundings and our precarious position could to some extent be
alleviated by increasing the rations, at least until we were more
accustomed to our new mode of life. That this was successful is
shown in their diaries.
“Day by day goes by much the same as one another. We work; we
talk; we eat. Ah, how we eat! No longer on short rations, we are
a trifle more exacting than we were when we first commenced our
‘simple life,’ but by comparison with home standards we are
positive barbarians, and our gastronomic rapacity knows no bounds.
“All is eaten that comes to each tent, and everything is most
carefully and accurately divided into as many equal portions as
there are men in the tent. One member then closes his eyes or
turns his head away and calls out the names at random, as the cook
for the day points to each portion, saying at the same
time, ‘Whose?’
“Partiality, however unintentional it may be, is thus entirely
obviated and every one feels satisfied that all is fair, even
though one may look a little enviously at the next man’s helping,
which differs in some especially appreciated detail from one’s
own. We break the Tenth Commandment energetically, but as we are
all in the same boat in this respect, no one says a word. We
understand each other’s feelings quite sympathetically.
“It is just like school-days over again, and very jolly it is too,
for the time being!”
Later on, as the prospect of wintering in the pack became more
apparent, the rations had to be considerably reduced. By that
time, however, everybody had become more accustomed to the idea
and took it quite as a matter of course.
Our meals now consisted in the main of a fairly generous helping
of seal or penguin, either boiled or fried. As one man wrote:
“We are now having enough to eat, but not by any means too much;
and every one is always hungry enough to eat every scrap he can
get. Meals are invariably taken very seriously, and little
talking is done till the hoosh is finished.”
Our tents made somewhat cramped quarters, especially during
meal-times.
“Living in a tent without any furniture requires a little getting
used to. For our meals we have to sit on the floor, and it is
surprising how awkward it is to eat in such a position; it is
better by far to kneel and sit back on one’s heels, as do the
Japanese.”
Each man took it in turn to be the tent “cook” for one day,
and one writes:
“The word ‘cook’ is at present rather a misnomer, for whilst we
have a permanent galley no cooking need be done in the tent.
“Really, all that the tent cook has to do is to take his two
hoosh-pots over to the galley and convey the hoosh and the
beverage to the tent, clearing up after each meal and washing up
the two pots and the mugs. There are no spoons, etc., to wash, for
we each keep our own spoon and pocket-knife in our pockets. We
just lick them as clean as possible and replace them in our pockets
after each meal.
“Our spoons are one of our indispensable possessions here.
To lose one’s spoon would be almost as serious as it is for an
edentate person to lose his set of false teeth.”
During all this time the supply of seals and penguins, if not
inexhaustible, was always sufficient for our needs.
Seal- and penguin-hunting was our daily occupation, and parties
were sent out in different directions to search among the hummocks
and the pressure-ridges for them. When one was found a signal was
hoisted, usually in the form of a scarf or a sock on a pole, and
an answering signal was hoisted at the camp.
Then Wild went out with a dog team to shoot and bring in the
game. To feed ourselves and the dogs, at least one seal a day was
required. The seals were mostly crab-eaters, and emperor penguins
were the general rule. On November 5, however, an adelie was
caught, and this was the cause of much discussion, as the following
extract shows: “The man on watch from 3 a.m. to 4 a.m. caught
an adelie penguin. This is the first of its kind that we have seen
since January last, and it may mean a lot. It may signify that
there is land somewhere near us, or else that great leads are
opening up, but it is impossible to form more than a mere
conjecture at present.”
No skuas, Antarctic petrels, or sea-leopards were seen during our
two months’ stay at Ocean Camp.
In addition to the daily hunt for food, our time was passed in
reading the few books that we had managed to save from the ship.
The greatest treasure in the library was a portion of the
“Encyclopaedia Britannica.” This was being continually used
to settle the inevitable arguments that would arise. The sailors
were discovered one day engaged in a very heated discussion on
the subject of Money and Exchange. They finally came to the
conclusion that the Encyclopaedia, since it did not coincide with
their views, must be wrong.
“For descriptions of every American town that ever has been, is,
or ever will be, and for full and complete biographies of every
American statesman since the time of George Washington and long
before, the Encyclopaedia would be hard to beat. Owing to our
shortage of matches we have been driven to use it for purposes
other than the purely literary ones though; and one genius
having discovered that the paper, used for its pages had been
impregnated with saltpetre, we can now thoroughly recommend it
as a very efficient pipe-lighter.”
We also possessed a few books on Antarctic exploration, a copy of
Browning and one of “The Ancient Mariner.” On reading the latter,
we sympathized with him and wondered what he had done with the
albatross; it would have made a very welcome addition to our
larder.
The two subjects of most interest to us were our rate of drift
and the weather. Worsley took observations of the sun whenever
possible, and his results showed conclusively that the drift of
our floe was almost entirely dependent upon the winds and not much
affected by currents. Our hope, of course, was to drift
northwards to the edge of the pack and then, when the ice was
loose enough, to take to the boats and row to the nearest land.
We started off in fine style, drifting north about twenty miles
in two or three days in a howling south-westerly blizzard.
Gradually, however, we slowed up, as successive observations showed,
until we began to drift back to the south. An increasing north-easterly
wind, which commenced on November 7 and lasted for twelve
days, damped our spirits for a time, until we found that we had
only drifted back to the south three miles, so that we were now
seventeen miles to the good. This tended to reassure us in our
theories that the ice of the Weddell Sea was drifting round in
a clockwise direction, and that if we could stay on our piece
long enough we must eventually be taken up to the north, where
lay the open sea and the path to comparative safety.
The ice was not moving fast enough to be noticeable. In fact,
the only way in which we could prove that we were moving at all
was by noting the change of relative positions of the bergs around
us, and, more definitely, by fixing our absolute latitude and
longitude by observations of the sun. Otherwise, as far as
actual visible drift was concerned, we might have been on dry
land.
For the next few days we made good progress, drifting seven miles
to the north on November 24 and another seven miles in the next
forty-eight hours. We were all very pleased to know that although
the wind was mainly south-west all this time, yet we had made very
little easting. The land lay to the west, so had we drifted to
the east we should have been taken right away to the centre of the
entrance to the Weddell Sea, and our chances of finally reaching
land would have been considerably lessened.
Our average rate of drift was slow, and many and varied were the
calculations as to when we should reach the pack-edge. On December
12, 1915, one man wrote: “Once across the Antarctic Circle, it
will seem as if we are practically halfway home again; and it is
just possible that with favourable winds we may cross the circle
before the New Year. A drift of only three miles a day would do
it, and we have often done that and more for periods of three or
four weeks.
“We are now only 250 miles from Paulet Island, but too much to
the east of it. We are approaching the latitudes in which we were
at this time last year, on our way down. The ship left South
Georgia just a year and a week ago, and reached this latitude four
or five miles to the eastward of our present position on January
3, 1915, crossing the circle on New Year’s Eve.”
Thus, after a year’s incessant battle with the ice, we had
returned, by many strange turns of fortune’s wheel, to almost
identically the same latitude that we had left with such high
hopes and aspirations twelve months previously; but under what
different conditions now! Our ship crushed and lost, and we
ourselves drifting on a piece of ice at the mercy of the winds.
However, in spite of occasional setbacks due to unfavourable winds,
our drift was in the main very satisfactory, and this went a long
way towards keeping the men cheerful.
As the drift was mostly affected by the winds, the weather was
closely watched by all, and Hussey, the meteorologist, was called
upon to make forecasts every four hours, and some times more
frequently than that. A meteorological screen, containing
thermometers and a barograph, had been erected on a post frozen
into the ice, and observations were taken every four hours. When
we first left the ship the weather was cold and miserable, and
altogether as unpropitious as it could possibly have been for our
attempted march. Our first few days at Ocean Camp were passed
under much the same conditions. At nights the temperature dropped
to zero, with blinding snow and drift. One-hour watches were
instituted, all hands taking their turn, and in such weather
this job was no sinecure. The watchman had to be continually
on the alert for cracks in the ice, or any sudden changes in
the ice conditions, and also had to keep his eye on the dogs,
who often became restless, fretful, and quarrelsome in the
early hours of the morning. At the end of his hour he was
very glad to crawl back into the comparative warmth of
his frozen sleeping-bag.
On November 6 a dull, overcast day developed into a howling
blizzard from the south-west, with snow and low drift. Only those
who were compelled left the shelter of their tent. Deep drifts
formed everywhere, burying sledges and provisions to a depth of
two feet, and the snow piling up round the tents threatened to
burst the thin fabric. The fine drift found its way in through
the ventilator of the tent, which was accordingly plugged up with
a spare sock.
This lasted for two days, when one man wrote: “The blizzard
continued through the morning, but cleared towards noon, and it
was a beautiful evening; but we would far rather have the screeching
blizzard with its searching drift and cold damp wind, for we
drifted about eleven miles to the north during the night.”
For four days the fine weather continued, with gloriously warm,
bright sun, but cold when standing still or in the shade. The
temperature usually dropped below zero, but every opportunity
was taken during these fine, sunny days to partially dry
our sleeping-bags and other gear, which had become sodden through
our body-heat having thawed the snow which had drifted in on to
them during the blizzard. The bright sun seemed to put new heart
into all.
The next day brought a north-easterly wind with the very high
temperature of 27° Fahr.—only 5° below freezing.
“These high temperatures do not always represent the warmth which
might be assumed from the thermometrical readings. They usually
bring dull, overcast skies, with a raw, muggy, moisture-laden wind.
The winds from the south, though colder, are nearly always coincident
with sunny days and clear blue skies.”
The temperature still continued to rise, reaching 33° Fahr.
on November 14. The thaw consequent upon these high temperatures
was having a disastrous effect upon the surface of our camp. “The
surface is awful!—not slushy, but elusive. You step out
gingerly. All is well for a few paces, then your foot suddenly
sinks a couple of feet until it comes to a hard layer. You wade
along in this way step by step, like a mudlark at Portsmouth
Hard, hoping gradually to regain the surface. Soon you do, only
to repeat the exasperating performance ad lib., to the
accompaniment of all the expletives that you can bring to bear on
the subject. What actually happens is that the warm air melts the
surface sufficiently to cause drops of water to trickle down
slightly, where, on meeting colder layers of snow, they freeze
again, forming a honeycomb of icy nodules instead of the soft,
powdery, granular snow that we are accustomed to.”
These high temperatures persisted for some days, and when, as
occasionally happened, the sky was clear and the sun was shining
it was unbearably hot. Five men who were sent to fetch some gear
from the vicinity of the ship with a sledge marched in nothing but
trousers and singlet, and even then were very hot; in fact they
were afraid of getting sunstroke, so let down flaps from their caps
to cover their necks. Their sleeves were rolled up over their
elbows, and their arms were red and sunburnt in consequence.
The temperature on this occasion was 26° Fahr., or 6°
below freezing. For five or six days more the sun continued, and
most of our clothes and sleeping-bags were now comparatively dry.
A wretched day with rainy sleet set in on November 21, but one
could put up with this discomfort as the wind was now from the
south.
The wind veered later to the west, and the sun came out at 9 p.m.
For at this time, near the end of November, we had the midnight
sun. “A thrice-blessed southerly wind” soon arrived to cheer us
all, occasioning the following remarks in one of the diaries:
“To-day is the most beautiful day we have had in the Antarctic—a
clear sky, a gentle, warm breeze from the south, and the most
brilliant sunshine. We all took advantage of it to strike tents,
clean out, and generally dry and air ground-sheets and sleeping-bags.”
I was up early—4 a.m.—to keep watch, and the sight was indeed
magnificent. Spread out before one was an extensive panorama of
ice-fields, intersected here and there by small broken leads,
and dotted with numerous noble bergs, partly bathed in sunshine
and partly tinged with the grey shadows of an overcast sky.
As one watched one observed a distinct line of demarcation between
the sunshine and the shade, and this line gradually approached
nearer and nearer, lighting up the hummocky relief of the ice-field
bit by bit, until at last it reached us, and threw the whole camp
into a blaze of glorious sunshine which lasted nearly all day.
“This afternoon we were treated to one or two showers of hail-like
snow. Yesterday we also had a rare form of snow, or, rather,
precipitation of ice-spicules, exactly like little hairs, about a
third of an inch long.
“The warmth in the tents at lunch-time was so great that we had
all the side-flaps up for ventilation, but it is a treat to get
warm occasionally, and one can put up with a little stuffy
atmosphere now and again for the sake of it. The wind has
gone to the best quarter this evening, the south-east, and
is freshening.”
On these fine, clear, sunny days wonderful mirage effects could be
observed, just as occur over the desert. Huge bergs were
apparently resting on nothing, with a distinct gap between their
bases and the horizon; others were curiously distorted into all
sorts of weird and fantastic shapes, appearing to be many times
their proper height. Added to this, the pure glistening white of
the snow and ice made a picture which it is impossible adequately
to describe.
Later on, the freshening south-westerly wind brought mild,
overcast weather, probably due to the opening up of the pack in
that direction.
I had already made arrangements for a quick move in case of a
sudden break-up of the ice. Emergency orders were issued; each
man had his post allotted and his duty detailed; and the whole
was so organized that in less than five minutes from the sounding
of the alarm on my whistle, tents were struck, gear and provisions
packed, and the whole party was ready to move off. I now took a
final survey of the men to note their condition, both mental and
physical. For our time at Ocean Camp had not been one of unalloyed
bliss. The loss of the ship meant more to us than we could ever
put into words. After we had settled at Ocean Camp she still
remained nipped by the ice, only her stern showing and her bows
overridden and buried by the relentless pack. The tangled mass of
ropes, rigging, and spars made the scene even more desolate and
depressing.
It was with a feeling almost of relief that the end came.
“November 21, 1915.—This evening, as we were lying in our tents
we heard the Boss call out, ‘She’s going, boys!’ We were out in a
second and up on the look-out station and other points of vantage,
and, sure enough, there was our poor ship a mile and a half away
struggling in her death-agony. She went down bows first, her stern
raised in the air. She then gave one quick dive and the ice closed
over her for ever. It gave one a sickening sensation to see it,
for, mastless and useless as she was, she seemed to be a link with
the outer world. Without her our destitution seems more
emphasized, our desolation more complete. The loss of the ship
sent a slight wave of depression over the camp. No one said much,
but we cannot be blamed for feeling it in a sentimental way. It
seemed as if the moment of severance from many cherished associations,
many happy moments, even stirring incidents, had come as she silently
up-ended to find a last resting-place beneath the ice on which we
now stand. When one knows every little nook and corner of one’s
ship as we did, and has helped her time and again in the fight
that she made so well, the actual parting was not without its
pathos, quite apart from one’s own desolation, and I doubt if there
was one amongst us who did not feel some personal emotion when Sir
Ernest, standing on the top of the look-out, said somewhat sadly
and quietly, ‘She’s gone, boys.’
“It must, however, be said that we did not give way to depression
for long, for soon every one was as cheery as usual. Laughter
rang out from the tents, and even the Boss had a passage-at-arms
with the storekeeper over the inadequacy of the sausage ration,
insisting that there should be two each ‘because they were such
little ones,’ instead of the one and a half that the latter
proposed.”
The psychological effect of a slight increase in the rations soon
neutralized any tendency to downheartedness, but with the high
temperatures surface-thaw set in, and our bags and clothes were
soaked and sodden. Our boots squelched as we walked, and we lived
in a state of perpetual wet feet. At nights, before the
temperature had fallen, clouds of steam could be seen rising from
our soaking bags and boots. During the night, as it grew colder,
this all condensed as rime on the inside of the tent, and showered
down upon us if one happened to touch the side inadvertently. One
had to be careful how one walked, too, as often only a thin crust
of ice and snow covered a hole in the floe, through which many an
unwary member went in up to his waist. These perpetual soakings,
however, seemed to have had little lasting effect, or perhaps it
was not apparent owing to the excitement of the prospect of an
early release.
A north-westerly wind on December 7 and 8 retarded our progress
somewhat, but I had reason to believe that it would help to open
the ice and form leads through which we might escape to open water.
So I ordered a practice launching of the boats and stowage of food
and stores in them. This was very satisfactory. We cut a slipway
from our floe into a lead which ran alongside, and the boats took
the water “like a bird,” as one sailor remarked. Our hopes were
high in anticipation of an early release. A blizzard sprang up,
increasing the next day and burying tents and packing-cases in the
drift. On December 12 it had moderated somewhat and veered to the
south-east, and the next day the blizzard had ceased, but a good
steady wind from south and south-west continued to blow us north.
“December 15, 1915.—The continuance of southerly winds is
exceeding our best hopes, and raising our spirits in proportion.
Prospects could not be brighter than they are just now. The
environs of our floe are continually changing. Some days we are
almost surrounded by small open leads, preventing us from crossing
over to the adjacent floes.”
After two more days our fortune changed, and a strong north-easterly
wind brought “a beastly cold, windy day” and drove us back three
and a quarter miles. Soon, however, the wind once more veered to
the south and south-west. These high temperatures, combined with
the strong changeable winds that we had had of late, led me to
conclude that the ice all around us was rotting and breaking up
and that the moment of our deliverance from the icy maw of the
Antarctic was at hand.
On December 20, after discussing the question with Wild, I
informed all hands that I intended to try and make a march to
the west to reduce the distance between us and Paulet Island.
A buzz of pleasurable anticipation went round the camp, and every
one was anxious to get on the move. So the next day I set off
with Wild, Crean, and Hurley, with dog teams, to the westward to
survey the route. After travelling about seven miles we mounted
a small berg, and there as far as we could see stretched a series
of immense flat floes from half a mile to a mile across, separated
from each other by pressure-ridges which seemed easily negotiable
with pick and shovel. The only place that appeared likely to be
formidable was a very much cracked-up area between the old floe
that we were on and the first of the series of young flat floes
about half a mile away.
December 22 was therefore kept as Christmas Day, and most of our
small remaining stock of luxuries was consumed at the Christmas
feast. We could not carry it all with us, so for the last time
for eight months we had a really good meal—as much as we could
eat. Anchovies in oil, baked beans, and jugged hare made a
glorious mixture such as we have not dreamed of since our
school-days. Everybody was working at high pressure, packing and
repacking sledges and stowing what provisions we were going to take
with us in the various sacks and boxes. As I looked round at the
eager faces of the men I could not but hope that this time the
fates would be kinder to us than in our last attempt to march
across the ice to safety.
THE MARCH BETWEEN
With the exception of the night-watchman we turned in at 11 p.m.,
and at 3 a.m. on December 23 all hands were roused for the purpose
of sledging the two boats, the James Caird and the Dudley Docker,
over the dangerously cracked portion to the first of the young
floes, whilst the surface still held its night crust. A thick
sea-fog came up from the west, so we started off finally at
4.30 a.m., after a drink of hot coffee.
Practically all hands had to be harnessed to each boat in
succession, and by dint of much careful manipulation and
tortuous courses amongst the broken ice we got both safely
over the danger-zone.
We then returned to Ocean Camp for the tents and the rest of the
sledges, and pitched camp by the boats about one and a quarter
miles off. On the way back a big seal was caught which provided
fresh food for ourselves and for the dogs. On arrival at the camp
a supper of cold tinned mutton and tea was served, and everybody
turned in at 2 p.m. It was my intention to sleep by day and
march by night, so as to take advantage of the slightly lower
temperatures and consequent harder surfaces.
At 8 p.m. the men were roused, and after a meal of cold mutton and
tea, the march was resumed. A large open lead brought us to a halt
at 11 p.m., whereupon we camped and turned in without a meal.
Fortunately just at this time the weather was fine and warm.
Several men slept out in the open at the beginning of the march.
One night, however, a slight snow-shower came on, succeeded
immediately by a lowering of the temperature. Worsley, who had
hung up his trousers and socks on a boat, found them iced-up and
stiff; and it was quite a painful process for him to dress
quickly that morning. I was anxious, now that we had started,
that we should make every effort to extricate ourselves, and
this temporary check so early was rather annoying. So that
afternoon Wild and I ski-ed out to the crack and found that
it had closed up again. We marked out the track with small
flags as we returned. Each day, after all hands had turned
in, Wild and I would go ahead for two miles or so to reconnoitre
the next day’s route, marking it with pieces of wood, tins,
and small flags. We had to pick the road which though it
might be somewhat devious, was flattest and had least hummocks.
Pressure-ridges had to be skirted, and where this was not
possible the best place to make a bridge of ice-blocks
across the lead or over the ridge had to be found and marked.
It was the duty of the dog-drivers to thus prepare the track
for those who were toiling behind with the heavy boats.
These boats were hauled in relays, about sixty yards at a
time. I did not wish them to be separated by too great a
distance in case the ice should crack between them, and we
should be unable to reach the one that was in rear. Every
twenty yards or so they had to stop for a rest and to take
breath, and it was a welcome sight to them to see the canvas
screen go up on some oars, which denoted the fact that the
cook had started preparing a meal, and that a temporary
halt, at any rate, was going to be made. Thus the ground
had to be traversed three times by the boat-hauling party.
The dog-sledges all made two, and some of them three, relays.
The dogs were wonderful. Without them we could never have
transported half the food and gear that we did.
We turned in at 7 p.m. that night, and at 1 a.m. next day, the
25th, and the third day of our march, a breakfast of sledging
ration was served. By 2 a.m. we were on the march again. We
wished one another a merry Christmas, and our thoughts went back
to those at home. We wondered, too, that day, as we sat down to
our “lunch” of stale, thin bannock and a mug of thin cocoa,
what they were having at home.
All hands were very cheerful. The prospect of a relief from the
monotony of life on the floe raised all our spirits. One man
wrote in his diary: “It’s a hard, rough, jolly life, this
marching and camping; no washing of self or dishes, no undressing,
no changing of clothes. We have our food anyhow, and always
impregnated with blubber-smoke; sleeping almost on the bare snow
and working as hard as the human physique is capable of doing
on a minimum of food.”
We marched on, with one halt at 6 a.m., till half-past eleven.
After a supper of seal steaks and tea we turned in. The surface
now was pretty bad. High temperatures during the day made the
upper layers of snow very soft, and the thin crust which formed at
night was not sufficient to support a man. Consequently, at each
step we went in over our knees in the soft wet snow. Sometimes a
man would step into a hole in the ice which was hidden by the
covering of snow, and be pulled up with a jerk by his harness.
The sun was very hot and many were suffering from cracked lips.
Two seals were killed to-day. Wild and McIlroy, who went out
to secure them, had rather an exciting time on some very loose,
rotten ice, three killer-whales in a lead a few yards away poking
up their ugly heads as if in anticipation of a feast.
Next day, December 26, we started off again at 1 a.m. “The
surface was much better than it has been for the last few days,
and this is the principal thing that matters. The route, however,
lay over very hummocky floes, and required much work with pick and
shovel to make it passable for the boat-sledges. These are
handled in relays by eighteen men under Worsley. It is killing
work on soft surfaces.”
At 5 a.m. we were brought up by a wide open lead after an
unsatisfactorily short march. While we waited, a meal of tea and
two small bannocks was served, but as 10 a.m. came and there were
no signs of the lead closing we all turned in.
It snowed a little during the day and those who were sleeping
outside got their sleeping-bags pretty wet.
At 9.30 p.m. that night we were off again. I was, as usual,
pioneering in front, followed by the cook and his mate pulling
a small sledge with the stove and all the cooking gear on. These
two, black as two Mohawk Minstrels with the blubber-soot, were
dubbed “Potash and Perlmutter.” Next come the dog teams, who
soon overtake the cook, and the two boats bring up the rear.
Were it not for these cumbrous boats we should get along at a
great rate, but we dare not abandon them on any account. As it
is we left one boat, the Stancomb Wills, behind at Ocean Camp,
and the remaining two will barely accommodate the whole party
when we leave the floe.
We did a good march of one and a half miles that night before we
halted for “lunch” at 1 a.m., and then on for another mile, when
at 5 a.m. we camped by a little sloping berg.
Blackie, one of Wild’s dogs, fell lame and could neither pull nor
keep up with the party even when relieved of his harness, so had
to be shot.
Nine p.m. that night, the 27th, saw us on the march again. The
first 200 yds. took us about five hours to cross, owing to the
amount of breaking down of pressure-ridges and filling in of leads
that was required. The surface, too, was now very soft, so our
progress was slow and tiring. We managed to get another three-quarters
of a mile before lunch, and a further mile due west
over a very hummocky floe before we camped at 5.30 a.m.
Greenstreet and Macklin killed and brought in a huge Weddell seal
weighing about 800 lbs., and two emperor penguins made a welcome
addition to our larder.
I climbed a small tilted berg nearby. The country immediately
ahead was much broken up. Great open leads intersected the floes
at all angles, and it all looked very unpromising. Wild and I
went out prospecting as usual, but it seemed too broken to travel
over.
“December 29.—After a further reconnaissance the ice ahead proved
quite un-negotiable, so at 8.30 p.m. last night, to the intense
disappointment of all, instead of forging ahead, we had to retire
half a mile so as to get on a stronger floe, and by 10 p.m. we
had camped and all hands turned in again. The extra sleep was much
needed, however disheartening the check may be.”
During the night a crack formed right across the floe, so we
hurriedly shifted to a strong old floe about a mile and a half to
the east of our present position. The ice all around was now too
broken and soft to sledge over, and yet there was not sufficient
open water to allow us to launch the boats with any degree of
safety. We had been on the march for seven days; rations were
short and the men were weak. They were worn out with the hard
pulling over soft surfaces, and our stock of sledging food was
very small. We had marched seven and a half miles in a direct
line and at this rate it would take us over three hundred days
to reach the land away to the west. As we only had food for
forty-two days there was no alternative, therefore, but to camp
once more on the floe and to possess our souls with what patience
we could till conditions should appear more favourable for a
renewal of the attempt to escape. To this end, we stacked our
surplus provisions, the reserve sledging rations being kept lashed
on the sledges, and brought what gear we could from our but lately
deserted Ocean Camp.
Our new home, which we were to occupy for nearly three and a half
months, we called “Patience Camp.”
PATIENCE CAMP
The apathy which seemed to take possession of some of the men at
the frustration of their hopes was soon dispelled. Parties were
sent out daily in different directions to look for seals and
penguins. We had left, other than reserve sledging rations,
about 110 lbs. of pemmican, including the dog-pemmican, and 300 lbs.
of flour. In addition there was a little tea, sugar, dried
vegetables, and suet. I sent Hurley and Macklin to Ocean Camp
to bring back the food that we had had to leave there. They
returned with quite a good load, including 130 lbs. of dry milk,
about 50 lbs. each of dog-pemmican and jam, and a few tins of
potted meats. When they were about a mile and a half away
their voices were quite audible to us at Ocean Camp, so still
was the air.
We were, of course, very short of the farinaceous element in
our diet. The flour would last ten weeks. After that our
sledging rations would last us less than three months. Our
meals had to consist mainly of seal and penguin; and though this
was valuable as an anti-scorbutic, so much so that not a single
case of scurvy occurred amongst the party, yet it was a badly
adjusted diet, and we felt rather weak and enervated in consequence.
“The cook deserves much praise for the way he has stuck to
his job through all this severe blizzard. His galley consists
of nothing but a few boxes arranged as a table, with a canvas
screen erected around them on four oars and the two blubber-stoves
within. The protection afforded by the screen is only partial,
and the eddies drive the pungent blubber-smoke in all directions.”
After a few days we were able to build him an igloo of ice-blocks,
with a tarpaulin over the top as a roof.
“Our rations are just sufficient to keep us alive, but we all
feel that we could eat twice as much as we get. An average day’s
food at present consists of ½ lb. of seal with ¾ pint of tea for
breakfast, a 4-oz. bannock with milk for lunch, and ¾ pint of seal
stew for supper. That is barely enough, even doing very little
work as we are, for of course we are completely destitute of bread
or potatoes or anything of that sort. Some seem to feel it more
than others and are continually talking of food; but most of us
find that the continual conversation about food only whets an
appetite that cannot be satisfied. Our craving for bread and
butter is very real, not because we cannot get it, but because
the system feels the need of it.”
Owing to this shortage of food and the fact that we needed all that
we could get for ourselves, I had to order all the dogs except two
teams to be shot. It was the worst job that we had had throughout
the Expedition, and we felt their loss keenly.
I had to be continually rearranging the weekly menu. The
possible number of permutations of seal meat were decidedly
limited. The fact that the men did not know what was coming gave
them a sort of mental speculation, and the slightest variation was
of great value.
“We caught an adelie to-day (January 26) and another whale was
seen at close quarters, but no seals.
“We are now very short of blubber, and in consequence one stove
has to be shut down. We only get one hot beverage a day, the tea
at breakfast. For the rest we have iced water. Sometimes we are
short even of this, so we take a few chips of ice in a tobacco-tin
to bed with us. In the morning there is about a spoonful of water
in the tin, and one has to lie very still all night so as not to
spill it.”
To provide some variety in the food, I commenced to use the
sledging ration at half strength twice a week.
The ice between us and Ocean Camp, now only about five miles away and
actually to the south-west of us, was very broken, but I decided to
send Macklin and Hurley back with their dogs to see if there was any
more food that could be added to our scanty stock. I gave them
written instructions to take no undue risk or cross any wide-open
leads, and said that they were to return by midday the next day.
Although they both fell through the thin ice up to their waists more
than once, they managed to reach the camp. They found the surface
soft and sunk about two feet. Ocean Camp, they said, “looked like a
village that had been razed to the ground and deserted by its
inhabitants.” The floor-boards forming the old tent-bottoms had
prevented the sun from thawing the snow directly underneath them, and
were in consequence raised about two feet above the level of the
surrounding floe.
The storehouse next the galley had taken on a list of several
degrees to starboard, and pools of water had formed everywhere.
They collected what food they could find and packed a few books
in a venesta sledging-case, returning to Patience Camp by about
8 p.m. I was pleased at their quick return, and as their report
seemed to show that the road was favourable, on February 2 I sent
back eighteen men under Wild to bring all the remainder of the food
and the third boat, the Stancomb Wills. They started off at
1 a.m., towing the empty boat-sledge on which the James Caird had
rested, and reached Ocean Camp about 3.30 a.m.
“We stayed about three hours at the Camp, mounting the boat on the
sledge, collecting eatables, clothing, and books. We left at 6
a.m., arriving back at Patience Camp with the boat at 12.30 p.m.,
taking exactly three times as long to return with the boat as it
did to pull in the empty sledge to fetch it. On the return
journey we had numerous halts while the pioneer party of four
were busy breaking down pressure-ridges and filling in open
cracks with ice-blocks, as the leads were opening up. The sun
had softened the surface a good deal, and in places it was
terribly hard pulling. Every one was a bit exhausted by the
time we got back, as we are not now in good training and are
on short rations. Every now and then the heavy sledge broke
through the ice altogether and was practically afloat. We
had an awful job to extricate it, exhausted as we were.
The longest distance which we managed to make without stopping
for leads or pressure-ridges was about three quarters of a mile.
“About a mile from Patience Camp we had a welcome surprise.
Sir Ernest and Hussey sledged out to meet us with dixies of hot
tea, well wrapped up to keep them warm.
“One or two of the men left behind had cut a moderately good track
for us into the camp, and they harnessed themselves up with us,
and we got in in fine style.
“One excellent result of our trip was the recovery of two cases
of lentils weighing 42 lbs. each.”
The next day I sent Macklin and Crean back to make a further
selection of the gear, but they found that several leads had
opened up during the night, and they had to return when within
a mile and a half of their destination. We were never able to
reach Ocean Camp again. Still, there was very little left
there that would have been of use to us.
By the middle of February the blubber question was a serious one.
I had all the discarded seals’ heads and flippers dug up and
stripped of every vestige of blubber. Meat was very short too.
We still had our three months’ supply of sledging food
practically untouched; we were only to use this as a last
resort. We had a small supply of dog-pemmican, the dogs that
were left being fed on those parts of the seals that we could not
use. This dog-pemmican we fried in suet with a little flour and
made excellent bannocks.
Our meat supply was now very low indeed; we were reduced to just
a few scraps. Fortunately, however, we caught two seals and four
emperor penguins, and next day forty adelies. We had now only
forty days’ food left, and the lack of blubber was being keenly
felt. All our suet was used up, so we used seal-blubber to fry
the meat in. Once we were used to its fishy taste we enjoyed it;
in fact, like Oliver Twist, we wanted more.
On Leap Year day, February 29, we held a special celebration,
more to cheer the men up than for anything else. Some of the
cynics of the party held that it was to celebrate their escape
from woman’s wiles for another four years. The last of our
cocoa was used to-day. Henceforth water, with an occasional
drink of weak milk, is to be our only beverage. Three lumps
of sugar were now issued to each man daily.
One night one of the dogs broke loose and played havoc
with our precious stock of bannocks. He ate four and half of
a fifth before he could be stopped. The remaining half, with
the marks of the dog’s teeth on it, I gave to Worsley, who divided
it up amongst his seven tent-mates; they each received about half
a square inch.
Lees, who was in charge of the food and responsible for its
safe keeping, wrote in his diary: “The shorter the provisions the
more there is to do in the commissariat department, contriving to
eke out our slender stores as the weeks pass by. No housewife
ever had more to do than we have in making a little go a long way.
“Writing about the bannock that Peter bit makes one wish now that
one could have many a meal that one has given to the dog at home.
When one is hungry, fastidiousness goes to the winds and one is
only too glad to eat up any scraps regardless of their
antecedents. One is almost ashamed to write of all the titbits
one has picked up here, but it is enough to say that when the
cook upset some pemmican on to an old sooty cloth and threw it
outside his galley, one man subsequently made a point of acquiring
it and scraping off the palatable but dirty compound.”
Another man searched for over an hour in the snow where he had
dropped a piece of cheese some days before, in the hopes of
finding a few crumbs. He was rewarded by coming across a piece
as big as his thumb-nail, and considered it well worth the trouble.
By this time blubber was a regular article of our diet—either raw,
boiled, or fried. “It is remarkable how our appetites have
changed in this respect. Until quite recently almost the thought
of it was nauseating. Now, however, we positively demand it.
The thick black oil which is rendered down from it, rather like
train-oil in appearance and cod-liver oil in taste, we drink with
avidity.”
We had now about enough farinaceous food for two meals all round,
and sufficient seal to last for a month. Our forty days’ reserve
sledging rations, packed on the sledges, we wished to keep till
the last.
But, as one man philosophically remarked in his diary:
“It will do us all good to be hungry like this, for we will
appreciate so much more the good things when we get home.”
Seals and penguins now seemed to studiously avoid us, and on
taking stock of our provisions on March 21 I found that we had
only sufficient meat to last us for ten days, and the blubber
would not last that time even, so one biscuit had to be our
midday meal.
Our meals were now practically all seal meat, with one biscuit at
midday; and I calculated that at this rate, allowing for a certain
number of seals and penguins being caught, we could last for
nearly six months. We were all very weak though, and as soon as
it appeared likely that we should leave our floe and take to the
boats I should have to considerably increase the ration. One day
a huge sea-leopard climbed on to the floe and attacked one of the
men. Wild, hearing the shouting, ran out and shot it. When it was
cut up, we found in its stomach several undigested fish. These we
fried in some of its blubber, and so had our only “fresh” fish
meal during the whole of our drift on the ice.
“As fuel is so scarce we have had to resort to melting ice for
drinking-water in tins against our bodies, and we treat the tins
of dog-pemmican for breakfast similarly by keeping them in our
sleeping-bags all night.
“The last two teams of dogs were shot to-day (April 2) the
carcasses being dressed for food. We had some of the dog-meat
cooked, and it was not at all bad—just like beef, but, of course,
very tough.”
On April 5 we killed two seals, and this, with the sea-leopard
of a few days before, enabled us to slightly increase our ration.
Everybody now felt much happier; such is the psychological
effect of hunger appeased.
On cold days a few strips of raw blubber were served out to all
hands, and it is wonderful how it fortified us against the cold.
Our stock of forty days’ sledging rations remained practically
untouched, but once in the boats they were used at full strength.
When we first settled down at Patience Camp the weather was very
mild. New Year’s Eve, however, was foggy and overcast, with some
snow, and next day, though the temperature rose to 38°
Fahr., it was “abominably cold and wet underfoot.” As a rule,
during the first half of January the weather was comparatively
warm, so much so that we could dispense with our mitts and work
outside for quite long periods with bare hands. Up till the 13th
it was exasperatingly warm and calm. This meant that our drift
northwards, which was almost entirely dependent on the wind, was
checked. A light southerly breeze on the 16th raised all our
hopes, and as the temperature was dropping we were looking forward
to a period of favourable winds and a long drift north.
On the 18th it had developed into a howling south-westerly gale,
rising next day to a regular blizzard with much drift. No one
left the shelter of his tent except to feed the dogs, fetch the
meals from the galley for his tent, or when his turn as watchman
came round. For six days this lasted, when the drift subsided
somewhat, though the southerly wind continued, and we were able
to get a glimpse of the sun. This showed us to have drifted 84
miles north in six days, the longest drift we had made. For weeks
we had remained on the 67th parallel, and it seemed as though some
obstruction was preventing us from passing it. By this amazing
leap, however, we had crossed the Antarctic Circle, and were now
146 miles from the nearest land to the west of us—Snow Hill—and
357 miles from the South Orkneys, the first land directly
to the north of us.
As if to make up for this, an equally strong north-easterly
wind sprang up next day, and not only stopped our northward
drift but set us back three miles to the south. As usual,
high temperatures and wet fog accompanied these northerly winds,
though the fog disappeared on the afternoon of January 25, and
we had the unusual spectacle of bright hot sun with a north-easterly
wind. It was as hot a day as we had ever had.
The temperature was 36° Fahr. in the shade and nearly
80° Fahr. inside the tents. This had an awful effect
on the surface, covering it with pools and making it very
treacherous to walk upon. Ten days of northerly winds rather
damped our spirits, but a strong southerly wind on February 4,
backing later, to south-east, carried us north again. High
temperatures and northerly winds soon succeeded this, so that
our average rate of northerly drift was about a mile a day
in February. Throughout the month the diaries record alternately
“a wet day, overcast and mild,” and “bright and cold with
light southerly winds.” The wind was now the vital factor
with us and the one topic of any real interest.
The beginning of March brought cold, damp, calm weather, with
much wet snow and overcast skies. The effect of the weather on
our mental state was very marked. All hands felt much more cheerful
on a bright sunny day, and looked forward with much more hope to
the future, than when it was dull and overcast. This had a much
greater effect than an increase in rations.
A south-easterly gale on the 13th lasting for five days sent us
twenty miles north, and from now our good fortune, as far as the
wind was concerned, never left us for any length of time. On the
20th we experienced the worst blizzard we had had up to that time,
though worse were to come after landing on Elephant Island. Thick
snow fell, making it impossible to see the camp from thirty yards
off. To go outside for a moment entailed getting covered all over
with fine powdery snow, which required a great deal of brushing
off before one could enter again.
As the blizzard eased up, the temperature dropped and it became
bitterly cold. In our weak condition, with torn, greasy clothes,
we felt these sudden variations in temperature much more than we
otherwise would have done. A calm, clear, magnificently warm day
followed, and next day came a strong southerly blizzard. Drifts
four feet deep covered everything, and we had to be continually
digging up our scanty stock of meat to prevent its being lost
altogether. We had taken advantage of the previous fine day to
attempt to thaw out our blankets, which were frozen stiff and could
be held out like pieces of sheet-iron; but on this day, and for
the next two or three also, it was impossible to do anything but
get right inside one’s frozen sleeping-bag to try and get warm.
Too cold to read or sew, we had to keep our hands well inside,
and pass the time in conversation with each other.
“The temperature was not strikingly low as temperatures go down
here, but the terrific winds penetrate the flimsy fabric of our
fragile tents and create so much draught that it is impossible
to keep warm within. At supper last night our drinking-water
froze over in the tin in the tent before we could drink it.
It is curious how thirsty we all are.”
Two days of brilliant warm sunshine succeeded these cold times,
and on March 29 we experienced, to us, the most amazing weather.
It began to rain hard, and it was the first rain that we had seen
since we left South Georgia sixteen months ago. We regarded, it
as our first touch with civilization, and many of the men longed
for the rain and fogs of London.
Strong south winds with dull, overcast skies and occasional high
temperatures were now our lot till April 7, when the mist lifted
and we could make out what appeared to be land to the north.
Although the general drift of our ice-floe had indicated to us that
we must eventually drift north, our progress in that direction was
not by any means uninterrupted. We were at the mercy of the wind,
and could no more control our drift than we could control the
weather.
A long spell of calm, still weather at the beginning of January
caused us some anxiety by keeping us at about the latitude that
we were in at the beginning of December. Towards the end of
January, however, a long drift of eighty-four miles in a blizzard
cheered us all up. This soon stopped and we began a slight drift
to the east. Our general drift now slowed up considerably, and by
February 22 we were still eighty miles from Paulet Island,
which now was our objective. There was a hut there and some stores
which had been taken down by the ship which went to the rescue of
Nordenskjold’s Expedition in 1904, and whose fitting out and
equipment I had charge of. We remarked amongst ourselves what a
strange turn of fate it would be if the very cases of provisions
which I had ordered and sent out so many years before were now to
support us during the coming winter. But this was not to be.
March 5 found us about forty miles south of the longitude of Paulet
Island, but well to the east of it; and as the ice was still too much
broken up to sledge over, it appeared as if we should be carried
past it. By March 17 we were exactly on a level with Paulet
Island but sixty miles to the east. It might have been six
hundred for all the chance that we had of reaching it by sledging
across the broken sea-ice in its present condition.
Our thoughts now turned to the Danger Islands, thirty-five miles
away. “It seems that we are likely to drift up and down this
coast from south-west to north-east and back again for some time
yet before we finally clear the point of Joinville Island; until
we do we cannot hope for much opening up, as the ice must be very
congested against the south-east coast of the island, otherwise
our failure to respond to the recent south-easterly gale cannot be
well accounted for. In support of this there has been some very
heavy pressure on the north-east side, of our floe, one immense
block being up-ended to a height of 25 ft. We saw a Dominican
gull fly over to-day, the first we have seen since leaving South
Georgia; it is another sign of our proximity to land. We cut
steps in this 25-ft. slab, and it makes a fine look-out. When
the weather clears we confidently expect to see land.”
A heavy blizzard obscured our view till March 23. “‘Land in
sight’ was reported this morning. We were sceptical, but this
afternoon it showed up unmistakably to the west, and there can be
no further doubt about it. It is Joinville Island, and its
serrated mountain ranges, all snow-clad, are just visible on the
horizon. This barren, inhospitable-looking land would be a haven
of refuge to us if we could but reach it. It would be ridiculous
to make the attempt though, with the ice all broken up as it is.
It is too loose and broken to march over, yet not open enough to
be able to launch the boats.” For the next two or three
days we saw ourselves slowly drifting past the land, longing to
reach it yet prevented from doing so by the ice between, and
towards the end of March we saw Mount Haddington fade away into
the distance.
Our hopes were now centred on Elephant Island or Clarence Island,
which lay 100 miles almost due north of us.
If we failed to reach either of them we might try for South
Georgia, but our chances of reaching it would be very small.
ESCAPE FROM THE ICE
On April 7 at daylight the long-desired peak of Clarence Island
came into view, bearing nearly north from our camp. At first it
had the appearance of a huge berg, but with the growing light we
could see plainly the black lines of scree and the high,
precipitous cliffs of the island, which were miraged up to some
extent. The dark rocks in the white snow were a pleasant sight.
So long had our eyes looked on icebergs that apparently grew or
dwindled according to the angles at which the shadows were cast
by the sun; so often had we discovered rocky islands and brought
in sight the peaks of Joinville Land, only to find them, after
some change of wind or temperature, floating away as nebulous
cloud or ordinary berg; that not until Worsley, Wild, and Hurley
had unanimously confirmed my observation was I satisfied that
I was really looking at Clarence Island. The land was still
more than sixty miles away, but it had to our eyes something
of the appearance of home, since we expected to find there
our first solid footing after all the long months of drifting
on the unstable ice. We had adjusted ourselves to the life on
the floe, but our hopes had been fixed all the time on some
possible landing-place. As one hope failed to materialize,
our anticipations fed themselves on another. Our drifting home
had no rudder to guide it, no sail to give it speed. We were
dependent upon the caprice of wind and current; we went
whither those irresponsible forces listed. The longing to
feel solid earth under our feet filled our hearts.
In the full daylight Clarence Island ceased to look like land and
had the appearance of a berg of more than eight or ten miles away,
so deceptive are distances in the clear air of the Antarctic.
The sharp white peaks of Elephant Island showed to the west of
north a little later in the day.
“I have stopped issuing sugar now, and our meals consist of seal
meat and blubber only, with 7 ozs. of dried milk per day for the
party,” I wrote. “Each man receives a pinch of salt, and the
milk is boiled up to make hot drinks for all hands. The diet suits
us, since we cannot get much exercise on the floe and the blubber
supplies heat. Fried slices of blubber seem to our taste to
resemble crisp bacon. It certainly is no hardship to eat it,
though persons living under civilized conditions probably would
shudder at it. The hardship would come if we were unable to get
it.”
I think that the palate of the human animal can adjust itself to
anything. Some creatures will die before accepting a strange diet
if deprived of their natural food. The Yaks of the Himalayan
uplands must feed from the growing grass, scanty and dry though
it may be, and would starve even if allowed the best oats and corn.
“We still have the dark water-sky of the last week with us to the
south-west and west, round to the north-east. We are leaving all
the bergs to the west and there are few within our range of vision
now. The swell is more marked to-day, and I feel sure we are at
the verge of the floe-ice. One strong gale, followed by a calm
would scatter the pack, I think, and then we could push through.
I have been thinking much of our prospects. The appearance of
Clarence Island after our long drift seems, somehow, to convey an
ultimatum. The island is the last outpost of the south and our
final chance of a landing-place. Beyond it lies the broad Atlantic.
Our little boats may be compelled any day now to sail unsheltered
over the open sea with a thousand leagues of ocean separating
them from the land to the north and east. It seems vital that we
shall land on Clarence Island or its neighbour, Elephant Island.
The latter island has attraction for us, although as far as I
know nobody has ever landed there. Its name suggests the presence
of the plump and succulent sea-elephant. We have an increasing
desire in any case to get firm ground under our feet. The floe
has been a good friend to us, but it is reaching the end of its
journey, and it is liable at any time now to break up and fling
us into the unplumbed sea.”
A little later, after reviewing the whole situation in the
light of our circumstances, I made up my mind that we should try
to reach Deception Island. The relative positions of Clarence,
Elephant, and Deception Islands can be seen on the chart. The two
islands first named lay comparatively near to us and were separated
by some eighty miles of water from Prince George Island, which was
about 150 miles away from our camp on the berg. From this island
a chain of similar islands extends westward, terminating in
Deception Island. The channels separating these desolate patches
of rock and ice are from ten to fifteen miles wide. But we knew
from the Admiralty sailing directions that there were stores for
the use of shipwrecked mariners on Deception Island, and it was
possible that the summer whalers had not yet deserted its harbour.
Also we had learned from our scanty records that a small church
had been erected there for the benefit of the transient whalers.
The existence of this building would mean to us a supply of timber,
from which, if dire necessity urged us, we could construct a
reasonably seaworthy boat. We had discussed this point during our
drift on the floe. Two of our boats were fairly strong, but the
third, the James Caird, was light, although a little longer than
the others. All of them were small for the navigation of these
notoriously stormy seas, and they would be heavily loaded, so a
voyage in open water would be a serious undertaking. I fear
that the carpenter’s fingers were already itching to convert pews
into topsides and decks. In any case, the worst that could befall
us when we had reached Deception Island would be a wait until
the whalers returned about the middle of November.
Another bit of information gathered from the records of the west
side of the Weddell Sea related to Prince George Island. The
Admiralty “Sailing Directions,” referring to the South Shetlands,
mentioned a cave on this island. None of us had seen that cave
or could say if it was large or small, wet or dry; but as we
drifted on our floe and later, when navigating the treacherous
leads and making our uneasy night camps, that cave seemed to my
fancy to be a palace which in contrast would dim the splendours
of Versailles.
The swell increased that night and the movement of the ice
became more pronounced. Occasionally a neighbouring floe would
hammer against the ice on which we were camped, and the lesson
of these blows was plain to read. We must get solid ground
under our feet quickly. When the vibration ceased after a heavy
surge, my thoughts flew round to the problem ahead. If the party
had not numbered more than six men a solution would not have been
so hard to find; but obviously the transportation of the whole
party to a place of safety, with the limited means at our
disposal, was going to be a matter of extreme difficulty.
There were twenty-eight men on our floating cake of ice, which was
steadily dwindling under the influence of wind, weather, charging
floes, and heavy swell. I confess that I felt the burden of
responsibility sit heavily on my shoulders; but, on the other
hand, I was stimulated and cheered by the attitude of the men.
Loneliness is the penalty of leadership, but the man who has to
make the decisions is assisted greatly if he feels that there is
no uncertainty in the minds of those who follow him, and that
his orders will be carried out confidently and in expectation of
success.
The sun was shining in the blue sky on the following morning
(April 8). Clarence Island showed clearly on the horizon, and
Elephant Island could also be distinguished. The single snow-clad
peak of Clarence Island stood up as a beacon of safety, though
the most optimistic imagination could not make an easy path of the
ice and ocean that separated us from that giant, white and austere.
“The pack was much looser this morning, and the long rolling swell
from the north-east is more pronounced than it was yesterday. The
floes rise and fall with the surge of the sea. We evidently are
drifting with the surface current, for all the heavier masses of
floe, bergs, and hummocks are being left behind. There has been
some discussion in the camp as to the advisability of making one
of the bergs our home for the time being and drifting with it to
the west. The idea is not sound. I cannot be sure that the berg
would drift in the right direction. If it did move west and
carried us into the open water, what would be our fate when we
tried to launch the boats down the steep sides of the berg in
the sea-swell after the surrounding floes had left us? One must
reckon, too, the chance of the berg splitting or even overturning
during our stay. It is not possible to gauge the condition of a
big mass of ice by surface appearance. The ice may have a fault,
and when the wind, current, and swell set up strains and tensions,
the line of weakness may reveal itself suddenly and disastrously.
No, I do not like the idea of drifting on a berg. We must stay
on our floe till conditions improve and then make another attempt
to advance towards the land.”
At 6.30 p.m. a particularly heavy shock went through our floe.
The watchman and other members of the party made an immediate
inspection and found a crack right under the James Caird and
between the other two boats and the main camp. Within five minutes
the boats were over the crack and close to the tents. The trouble
was not caused by a blow from another floe. We could see that the
piece of ice we occupied had slewed and now presented its long axis
towards the oncoming swell. The floe, therefore, was pitching in
the manner of a ship, and it had cracked across when the swell
lifted the centre, leaving the two ends comparatively unsupported.
We were now on a triangular raft of ice, the three sides measuring,
roughly, 90, 100, and 120 yds. Night came down dull and overcast,
and before midnight the wind had freshened from the west. We could
see that the pack was opening under the influence of wind, wave,
and current, and I felt that the time for launching the boats was
near at hand. Indeed, it was obvious that even if the conditions
were unfavourable for a start during the coming day, we could not
safely stay on the floe many hours longer. The movement of the ice
in the swell was increasing, and the floe might split right under
our camp. We had made preparations for quick action if anything
of the kind occurred. Our case would be desperate if the ice
broke into small pieces not large enough to support our party
and not loose enough to permit the use of the boats.
The following day was Sunday (April 9), but it proved no day
of rest for us. Many of the important events of our Expedition
occurred on Sundays, and this particular day was to see our
forced departure from the floe on which we had lived for nearly
six months, and the start of our journeyings in the boats.
“This has been an eventful day. The morning was fine, though
somewhat overcast by stratus and cumulus clouds; moderate
south-south-westerly and south-easterly breezes. We hoped that
with this wind the ice would drift nearer to Clarence Island.
At 7 a.m. lanes of water and leads could be seen on the horizon
to the west. The ice separating us from the lanes was loose, but
did not appear to be workable for the boats. The long swell from
the north-west was coming in more freely than on the previous day
and was driving the floes together in the utmost confusion.
The loose brash between the masses of ice was being churned to
mudlike consistency, and no boat could have lived in the channels
that opened and closed around us. Our own floe was suffering in
the general disturbance, and after breakfast I ordered the tents
to be struck and everything prepared for an immediate start when
the boats could be launched.”
I had decided to take the James Caird myself, with Wild and eleven
men. This was the largest of our boats, and in addition to her
human complement she carried the major portion of the stores.
Worsley had charge of the Dudley Docker with nine men, and
Hudson and Crean were the senior men on the Stancomb Wills.
Soon after breakfast the ice closed again. We were standing by,
with our preparations as complete as they could be made, when at
11 a.m. our floe suddenly split right across under the boats. We
rushed our gear on to the larger of the two pieces and watched with
strained attention for the next development. The crack had cut
through the site of my tent. I stood on the edge of the new
fracture, and, looking across the widening channel of water,
could see the spot where for many months my head and shoulders
had rested when I was in my sleeping-bag. The depression formed
by my body and legs was on our side of the crack. The ice had
sunk under my weight during the months of waiting in the tent,
and I had many times put snow under the bag to fill the hollow.
The lines of stratification showed clearly the different layers
of snow. How fragile and precarious had been our resting-place!
Yet usage had dulled our sense of danger. The floe had become
our home, and during the early months of the drift we had almost
ceased to realize that it was but a sheet of ice floating on
unfathomed seas. Now our home was being shattered under our feet,
and we had a sense of loss and incompleteness hard to describe.
The fragments of our floe came together again a little later,
and we had our lunch of seal meat, all hands eating their fill.
I thought that a good meal would be the best possible preparation
for the journey that now seemed imminent, and as we would not
be able to take all our meat with us when we finally moved, we
could regard every pound eaten as a pound rescued. The call to
action came at 1 p.m. The pack opened well and the channels became
navigable. The conditions were not all one could have desired, but
it was best not to wait any longer. The Dudley Docker and the
Stancomb Wills were launched quickly. Stores were thrown in,
and the two boats were pulled clear of the immediate floes towards
a pool of open water three miles broad, in which floated a lone and
mighty berg. The James Caird was the last boat to leave, heavily
loaded with stores and odds and ends of camp equipment. Many things
regarded by us as essentials at that time were to be discarded a
little later as the pressure of the primitive became more severe.
Man can sustain life with very scanty means. The trappings of
civilization are soon cast aside in the face of stern realities,
and given the barest opportunity of winning food and shelter,
man can live and even find his laughter ringing true.
The three boats were a mile away from our floe home at 2 p.m. We
had made our way through the channels and had entered the big pool
when we saw a rush of foam-clad water and tossing ice approaching
us, like the tidal bore of a river. The pack was being impelled to
the east by a tide-rip, and two huge masses of ice were driving
down upon us on converging courses. The James Caird was leading.
Starboarding the helm and bending strongly to the oars, we managed
to get clear. The two other boats followed us, though from their
position astern at first they had not realized the immediate
danger. The Stancomb Wills was the last boat and she was very
nearly caught, but by great exertion she was kept just ahead of
the driving ice. It was an unusual and startling experience.
The effect of tidal action on ice is not often as marked as it
was that day. The advancing ice, accompanied by a large wave,
appeared to be travelling at about three knots; and if we had
not succeeded in pulling clear we would certainly have been
swamped.
We pulled hard for an hour to windward of the berg that lay in
the open water. The swell was crashing on its perpendicular
sides and throwing spray to a height of sixty feet. Evidently
there was an ice-foot at the east end, for the swell broke before
it reached the berg-face and flung its white spray on to the blue
ice-wall. We might have paused to have admired the spectacle under
other conditions; but night was coming on apace, and we needed a
camping-place. As we steered north-west, still amid the ice-floes,
the Dudley Docker got jammed between two masses while attempting
to make a short cut. The old adage about a short cut being the
longest way round is often as true in the Antarctic as it is in
the peaceful countryside. The James Caird got a line aboard the
Dudley Docker, and after some hauling the boat was brought clear
of the ice again. We hastened forward in the twilight in search
of a flat, old floe, and presently found a fairly large piece
rocking in the swell. It was not an ideal camping-place by any
means, but darkness had overtaken us. We hauled the boats up,
and by 8 p.m. had the tents pitched and the blubber-stove burning
cheerily. Soon all hands were well fed and happy in their tents,
and snatches of song came to me as I wrote up my log.
Some intangible feeling of uneasiness made me leave my tent about
11 p.m. that night and glance around the quiet camp. The stars
between the snow-flurries showed that the floe had swung round
and was end on to the swell, a position exposing it to sudden
strains. I started to walk across the floe in order to warn the
watchman to look carefully for cracks, and as I was passing the
men’s tent the floe lifted on the crest of a swell and cracked
right under my feet. The men were in one of the dome-shaped
tents, and it began to stretch apart as the ice opened. A
muffled sound, suggestive of suffocation, came from beneath
the stretching tent. I rushed forward, helped some emerging
men from under the canvas, and called out,
“Are you all right?”
“There are two in the water,” somebody answered. The crack
had widened to about four feet, and as I threw myself down at
the edge, I saw a whitish object floating in the water. It
was a sleeping-bag with a man inside. I was able to grasp it,
and with a heave lifted man and bag on to the floe. A few
seconds later the ice-edges came together again with tremendous
force. Fortunately, there had been but one man in the water, or
the incident might have been a tragedy. The rescued bag contained
Holness, who was wet down to the waist but otherwise unscathed.
The crack was now opening again. The James Caird and my tent were
on one side of the opening and the remaining two boats and the rest
of the camp on the other side. With two or three men to help me I
struck my tent; then all hands manned the painter and rushed the
James Caird across the opening crack. We held to the rope while,
one by one, the men left on our side of the floe jumped the
channel or scrambled over by means of the boat. Finally I was
left alone. The night had swallowed all the others and the rapid
movement of the ice forced me to let go the painter. For a moment
I felt that my piece of rocking floe was the loneliest place in
the world. Peering into the darkness; I could just see the dark
figures on the other floe. I hailed Wild, ordering him to launch
the Stancomb Wills, but I need not have troubled. His quick
brain had anticipated the order and already the boat was being
manned and hauled to the ice-edge. Two or three minutes
later she reached me, and I was ferried across to the Camp.
We were now on a piece of flat ice about 200 ft. long and 100 ft.
wide. There was no more sleep for any of us that night. The killers
were blowing in the lanes around, and we waited for daylight and
watched for signs of another crack in the ice. The hours passed with
laggard feet as we stood huddled together or walked to and fro in the
effort to keep some warmth in our bodies. We lit the blubber-stove at
3 a.m., and with pipes going and a cup of hot milk for each man, we
were able to discover some bright spots in our outlook. At any rate,
we were on the move at last, and if dangers and difficulties lay ahead
we could meet and overcome them. No longer were we drifting
helplessly at the mercy of wind and current.
The first glimmerings of dawn came at 6 a.m., and I waited
anxiously for the full daylight. The swell was growing, and at
times our ice was surrounded closely by similar pieces. At 6.30
a.m. we had hot hoosh, and then stood by waiting for the pack to
open. Our chance came at 8, when we launched the boats, loaded
them, and started to make our way through the lanes in a
northerly direction. The James Caird was in the lead, with the
Stancomb Wills next and the Dudley Docker bringing up the
rear. In order to make the boats more seaworthy we had left some
of our shovels, picks, and dried vegetables on the floe, and for
a long time we could see the abandoned stores forming a dark spot
on the ice. The boats were still heavily loaded. We got out
of the lanes, and entered a stretch of open water at 11 a.m. A
strong easterly breeze was blowing, but the fringe of pack lying
outside protected us from the full force of the swell, just as the
coral-reef of a tropical island checks the rollers of the Pacific.
Our way was across the open sea, and soon after noon we swung
round the north end of the pack and laid a course to the westward,
the James Caird still in the lead. Immediately our deeply laden
boats began to make heavy weather. They shipped sprays, which,
freezing as they fell, covered men and gear with ice, and soon it
was clear that we could not safely proceed. I put the James Caird
round and ran for the shelter of the pack again, the other boats
following. Back inside the outer line of ice the sea was not
breaking. This was at 3 p.m., and all hands were tired and cold.
A big floeberg resting peacefully ahead caught my eye, and half
an hour later we had hauled up the boats and pitched camp for the
night. It was a fine, big, blue berg with an attractively solid
appearance, and from our camp we could get a good view of the
surrounding sea and ice. The highest point was about 15 ft.
above sea-level. After a hot meal all hands, except the watchman,
turned in. Every one was in need of rest after the troubles of the
previous night and the unaccustomed strain of the last thirty-six
hours at the oars. The berg appeared well able to withstand the
battering of the sea, and too deep and massive to be seriously
affected by the swell; but it was not as safe as it looked.
About midnight the watchman called me and showed me that the
heavy north-westerly swell was undermining the ice. A great
piece had broken off within eight feet of my tent. We made what
inspection was possible in the darkness, and found that on the
westward side of the berg the thick snow covering was yielding
rapidly to the attacks of the sea. An ice-foot had formed just
under the surface of the water. I decided that there was no
immediate danger and did not call the men. The north-westerly
wind strengthened during the night.
The morning of April 11 was overcast and misty. There was a haze
on the horizon, and daylight showed that the pack had closed round
our berg, making it impossible in the heavy swell to launch the boats.
We could see no sign of the water. Numerous whales and killers were
blowing between the floes, and Cape pigeons, petrels, and fulmars
were circling round our berg. The scene from our camp as the
daylight brightened was magnificent beyond description, though I
must admit that we viewed it with anxiety. Heaving hills of pack
and floe were sweeping towards us in long undulations, later to be
broken here and there by the dark lines that indicated open water.
As each swell lifted around our rapidly dissolving berg it drove
floe-ice on to the ice-foot, shearing off more of the top snow-covering
and reducing the size of our camp. When the floes
retreated to attack again the water swirled over the ice-foot,
which was rapidly increasing in width. The launching of the
boats under such conditions would be difficult. Time after time,
so often that a track was formed, Worsley, Wild, and I, climbed
to the highest point of the berg and stared out to the horizon
in search of a break in the pack. After long hours had dragged
past, far away on the lift of the swell there appeared a dark
break in the tossing field of ice. Aeons seemed to pass, so
slowly it approached. I noticed enviously the calm peaceful
attitudes of two seals which lolled lazily on a rocking floe.
They were at home and had no reason for worry or cause for fear.
If they thought at all, I suppose they counted it an ideal day
for a joyous journey on the tumbling ice. To us it was a day
that seemed likely to lead to no more days. I do not think
I had ever before felt the anxiety that belongs leadership
quite so keenly. When I looked down at the camp to rest my
eyes from the strain of watching the wide white expanse
broken by that one black ribbon of open water, I could see that
my companions were waiting with more than ordinary interest to
learn what I thought about it all. After one particularly heavy
collision somebody shouted sharply, “She has cracked in the
middle.” I jumped off the look-out station and ran to the place
the men were examining. There was a crack, but investigation showed
it to be a mere surface break in the snow with no indication of a
split in the berg itself. The carpenter mentioned calmly that
earlier in the day he had actually gone adrift on a fragment of ice.
He was standing near the edge of our camping-ground when the ice
under his feet parted from the parent mass. A quick jump over
the widening gap saved him.
The hours dragged on. One of the anxieties in my mind was the
possibility that we would be driven by the current through the
eighty-mile gap between Clarence Island and Prince George Island
into the open Atlantic; but slowly the open water came nearer,
and at noon it had almost reached us. A long lane, narrow but
navigable, stretched out to the south-west horizon. Our chance
came a little later. We rushed our boats over the edge of the
reeling berg and swung them clear of the ice-foot as it rose
beneath them. The James Caird was nearly capsized by a blow
from below as the berg rolled away, but she got into deep water.
We flung stores and gear aboard and within a few minutes were away.
The James Caird and Dudley Docker had good sails and with a
favourable breeze could make progress along the lane, with the
rolling fields of ice on either side. The swell was heavy and
spray was breaking over the ice-floes. An attempt to set a little
rag of sail on the Stancomb Wills resulted in serious delay. The
area of sail was too small to be of much assistance, and while the
men were engaged in this work the boat drifted down towards the
ice-floe, where her position was likely to be perilous. Seeing
her plight, I sent the Dudley Docker back for her and tied the
James Caird up to a piece of ice. The Dudley Docker had to
tow the Stancomb Wills, and the delay cost us two hours of
valuable daylight. When I had the three boats together again
we continued down the lane, and soon saw a wider stretch
of water to the west; it appeared to offer us release from the
grip of the pack. At the head of an ice-tongue that nearly closed
the gap through which we might enter the open space was a wave-worn
berg shaped like some curious antediluvian monster, an icy Cerberus
guarding the way. It had head and eyes and rolled so heavily that
it almost overturned. Its sides dipped deep in the sea, and as it
rose again the water seemed to be streaming from its eyes, as
though it were weeping at our escape from the clutch of the floes.
This may seem fanciful to the reader, but the impression was real
to us at the time. People living under civilized conditions,
surrounded by Nature’s varied forms of life and by all the
familiar work of their own hands, may scarcely realize how
quickly the mind, influenced by the eyes, responds to the unusual
and weaves about it curious imaginings like the firelight fancies
of our childhood days. We had lived long amid the ice, and we
half-unconsciously strove to see resemblances to human faces and
living forms in the fantastic contours and massively uncouth
shapes of berg and floe.
At dusk we made fast to a heavy floe, each boat having its painter
fastened to a separate hummock in order to avoid collisions in the
swell. We landed the blubber-stove, boiled some water in order to
provide hot milk, and served cold rations. I also landed the dome
tents and stripped the coverings from the hoops. Our experience
of the previous day in the open sea had shown us that the tents
must be packed tightly. The spray had dashed over the bows and
turned to ice on the cloth, which had soon grown dangerously
heavy. Other articles off our scanty equipment had to go that
night. We were carrying only the things that had seemed
essential, but we stripped now to the barest limit of safety.
We had hoped for a quiet night, but presently we were forced to
cast off, since pieces of loose ice began to work round the floe.
Drift-ice is always attracted to the lee side of a heavy floe,
where it bumps and presses under the influence of the current.
I had determined not to risk a repetition of the last night’s
experience and so had not pulled the boats up. We spent the
hours of darkness keeping an offing from the main line of pack
under the lee of the smaller pieces. Constant rain and snow
squalls blotted out the stars and soaked us through, and at
times it was only by shouting to each other that we managed
to keep the boats together. There was no sleep for anybody
owing to the severe cold, and we dare not pull fast enough
to keep ourselves warm since we were unable to see more than
a few yards ahead. Occasionally the ghostly shadows of silver,
snow, and fulmar petrels flashed close to us, and all around
we could hear the killers blowing, their short, sharp hisses
sounding like sudden escapes of steam. The killers were a source
of anxiety, for a boat could easily have been capsized by one of
them coming up to blow. They would throw aside in a nonchalant
fashion pieces of ice much bigger than our boats when they rose
to the surface, and we had an uneasy feeling that the white bottoms
of the boats would look like ice from below. Shipwrecked mariners
drifting in the Antarctic seas would be things not dreamed of in
the killers’ philosophy, and might appear on closer examination to
be tasty substitutes for seal and penguin. We certainly regarded
the killers with misgivings.
Early in the morning of April 12 the weather improved and the wind
dropped. Dawn came with a clear sky, cold and fearless. I looked
around at the faces of my companions in the James Caird and saw
pinched and drawn features. The strain was beginning to tell.
Wild sat at the rudder with the same calm, confident expression
that he would have worn under happier conditions; his steel-blue
eyes looked out to the day ahead. All the people, though
evidently suffering, were doing their best to be cheerful, and the
prospect of a hot breakfast was inspiriting. I told all the boats
that immediately we could find a suitable floe the cooker would be
started and hot milk and Bovril would soon fix everybody up. Away
we rowed to the westward through open pack, floes of all shapes and
sizes on every side of us, and every man not engaged in pulling
looking eagerly for a suitable camping-place. I could gauge the
desire for food of the different members by the eagerness they
displayed in pointing out to me the floes they considered exactly
suited to our purpose. The temperature was about 10° Fahr.,
and the Burberry suits of the rowers crackled as the men bent to
the oars. I noticed little fragments of ice and frost falling
from arms and bodies. At eight o’clock a decent floe appeared
ahead and we pulled up to it. The galley was landed, and soon
the welcome steam rose from the cooking food as the blubber-stove
flared and smoked. Never did a cook work under more anxious
scrutiny. Worsley, Crean, and I stayed in our respective boats
to keep them steady and prevent collisions with the floe, since
the swell was still running strong, but the other men were able
to stretch their cramped limbs and run to and fro “in the kitchen,”
as somebody put it. The sun was now rising gloriously. The
Burberry suits were drying and the ice was melting off our beards.
The steaming food gave us new vigour, and within three-quarters
of an hour we were off again to the west with all sails set. We
had given an additional sail to the Stancomb Wills and she was
able to keep up pretty well. We could see that we were on the
true pack-edge, with the blue, rolling sea just outside the fringe
of ice to the north. White-capped waves vied with the glittering
floes in the setting of blue water, and countless seals basked
and rolled on every piece of ice big enough to form a raft.
We had been making westward with oars and sails since April 9,
and fair easterly winds had prevailed. Hopes were running high as
to the noon observation for position. The optimists thought that
we had done sixty miles towards our goal, and the most cautious
guess gave us at least thirty miles. The bright sunshine and the
brilliant scene around us may have influenced our anticipations.
As noon approached I saw Worsley, as navigating officer, balancing
himself on the gunwale of the Dudley Docker with his arm around
the mast, ready to snap the sun. He got his observation and we
waited eagerly while he worked out the sight. Then the Dudley
Docker ranged up alongside the James Caird and I jumped into
Worsley’s boat in order to see the result. It was a grievous
disappointment. Instead of making a good run to the westward we
had made a big drift to the south-east. We were actually thirty
miles to the east of the position we had occupied when we left the
floe on the 9th. It has been noted by sealers operating in this
area that there are often heavy sets to the east in the Belgica
Straits, and no doubt it was one of these sets that we had
experienced. The originating cause would be a north-westerly gale
off Cape Horn, producing the swell that had already caused us so
much trouble. After a whispered consultation with Worsley and
Wild, I announced that we had not made as much progress as we
expected, but I did not inform the hands of our retrograde movement.
The question of our course now demanded further consideration.
Deception Island seemed to be beyond our reach. The wind was foul
for Elephant Island, and as the sea was clear to the south-west; I
discussed with Worsley and Wild the advisability of proceeding to
Hope Bay on the mainland of the Antarctic Continent, now only
eighty miles distant. Elephant Island was the nearest land, but
it lay outside the main body of pack, and even if the wind had
been fair we would have hesitated at that particular time to face
the high sea that was running in the open. We laid a course
roughly for Hope Bay, and the boats moved on again. I gave
Worsley a line for a berg ahead and told him, if possible, to make
fast before darkness set in. This was about three o’clock in the
afternoon. We had set sail, and as the Stancomb Wills could not
keep up with the other two boats I took her in tow, not being
anxious to repeat the experience of the day we left the reeling
berg. The Dudley Docker went ahead, but came beating down towards
us at dusk. Worsley had been close to the berg, and he reported
that it was unapproachable. It was rolling in the swell and
displaying an ugly ice-foot. The news was bad. In the failing
light we turned towards a line of pack, and found it so tossed
and churned by the sea that no fragment remained big enough to
give us an anchorage and shelter. Two miles away we could see a
larger piece of ice, and to it we managed, after some trouble, to
secure the boats. I brought my boat bow on to the floe, whilst
Howe, with the painter in his hand, stood ready to jump. Standing
up to watch our chance, while the oars were held ready to back the
moment Howe had made his leap, I could see that there would be no
possibility of getting the galley ashore that night. Howe just
managed to get a footing on the edge of the floe, and then
made the painter fast to a hummock. The other two boats were
fastened alongside the James Caird. They could not lie astern
of us in a line, since cakes of ice came drifting round the floe
and gathering under its lee. As it was we spent the next two hours
poling off the drifting ice that surged towards us. The blubber-stove
could not be used, so we started the Primus lamps. There
was a rough, choppy sea, and the Dudley Docker could not get her
Primus under way, something being adrift. The men in that boat
had to wait until the cook on the James Caird had boiled up
the first pot of milk.
The boats were bumping so heavily that I had to slack away the
painter of the Stancomb Wills and put her astern. Much ice was
coming round the floe and had to be poled off. Then the Dudley
Docker, being the heavier boat, began to damage the James Caird,
and I slacked the Dudley Docker away. The James Caird remained
moored to the ice, with the Dudley Docker and the Stancomb Wills
in line behind her. The darkness had become complete, and we
strained our eye to see the fragments of ice that threatened us.
Presently we thought we saw a great berg bearing down upon us, its
form outlined against the sky, but this startling spectacle
resolved itself into a low-lying cloud in front of the rising moon.
The moon appeared in a clear sky. The wind shifted to the south-east
as the light improved and drove the boats broadside on towards
the jagged edge of the floe. We had to cut the painter of the James
Caird and pole her off, thus losing much valuable rope. There was
no time to cast off. Then we pushed away from the floe, and all
night long we lay in the open, freezing sea, the Dudley Docker now
ahead, the James Caird astern of her, and the Stancomb Wills third
in the line. The boats were attached to one another by their
painters. Most of the time the Dudley Docker kept the James Caird
and the Stancomb Wills up to the swell, and the men who were
rowing were in better pass than those in the other boats, waiting
inactive for the dawn. The temperature was down to 4° below
zero, and a film of ice formed on the surface of the sea. When we
were not on watch we lay in each other’s arms for warmth. Our
frozen suits thawed where our bodies met, and as the slightest
movement exposed these comparatively warm spots to the biting
air, we clung motionless, whispering each to his companion our
hopes and thoughts. Occasionally from an almost clear sky came
snow-showers, falling silently on the sea and laying a thin shroud
of white over our bodies and our boats.
The dawn of April 13 came clear and bright, with occasional
passing clouds. Most of the men were now looking seriously worn
and strained. Their lips were cracked and their eyes and eyelids
showed red in their salt-encrusted faces. The beards even of the
younger men might have been those of patriarchs, for the frost
and the salt spray had made them white. I called the Dudley
Docker alongside and found the condition of the people there
was no better than in the James Caird. Obviously we must make
land quickly, and I decided to run for Elephant Island.
The wind had shifted fair for that rocky isle, then about one
hundred miles away, and the pack that separated us from Hope Bay
had closed up during the night from the south. At 6 p.m. we
made a distribution of stores among the three boats, in view of
the possibility of their being separated. The preparation of
a hot breakfast was out of the question. The breeze was strong
and the sea was running high in the loose pack around us. We
had a cold meal, and I gave orders that all hands might eat as
much as they pleased, this concession being due partly to a
realization that we would have to jettison some of our stores
when we reached open sea in order to lighten the boats. I
hoped, moreover, that a full meal of cold rations would
compensate to some extent for the lack of warm food and shelter.
Unfortunately, some of the men were unable to take advantage
of the extra food owing to seasickness. Poor fellows, it was
bad enough to be huddled in the deeply laden, spray-swept boats,
frost-bitten and half-frozen, without having the pangs of seasickness
added to the list of their woes. But some smiles were
caused even then by the plight of one man, who had a habit of
accumulating bits of food against the day of starvation that
he seemed always to think was at hand, and who was condemned
now to watch impotently while hungry comrades with undisturbed
stomachs made biscuits, rations, and sugar disappear with
extraordinary rapidity.
We ran before the wind through the loose pack, a man in the bow
of each boat trying to pole off with a broken oar the lumps of ice
that could not be avoided. I regarded speed as essential.
Sometimes collisions were not averted. The James Caird was in
the lead, where she bore the brunt of the encounter with lurking
fragments, and she was holed above the water-line by a sharp spur
of ice, but this mishap did not stay us. Later the wind became
stronger and we had to reef sails, so as not to strike the ice too
heavily. The Dudley Docker came next to the James Caird and
the Stancomb Wills followed. I had given order that the boats
should keep 30 or 40 yds. apart, so as to reduce the danger of a
collision if one boat was checked by the ice. The pack was
thinning, and we came to occasional open areas where thin ice had
formed during the night. When we encountered this new ice we had
to shake the reef out of the sails in order to force a way through.
Outside of the pack the wind must have been of hurricane force.
Thousands of small dead fish were to be seen, killed probably by
a cold current and the heavy weather. They floated in the water
and lay on the ice, where they had been cast by the waves. The
petrels and skua-gulls were swooping down and picking them up
like sardines off toast.
We made our way through the lanes till at noon we were suddenly
spewed out of the pack into the open ocean. Dark blue and sapphire
green ran the seas. Our sails were soon up, and with a fair wind
we moved over the waves like three Viking ships on the quest of
a lost Atlantis. With the sheet well out and the sun shining
bright above, we enjoyed for a few hours a sense of the freedom
and magic of the sea, compensating us for pain and trouble in the
days that had passed. At last we were free from the ice, in water
that our boats could navigate. Thoughts of home, stifled by the
deadening weight of anxious days and nights, came to birth once
more, and the difficulties that had still to be overcome dwindled
in fancy almost to nothing.
During the afternoon we had to take a second reef in the sails,
for the wind freshened and the deeply laden boats were shipping
much water and steering badly in the rising sea. I had laid the
course for Elephant Island and we were making good progress.
The Dudley Docker ran down to me at dusk and Worsley suggested
that we should stand on all night; but already the Stancomb Wills
was barely discernible among the rollers in the gathering dusk,
and I decided that it would be safer to heave to and wait for the
daylight. It would never have done for the boats to have become
separated from one another during the night. The party must be
kept together, and, moreover, I thought it possible that we might
overrun our goal in the darkness and not be able to return. So we
made a sea-anchor of oars and hove to, the Dudley Docker in the
lead, since she had the longest painter. The James Caird swung
astern of the Dudley Docker and the Stancomb Wills again had
the third place. We ate a cold meal and did what little we could
to make things comfortable for the hours of darkness. Rest was
not for us. During the greater part of the night the sprays broke
over the boats and froze in masses of ice, especially at the stern
and bows. This ice had to be broken away in order to prevent the
boats growing too heavy. The temperature was below zero and the
wind penetrated our clothes and chilled us almost unbearably.
I doubted if all the men would survive that night. One of our
troubles was lack of water. We had emerged so suddenly from the
pack into the open sea that we had not had time to take aboard ice
for melting in the cookers, and without ice we could not have hot
food. The Dudley Docker had one lump of ice weighing about ten
pounds, and this was shared out among all hands. We sucked small
pieces and got a little relief from thirst engendered by the salt
spray, but at the same time we reduced our bodily heat. The condition
of most of the men was pitiable. All of us had swollen mouths and
we could hardly touch the food. I longed intensely for the dawn.
I called out to the other boats at intervals during the night,
asking how things were with them. The men always managed to reply
cheerfully. One of the people on the Stancomb Wills shouted,
“We are doing all right, but I would like some dry mitts.” The
jest brought a smile to cracked lips. He might as well have asked
for the moon. The only dry things aboard the boats were swollen
mouths and burning tongues. Thirst is one of the troubles that
confront the traveller in polar regions. Ice may be plentiful
on every hand, but it does not become drinkable until it is melted,
and the amount that may be dissolved in the mouth is limited. We
had been thirsty during the days of heavy pulling in the pack,
and our condition was aggravated quickly by the salt spray. Our
sleeping-bags would have given us some warmth, but they were not
within our reach. They were packed under the tents in the bows,
where a mail-like coating of ice enclosed them, and we were so
cramped that we could not pull them out.
At last daylight came, and with the dawn the weather cleared and
the wind fell to a gentle south-westerly breeze. A magnificent
sunrise heralded in what we hoped would be our last day in the
boats. Rose-pink in the growing light, the lofty peak of Clarence
Island told of the coming glory of the sun. The sky grew blue
above us and the crests of the waves sparkled cheerfully. As
soon as it was light enough we chipped and scraped the ice off
the bows and sterns. The rudders had been unshipped during the
night in order to avoid the painters catching them. We cast off
our ice-anchor and pulled the oars aboard. They
had grown during the night to the thickness of telegraph-poles
while rising and falling in the freezing seas, and had to be chipped
clear before they could be brought inboard.
We were dreadfully thirsty now. We found that we could get
momentary relief by chewing pieces of raw seal meat and swallowing
the blood, but thirst came back with redoubled force owing to the
saltness of the flesh. I gave orders, therefore, that meat was
to be served out only at stated intervals during the day or when
thirst seemed to threaten the reason of any particular individual.
In the full daylight Elephant Island showed cold and severe to the
north-north-west. The island was on the bearings that Worsley had
laid down, and I congratulated him on the accuracy of his navigation
under difficult circumstances, with two days dead reckoning while
following a devious course through the pack-ice and after drifting
during two nights at the mercy of wind and waves. The Stancomb
Wills came up and McIlroy reported that Blackborrow’s feet were
very badly frost-bitten. This was unfortunate, but nothing could
be done. Most of the people were frost-bitten to some extent, and
it was interesting to notice that the “oldtimers,” Wild, Crean,
Hurley, and I, were all right. Apparently we were acclimatized to
ordinary Antarctic temperature, though we learned later that we were
not immune.
All day, with a gentle breeze on our port bow, we sailed and pulled
through a clear sea. We would have given all the tea in China for
a lump of ice to melt into water, but no ice was within our reach.
Three bergs were in sight and we pulled towards them, hoping that
a trail of brash would be floating on the sea to leeward; but they
were hard and blue, devoid of any sign of cleavage, and the swell
that surged around them as they rose and fell made it impossible
for us to approach closely. The wind was gradually hauling ahead,
and as the day wore on the rays of the sun beat fiercely down
from a cloudless sky on pain-racked men. Progress was slow, but
gradually Elephant Island came nearer. Always while I attended to
the other boats, signalling and ordering, Wild sat at the tiller of
the James Caird. He seemed unmoved by fatigue and unshaken by
privation. About four o’clock in the afternoon a stiff breeze came
up ahead and, blowing against the current, soon produced a choppy
sea. During the next hour of hard pulling we seemed to make no
progress at all. The James Caird and the Dudley Docker had been
towing the Stancomb Wills in turn, but my boat now took the
Stancomb Wills in tow permanently, as the James Caird could carry
more sail than the Dudley Docker in the freshening wind.
We were making up for the south-east side of Elephant Island, the
wind being between north-west and west. The boats, held as close
to the wind as possible, moved slowly, and when darkness set in
our goal was still some miles away. A heavy sea was running. We
soon lost sight of the Stancomb Wills, astern of the James Caird
at the length of the painter, but occasionally the white gleam of
broken water revealed her presence. When the darkness was complete
I sat in the stern with my hand on the painter, so that I might
know if the other boat broke away, and I kept that position during
the night. The rope grew heavy with the ice as the unseen seas
surged past us and our little craft tossed to the motion of the
waters. Just at dusk I had told the men on the Stancomb Wills
that if their boat broke away during the night and they were unable
to pull against the wind, they could run for the east side of
Clarence Island and await our coming there. Even though we could
not land on Elephant Island, it would not do to have the third boat
adrift.
It was a stern night. The men, except the watch, crouched and
huddled in the bottom of the boat, getting what little warmth they
could from the soaking sleeping-bags and each other’s bodies.
Harder and harder blew the wind and fiercer and fiercer grew the
sea. The boat plunged heavily through the squalls and came up to
the wind, the sail shaking in the stiffest gusts. Every now and
then, as the night wore on, the moon would shine down through a
rift in the driving clouds, and in the momentary light I could see
the ghostly faces of men, sitting up to trim the boat as she
heeled over to the wind. When the moon was hidden its presence was
revealed still by the light reflected on the streaming glaciers of
the island. The temperature had fallen very low, and it seemed
that the general discomfort of our situation could scarcely have
been increased; but the land looming ahead was a beacon of
safety, and I think we were all buoyed up by the hope that the
coming day would see the end of our immediate troubles. At least
we would get firm land under our feet. While the painter of the
Stancomb Wills tightened and drooped under my hand, my thoughts
were busy with plans for the future.
Towards midnight the wind shifted to the south-west, and this
change enabled us to bear up closer to the island. A little later
the Dudley Docker ran down to the James Caird, and Worsley
shouted a suggestion that he should go ahead and search for a
landing-place. His boat had the heels of the James Caird, with
the Stancomb Wills in tow. I told him he could try, but he must
not lose sight of the James Caird. Just as he left me a heavy
snow-squall came down, and in the darkness the boats parted. I
saw the Dudley Docker no more. This separation caused me some
anxiety during the remaining hours of the night. A cross-sea was
running and I could not feel sure that all was well with the missing
boat. The waves could not be seen in the darkness, though the
direction and force of the wind could be felt, and under such
conditions, in an open boat, disaster might overtake the most
experienced navigator. I flashed our compass-lamp on the sail
in the hope that the signal would be visible on board the Dudley
Docker, but could see no reply. We strained our eyes to windward
in the darkness in the hope of catching a return signal and
repeated our flashes at intervals.
My anxiety, as a matter of fact, was groundless. I will quote
Worsley’s own account of what happened to the Dudley Docker:
“About midnight we lost sight of the James Caird with the
Stancomb Wills in tow, but not long after saw the light of the
James Caird’s compass-lamp, which Sir Ernest was flashing on
their sail as a guide to us. We answered by lighting our candle
under the tent and letting the light shine through. At the same
time we got the direction of the wind and how we were hauling from
my little pocket-compass, the boat’s compass being smashed. With
this candle our poor fellows lit their pipes, their only solace,
as our raging thirst prevented us from eating anything. By this
time we had got into a bad tide-rip, which, combined with the heavy,
lumpy sea, made it almost impossible to keep the Dudley Docker
from swamping. As it was we shipped several bad seas over the
stern as well as abeam and over the bows, although we were ‘on
a wind.’ Lees, who owned himself to be a rotten oarsman, made
good here by strenuous baling, in which he was well seconded by
Cheetham. Greenstreet, a splendid fellow, relieved me at the
tiller and helped generally. He and Macklin were my right and left
bowers as stroke-oars throughout. McLeod and Cheetham were two good
sailors and oars, the former a typical old deep-sea salt and growler,
the latter a pirate to his finger-tips. In the height of the gale
that night Cheetham was buying matches from me for bottles of
champagne, one bottle per match (too cheap; I should have charged
him two bottles). The champagne is to be paid when he opens his
pub in Hull and I am able to call that way. . . . We had now had
one hundred and eight hours of toil, tumbling, freezing, and
soaking, with little or no sleep. I think Sir Ernest, Wild,
Greenstreet, and I could say that we had no sleep at all.
Although it was sixteen months since we had been in a rough sea,
only four men were actually seasick, but several others were
off colour.
“The temperature was 20° below freezing-point; fortunately,
we were spared the bitterly low temperature of the previous night.
Greenstreet’s right foot got badly frost-bitten, but Lees restored
it by holding it in his sweater against his stomach. Other men
had minor frost-bites, due principally to the fact that their
clothes were soaked through with salt water. . . . We were close to
the land as the morning approached, but could see nothing of it
through the snow and spindrift. My eyes began to fail me.
Constant peering to windward, watching for seas to strike us,
appeared to have given me a cold in the eyes. I could not see
or judge distance properly, and found myself falling asleep
momentarily at the tiller. At 3 a.m. Greenstreet relieved me
there. I was so cramped from long hours, cold, and wet, in the
constrained position one was forced to assume on top of the gear
and stores at the tiller, that the other men had to pull me
amidships and straighten me out like a jack-knife, first rubbing
my thighs, groin, and stomach.
“At daylight we found ourselves close alongside the land, but the
weather was so thick that we could not see where to make for a
landing. Having taken the tiller again after an hour’s rest under
the shelter (save the mark!) of the dripping tent, I ran the Dudley
Docker off before the gale, following the coast around to the
north. This course for the first hour was fairly risky, the heavy
sea before which we were running threatening to swamp the boat, but
by 8 a.m. we had obtained a slight lee from the land. Then I was
able to keep her very close in, along a glacier front, with
the object of picking up lumps of fresh-water ice as we sailed
through them. Our thirst was intense. We soon had some ice
aboard, and for the next hour and a half we sucked and chewed
fragments of ice with greedy relish.
“All this time we were coasting along beneath towering rocky
cliffs and sheer glacier-faces, which offered not the slightest
possibility of landing anywhere. At 9.30 a.m. we spied a narrow,
rocky beach at the base of some very high crags and cliff, and
made for it. To our joy, we sighted the James Caird and the
Stancomb Wills sailing into the same haven just ahead of us.
We were so delighted that we gave three cheers, which were not
heard aboard the other boats owing to the roar of the surf.
However, we soon joined them and were able to exchange experiences
on the beach.”
Our experiences on the James Caird had been similar, although
we had not been able to keep up to windward as well as the
Dudley Docker had done. This was fortunate as events proved,
for the James Caird and Stancomb Wills went to leeward of the
big bight the Dudley Docker entered and from which she had to
turn out with the sea astern. We thus avoided the risk of having
the Stancomb Wills swamped in the following sea. The weather
was very thick in the morning. Indeed at 7 a.m. we were right
under the cliffs, which plunged sheer into the sea, before we saw
them. We followed the coast towards the north, and ever the
precipitous cliffs and glacier-faces presented themselves to our
searching eyes. The sea broke heavily against these walls and
a landing would have been impossible under any conditions. We
picked up pieces of ice and sucked them eagerly. At 9 a.m. at
the north-west end of the island we saw a narrow beach at the foot
of the cliffs. Outside lay a fringe of rocks heavily beaten by
the surf but with a narrow channel showing as a break in the
foaming water. I decided that we must face the hazards of this
unattractive landing-place. Two days and nights without drink or
hot food had played havoc with most of the men, and we could not
assume that any safer haven lay within our reach. The Stancomb
Wills was the lighter and handier boat—and I called her
alongside with the intention of taking her through the gap first and
ascertaining the possibilities of a landing before the James Caird
made the venture. I was just climbing into the Stancomb Wills when
I saw the Dudley Docker coming up astern under sail. The sight
took a great load off my mind.
Rowing carefully and avoiding the blind rollers which showed where
sunken rocks lay, we brought the Stancomb Wills towards the opening
in the reef. Then, with a few strong strokes we shot through
on the top of a swell and ran the boat on to a stony beach. The
next swell lifted her a little farther. This was the first landing
ever made on Elephant Island, and a thought came to me that the
honour should belong to the youngest member of the Expedition, so
I told Blackborrow to jump over. He seemed to be in a state almost
of coma, and in order to avoid delay I helped him, perhaps a
little roughly, over the side of the boat. He promptly sat down
in the surf and did not move. Then I suddenly realized what I had
forgotten, that both his feet were frost-bitten badly. Some of
us jumped over and pulled him into a dry place. It was a rather
rough experience for Blackborrow, but, anyhow, he is now able to
say that he was the first man to sit on Elephant Island. Possibly
at the time he would have been willing to forgo any distinction of
the kind. We landed the cook with his blubber-stove, a supply of
fuel and some packets of dried milk, and also several of the men.
Then the rest of us pulled out again to pilot the other boats
through the channel. The James Caird was too heavy to be beached
directly, so after landing most of the men from the Dudley Docker
and the Stancomb Wills I superintended the transhipment of the
James Caird’s gear outside the reef. Then we all made the passage,
and within a few minutes the three boats were aground. A curious
spectacle met my eyes when I landed the second time. Some of the
men were reeling about the beach as if they had found an unlimited
supply of alcoholic liquor on the desolate shore. They were
laughing uproariously, picking up stones and letting handfuls of
pebbles trickle between their fingers like misers gloating over
hoarded gold. The smiles and laughter, which caused cracked lips
to bleed afresh, and the gleeful exclamations at the sight of two
live seals on the beach made me think for a moment of that glittering
hour of childhood when the door is open at last and the Christmas-tree
in all its wonder bursts upon the vision. I remember that
Wild, who always rose superior to fortune, bad and good, came
ashore as I was looking at the men and stood beside me as easy
and unconcerned as if he had stepped out of his car for a stroll
in the park.
Soon half a dozen of us had the stores ashore. Our strength was
nearly exhausted and it was heavy work carrying our goods over the
rough pebbles and rocks to the foot of the cliff, but we dare not
leave anything within reach of the tide. We had to wade knee-deep
in the icy water in order to lift the gear from the boats. When the
work was done we pulled the three boats a little higher on the beach
and turned gratefully to enjoy the hot drink the cook had prepared.
Those of us who were comparatively fit had to wait until the weaker
members of the party had been supplied; but every man had his pannikin
of hot milk in the end, and never did anything taste better. Seal
steak and blubber followed, for the seals that had been careless
enough to await our arrival on the beach had already given up their
lives. There was no rest for the cook. The blubber-stove flared
and spluttered fiercely as he cooked, not one meal, but many meals,
which merged into a day-long bout of eating. We drank water and
ate seal meat until every man had reached the limit of his capacity.
The tents were pitched with oars for supports, and by 3 p.m. our
camp was in order. The original framework of the tents had been
cast adrift on one of the floes in order to save weight. Most of
the men turned in early for a safe and glorious sleep, to be broken
only by the call to take a turn on watch. The chief duty of the
watchman was to keep the blubber-stove alight, and each man on duty
appeared to find it necessary to cook himself a meal during his
watch, and a supper before he turned in again.
Wild, Worsley, and Hurley accompanied me on an inspection of our
beach before getting into the tents. I almost wished then that
I had postponed the examination until after sleep, but the sense
of caution that the uncertainties of polar travel implant in one’s
mind had made me uneasy. The outlook we found to be anything but
cheering. Obvious signs showed that at spring tides the little
beach would be covered by the water right up to the foot of the
cliffs. In a strong north-easterly gale, such as we might expect
to experience at any time, the waves would pound over the scant
barrier of the reef and break against the sheer sides of the rocky
wall behind us. Well-marked terraces showed the effect of other
gales, and right at the back of the beach was a small bit of
wreckage not more than three feet long, rounded by the constant
chafing it had endured. Obviously we must find some better
resting-place. I decided not to share with the men the knowledge
of the uncertainties of our situation until they had enjoyed the
full sweetness of rest untroubled by the thought that at any
minute they might be called to face peril again. The threat of
the sea had been our portion during many, many days, and a respite
meant much to weary bodies and jaded minds.
The accompanying plan will indicate our exact position more
clearly than I can describe it. The cliffs at the back of the
beach were inaccessible except at two points where there were
steep snow-slopes. We were not worried now about food, for,
apart from our own rations, there were seals on the beach
and we could see others in the water outside the reef. Every now
and then one of the animals would rise in the shallows and crawl up
on the beach, which evidently was a recognized place of resort for
its kind. A small rocky island which protected us to some extent
from the north-westerly wind carried a ringed-penguin rookery.
These birds were of migratory habit and might be expected to leave
us before the winter set in fully, but in the meantime they were
within our reach. These attractions, however, were overridden by
the fact that the beach was open to the attack of wind and sea from
the north-east and east. Easterly gales are more prevalent than
western in that area of the Antarctic during the winter. Before
turning in that night I studied the whole position and weighed every
chance of getting the boats and our stores into a place of safety
out of reach of the water. We ourselves might have clambered a
little way up the snow-slopes, but we could not have taken the
boats with us. The interior of the island was quite inaccessible.
We climbed up one of the slopes and found ourselves stopped soon by
overhanging cliffs. The rocks behind the camp were much weathered,
and we noticed the sharp, unworn boulders that had fallen from above.
Clearly there was a danger from overhead if we camped at the back
of the beach. We must move on. With that thought in mind I reached
my tent and fell asleep on the rubbly ground, which gave a comforting
sense of stability. The fairy princess who would not rest on her
seven downy mattresses because a pea lay underneath the pile might
not have understood the pleasure we all derived from the
irregularities of the stones, which could not possibly break beneath
us or drift away; the very searching lumps were sweet reminders of
our safety.
Early next morning (April 15) all hands were astir. The sun soon
shone brightly and we spread out our wet gear to dry, till the
beach looked like a particularly disreputable gipsy camp. The
boots and clothing had suffered considerably during our travels.
I had decided to send Wild along the coast in the Stancomb Wills
to look for a new camping-ground, and he and I discussed the details
of the journey while eating our breakfast of hot seal steak and
blubber. The camp I wished to find was one where the party could
live for weeks or even months in safety, without danger from sea
or wind in the heaviest winter gale. Wild was to proceed westwards
along the coast and was to take with him four of the fittest men,
Marston, Crean, Vincent, and McCarthy. If he did not return before
dark we were to light a flare, which would serve him as a guide to
the entrance of the channel. The Stancomb Wills pushed off at
11 a.m. and quickly passed out of sight around the island. Then
Hurley and I walked along the beach towards the west, climbing
through a gap between the cliff and a great detached pillar of
basalt. The narrow strip of beach was cumbered with masses of
rock that had fallen from the cliffs. We struggled along for
two miles or more in the search for a place where we could get
the boats ashore and make a permanent camp in the event of Wild’s
search proving fruitless, but after three hours’ vain toil we had
to turn back. We had found on the far side of the pillar of
basalt a crevice in the rocks beyond the reach of all but
the heaviest gales. Rounded pebbles showed that the seas
reached the spot on occasions. Here I decided to depot ten
cases of Bovril sledging ration in case of our having to move
away quickly. We could come back for the food at a later date
if opportunity offered.
Returning to the camp, we found the men resting or attending to
their gear. Clark had tried angling in the shallows off the rocks
and had secured one or two small fish. The day passed quietly.
Rusty needles were rubbed bright on the rocks and clothes were
mended and darned. A feeling of tiredness—due, I suppose, to
reaction after the strain of the preceding days—overtook us, but
the rising tide, coming farther up the beach than it had done on
the day before, forced us to labour at the boats, which we hauled
slowly to a higher ledge. We found it necessary to move our
makeshift camp nearer the cliff. I portioned out the available
ground for the tents, the galley, and other purposes, as every
foot was of value. When night arrived the Stancomb Wills was
still away, so I had a blubber-flare lit at the head of the channel.
About 8 p.m. we heard a hail in the distance. We could see
nothing, but soon like a pale ghost out of the darkness came the
boat, the faces of the men showing white in the glare of the fire.
Wild ran her on the beach with the swell, and within a couple of
minutes we had dragged her to a place of safety. I was waiting
Wild’s report with keen anxiety, and my relief was great when he
told me that he had discovered a sandy spit seven miles to the
west, about 200 yds. long, running out at right angles to the
coast and terminating at the seaward end in a mass of rock. A
long snow-slope joined the spit at the shore end, and it seemed
possible that a “dugout” could be made in the snow. The spit,
in any case, would be a great improvement on our narrow beach.
Wild added that the place he described was the only possible
camping-ground he had seen. Beyond, to the west and south-west,
lay a frowning line of cliffs and glaciers, sheer to the water’s
edge. He thought that in very heavy gales either from the south-west
or east the spit would be spray-blown, but that the seas
would not actually break over it. The boats could be run up on
a shelving beach.
After hearing this good news I was eager to get away from the
beach camp. The wind when blowing was favourable for the run
along the coast. The weather had been fine for two days and a
change might come at any hour. I told all hands that we would
make a start early on the following morning. A newly killed seal
provided a luxurious supper of steak and blubber, and then we slept
comfortably till the dawn.
The morning of April 17 came fine and clear. The sea was smooth,
but in the offing we could see a line of pack, which seemed to be
approaching. We had noticed already pack and bergs being driven
by the current to the east and then sometimes coming back with a
rush to the west. The current ran as fast as five miles an hour,
and it was a set of this kind that had delayed Wild on his return
from the spit. The rise and fall of the tide was only about five
feet at this time, but the moon was making for full and the tides
were increasing. The appearance of ice emphasized the importance
of getting away promptly. It would be a serious matter to be
prisoned on the beach by the pack. The boats were soon afloat in
the shallows, and after a hurried breakfast all hands worked hard
getting our gear and stores aboard. A mishap befell us when we were
launching the boats. We were using oars as rollers, and three of
these were broken, leaving us short for the journey that had still
to be undertaken. The preparations took longer than I had
expected; indeed, there seemed to be some reluctance on the part
of several men to leave the barren safety of the little beach and
venture once more on the ocean. But the move was imperative, and
by 11 a.m. we were away, the James Caird leading. Just as we
rounded the small island occupied by the ringed penguins the
“willywaw” swooped down from the 2000-ft. cliffs behind us, a
herald of the southerly gale that was to spring up within half an
hour.
Soon we were straining at the oars with the gale on our bows.
Never had we found a more severe task. The wind shifted from the
south to the south-west, and the shortage of oars became a serious
matter. The James Caird, being the heaviest boat, had to keep a
full complement of rowers, while the Dudley Docker and the
Stancomb Wills went short and took turns using the odd oar. A big
swell was thundering against the cliffs and at times we were almost
driven on to the rocks by swirling green waters. We had to keep
close inshore in order to avoid being embroiled in the raging sea,
which was lashed snow-white and quickened by the furious squalls
into a living mass of sprays. After two hours of strenuous labour
we were almost exhausted, but we were fortunate enough to find
comparative shelter behind a point of rock. Overhead towered the
sheer cliffs for hundreds of feet, the sea-birds that fluttered
from the crannies of the rock dwarfed by the height. The boats
rose and fell in the big swell, but the sea was not breaking in
our little haven, and we rested there while we ate our cold ration.
Some of the men had to stand by the oars in order to pole the
boats off the cliff-face.
After half an hour’s pause I gave the order to start again. The
Dudley Docker was pulling with three oars, as the Stancomb Wills
had the odd one, and she fell away to leeward in a particularly
heavy squall. I anxiously watched her battling up against wind and
sea. It would have been useless to take the James Caird back to
the assistance of the Dudley Docker since we were hard pressed
to make any progress ourselves in the heavier boat. The only
thing was to go ahead and hope for the best. All hands were wet
to the skin again and many men were feeling the cold severely.
We forged on slowly and passed inside a great pillar of rock
standing out to sea and towering to a height of about 2400 ft.
A line of reef stretched between the shore and this pillar, and
I thought as we approached that we would have to face the raging
sea outside; but a break in the white surf revealed a gap in the
reef and we laboured through, with the wind driving clouds of
spray on our port beam. The Stancomb Wills followed safely.
In the stinging spray I lost sight of the Dudley Docker
altogether. It was obvious she would have to go outside the
pillar as she was making so much leeway, but I could not see what
happened to her and I dared not pause. It was a bad time. At
last, about 5 p.m., the James Caird and the Stancomb Wills
reached comparatively calm water and we saw Wild’s beach just
ahead of us. I looked back vainly for the Dudley Docker.
Rocks studded the shallow water round the spit and the sea surged
amongst them. I ordered the Stancomb Wills to run on to the
beach at the place that looked smoothest, and in a few moments the
first boat was ashore, the men jumping out and holding her against
the receding wave. Immediately I saw she was safe I ran the James
Caird in. Some of us scrambled up the beach through the fringe of
the surf and slipped the painter round a rock, so as to hold the
boat against the backwash. Then we began to get the stores and
gear out, working like men possessed, for the boats could not be
pulled up till they had been emptied. The blubber-stove was
quickly alight and the cook began to prepare a hot drink. We were
labouring at the boats when I noticed Rickenson turn white and
stagger in the surf. I pulled him out of reach of the water and
sent him up to the stove, which had been placed in the shelter of
some rocks. McIlroy went to him and found that his heart had been
temporarily unequal to the strain placed upon it. He was in a bad
way and needed prompt medical attention. There are some men who
will do more than their share of work and who will attempt more
than they are physically able to accomplish. Rickenson was one
of these eager souls. He was suffering, like many other members
of the Expedition, from bad salt-water boils. Our wrists, arms,
and legs were attacked. Apparently this infliction was due to
constant soaking with sea-water, the chafing of wet clothes,
and exposure.
I was very anxious about the Dudley Docker, and my eyes as
well as my thoughts were turned eastward as we carried the stores
ashore; but within half an hour the missing boat appeared,
labouring through the spume-white sea, and presently she reached
the comparative calm of the bay. We watched her coming with that
sense of relief that the mariner feels when he crosses the
harbour-bar. The tide was going out rapidly, and Worsley
lightened the Dudley Docker by placing some cases on an outer
rock, where they were retrieved subsequently. Then he beached
his boat, and with many hands at work we soon had our belongings
ashore and our three craft above high-water mark. The spit was
by no means an ideal camping-ground; it was rough, bleak, and
inhospitable—just an acre or two of rock and shingle, with the
sea foaming around it except where the snow-slope, running up to
a glacier, formed the landward boundary. But some of the larger
rocks provided a measure of shelter from the wind, and as we
clustered round the blubber-stove, with the acrid smoke blowing
into our faces, we were quite a cheerful company. After all,
another stage of the homeward journey had been accomplished and
we could afford to forget for an hour the problems of the future.
Life was not so bad. We ate our evening meal while the snow drifted
down from the surface of the glacier, and our chilled bodies grew warm.
Then we dried a little tobacco at the stove and enjoyed our pipes
before we crawled into our tents. The snow had made it impossible
for us to find the tide-line and we were uncertain how far the sea
was going to encroach upon our beach. I pitched my tent on
the seaward side of the camp so that I might have early warning
of danger, and, sure enough, about 2 a.m. a little wave forced its
way under the tent-cloth. This was a practical demonstration that
we had not gone far enough back from the sea, but in the semi-darkness
it was difficult to see where we could find safety. Perhaps it was
fortunate that experience had inured us to the unpleasantness of
sudden forced changes of camp. We took down the tents and re-pitched
them close against the high rocks at the seaward end of
the spit, where large boulders made an uncomfortable resting-place.
Snow was falling heavily. Then all hands had to assist in pulling
the boats farther up the beach, and at this task we suffered a
serious misfortune. Two of our four bags of clothing had been
placed under the bilge of the James Caird, and before we realized
the danger a wave had lifted the boat and carried the two bags back
into the surf. We had no chance of recovering them. This accident
did not complete the tale of the night’s misfortunes. The big eight-man
tent was blown to pieces in the early morning. Some of the men
who had occupied it took refuge in other tents, but several remained
in their sleeping-bags under the fragments of cloth until it was time
to turn out.
A southerly gale was blowing on the morning of April 18 and the
drifting snow was covering everything. The outlook was cheerless
indeed, but much work had to be done and we could not yield to the
desire to remain in the sleeping-bags. Some sea-elephants were
lying about the beach above high-water mark, and we killed several
of the younger ones for their meat and blubber. The big tent could
not be replaced, and in order to provide shelter for the men we
turned the Dudley Docker upside down and wedged up the weather
side with boulders. We also lashed the painter and stern-rope
round the heaviest rocks we could find, so as to guard against the
danger of the boat being moved by the wind. The two bags of
clothing were bobbing about amid the brash and glacier-ice to the
windward side of the spit, and it did not seem possible to reach
them. The gale continued all day, and the fine drift from the
surface of the glacier was added to the big flakes of snow falling
from the sky. I made a careful examination of the spit with the
object of ascertaining its possibilities as a camping-ground.
Apparently, some of the beach lay above high-water mark and the
rocks that stood above the shingle gave a measure of shelter.
It would be possible to mount the snow-slope towards the glacier
in fine weather, but I did not push my exploration in that
direction during the gale. At the seaward end of the spit was
the mass of rock already mentioned. A few thousand ringed
penguins, with some gentoos, were on these rocks, and we had noted
this fact with a great deal of satisfaction at the time of our
landing. The ringed penguin is by no means the best of the
penguins from the point of view of the hungry traveller, but it
represents food. At 8 a.m. that morning I noticed the ringed
penguins mustering in orderly fashion close to the water’s edge,
and thought that they were preparing for the daily fishing
excursion; but presently it became apparent that some important
move was on foot. They were going to migrate, and with their
departure much valuable food would pass beyond our reach.
Hurriedly we armed ourselves with pieces of sledge-runner and other
improvised clubs, and started towards the rookery. We were too
late. The leaders gave their squawk of command and the columns
took to the sea in unbroken ranks. Following their leaders, the
penguins dived through the surf and reappeared in the heaving water
beyond. A very few of the weaker birds took fright and made their
way back to the beach, where they fell victims later to our
needs; but the main army went northwards and we saw them no more.
We feared that the gentoo penguins might follow the example of
their ringed cousins, but they stayed with us; apparently they
had not the migratory habit. They were comparatively few in
number, but from time to time they would come in from the sea and
walk up our beach. The gentoo is the most strongly marked of all
the smaller varieties of penguins as far as colouring is concerned,
and it far surpasses the adelie in weight of legs and breast, the
points that particularly appealed to us.
The deserted rookery was sure to be above high-water mark at all
times; and we mounted the rocky ledge in search of a place to
pitch our tents. The penguins knew better than to rest where the
sea could reach them even when the highest tide was supported by
the strongest gale. The disadvantages of a camp on the rookery
were obvious. The smell was strong, to put it mildly, and was not
likely to grow less pronounced when the warmth of our bodies thawed
the surface. But our choice of places was not wide, and that
afternoon we dug out a site for two tents in the debris of the
rookery, levelling it off with snow and rocks. My tent, No. 1,
was pitched close under the cliff, and there during my stay on
Elephant Island I lived. Crean’s tent was close by, and the other
three tents, which had fairly clean snow under them, were some yards
away. The fifth tent was a ramshackle affair. The material of
the torn eight-man tent had been drawn over a rough framework of
oars, and shelter of a kind provided for the men who occupied it.
The arrangement of our camp, the checking of our gear, the killing
and skinning of seals and sea-elephants occupied us during the day,
and we took to our sleeping-bags early. I and my companions in
No. 1 tent were not destined to spend a pleasant night. The heat of
our bodies soon melted the snow and refuse beneath us and the floor
of the tent became an evil smelling yellow mud. The snow drifting
from the cliff above us weighted the sides of the tent, and during
the night a particularly stormy gust brought our little home down
on top of us. We stayed underneath the snow-laden cloth till the
morning, for it seemed a hopeless business to set about re-pitching
the tent amid the storm that was raging in the darkness of the night.
The weather was still bad on the morning of April 19. Some of the
men were showing signs of demoralization. They were disinclined
to leave the tents when the hour came for turning out, and it was
apparent they were thinking more of the discomforts of the moment
than of the good fortune that had brought us to sound ground and
comparative safety. The condition of the gloves and headgear shown
me by some discouraged men illustrated the proverbial carelessness
of the sailor. The articles had frozen stiff during the night,
and the owners considered, it appeared, that this state of affairs
provided them with a grievance, or at any rate gave them the right
to grumble. They said they wanted dry clothes and that their health
would not admit of their doing any work. Only by rather drastic
methods were they induced to turn to. Frozen gloves and helmets
undoubtedly are very uncomfortable, and the proper thing is to keep
these articles thawed by placing them inside one’s shirt during
the night.
The southerly gale, bringing with it much snow, was so severe that
as I went along the beach to kill a seal I was blown down by a
gust. The cooking-pots from No. 2 tent took a flying run into the
sea at the same moment. A case of provisions which had been placed
on them to keep them safe had been capsized by a squall. These
pots, fortunately, were not essential, since nearly all our
cooking was done over the blubber-stove. The galley was set up by
the rocks close to my tent, in a hole we had dug through the
debris of the penguin rookery. Cases of stores gave some shelter
from the wind and a spread sail kept some of the snow off the cook
when he was at work. He had not much idle time. The amount of
seal and sea-elephant steak and blubber consumed by our hungry
party was almost incredible. He did not lack assistance—the
neighbourhood of the blubber-stove had attractions for every
member of the party; but he earned everybody’s gratitude by his
unflagging energy in preparing meals that to us at least were
savoury and satisfying. Frankly, we needed all the comfort that
the hot food could give us. The icy fingers of the gale searched
every cranny of our beach and pushed relentlessly through our
worn garments and tattered tents. The snow, drifting from the
glacier and falling from the skies, swathed us and our gear and
set traps for our stumbling feet. The rising sea beat against
the rocks and shingle and tossed fragments of floe-ice within a
few feet of our boats. Once during the morning the sun shone
through the racing clouds and we had a glimpse of blue sky; but
the promise of fair weather was not redeemed. The consoling feature
of the situation was that our camp was safe. We could endure the
discomforts, and I felt that all hands would be benefited by the
opportunity for rest and recuperation.
THE BOAT JOURNEY
The increasing sea made it necessary for us to drag the boats
farther up the beach. This was a task for all hands, and after
much labour we got the boats into safe positions among the rocks
and made fast the painters to big boulders. Then I discussed with
Wild and Worsley the chances of reaching South Georgia before the
winter locked the seas against us. Some effort had to be made to
secure relief. Privation and exposure had left their mark on the
party, and the health and mental condition of several men were
causing me serious anxiety. Blackborrow’s feet, which had been
frost-bitten during the boat journey, were in a bad way, and the
two doctors feared that an operation would be necessary. They
told me that the toes would have to be amputated unless animation
could be restored within a short period. Then the food-supply was
a vital consideration. We had left ten cases of provisions in
the crevice of the rocks at our first camping-place on the island.
An examination of our stores showed that we had full rations for
the whole party for a period of five weeks. The rations could be
spread over three months on a reduced allowance and probably would
be supplemented by seals and sea-elephants to some extent. I did
not dare to count with full confidence on supplies of meat and
blubber, for the animals seemed to have deserted the beach and the
winter was near. Our stocks included three seals and two and a
half skins (with blubber attached). We were mainly dependent on
the blubber for fuel, and, after making a preliminary survey of
the situation, I decided that the party must be limited to one hot
meal a day.
A boat journey in search of relief was necessary and must not be
delayed. That conclusion was forced upon me. The nearest port
where assistance could certainly be secured was Port Stanley, in
the Falkland Islands, 540 miles away, but we could scarcely hope
to beat up against the prevailing north-westerly wind in a frail
and weakened boat with a small sail area. South Georgia was over
800 miles away, but lay in the area of the west winds, and I could
count upon finding whalers at any of the whaling-stations on the
east coast. A boat party might make the voyage and be back with
relief within a month, provided that the sea was clear of ice and
the boat survive the great seas. It was not difficult to decide
that South Georgia must be the objective, and I proceeded to plan
ways and means. The hazards of a boat journey across 800 miles of
stormy sub-Antarctic ocean were obvious, but I calculated that at
worst the venture would add nothing to the risks of the men left
on the island. There would be fewer mouths to feed during the
winter and the boat would not require to take more than one month’s
provisions for six men, for if we did not make South Georgia in
that time we were sure to go under. A consideration that had
weight with me was that there was no chance at all of any search
being made for us on Elephant Island.
The case required to be argued in some detail, since all hands
knew that the perils of the proposed journey were extreme. The
risk was justified solely by our urgent need of assistance. The
ocean south of Cape Horn in the middle of May is known to be the
most tempestuous storm-swept area of water in the world. The
weather then is unsettled, the skies are dull and overcast, and
the gales are almost unceasing. We had to face these conditions
in a small and weather-beaten boat, already strained by the work
of the months that had passed. Worsley and Wild realized that
the attempt must be made, and they both asked to be allowed to
accompany me on the voyage. I told Wild at once that he would
have to stay behind. I relied upon him to hold the party together
while I was away and to make the best of his way to Deception
Island with the men in the spring in the event of our failure to
bring help. Worsley I would take with me, for I had a very high
opinion of his accuracy and quickness as a navigator, and
especially in the snapping and working out of positions in
difficult circumstances—an opinion that was only enhanced during
the actual journey. Four other men would be required, and I
decided to call for volunteers, although, as a matter of fact,
I pretty well knew which of the people I would select. Crean
I proposed to leave on the island as a right-hand man for Wild,
but he begged so hard to be allowed to come in the boat that,
after consultation with Wild, I promised to take him. I called
the men together, explained my plan, and asked for volunteers.
Many came forward at once. Some were not fit enough for the
work that would have to be done, and others would not have been
much use in the boat since they were not seasoned sailors, though
the experiences of recent months entitled them to some consideration
as seafaring men. McIlroy and Macklin were both anxious to go
but realized that their duty lay on the island with the sick men.
They suggested that I should take Blackborrow in order that he
might have shelter and warmth as quickly as possible, but I had
to veto this idea. It would be hard enough for fit men to live
in the boat. Indeed, I did not see how a sick man, lying helpless
in the bottom of the boat, could possibly survive in the heavy
weather we were sure to encounter. I finally selected McNeish,
McCarthy, and Vincent in addition to Worsley and Crean. The crew
seemed a strong one, and as I looked at the men I felt confidence
increasing.
The decision made, I walked through the blizzard with Worsley and
Wild to examine the James Caird. The 20-ft. boat had never
looked big; she appeared to have shrunk in some mysterious way
when I viewed her in the light of our new undertaking. She was
an ordinary ship’s whaler, fairly strong, but showing signs of the
strains she had endured since the crushing of the Endurance. Where
she was holed in leaving the pack was, fortunately, about the
water-line and easily patched. Standing beside her, we glanced at
the fringe of the storm-swept, tumultuous sea that formed our path.
Clearly, our voyage would be a big adventure. I called the
carpenter and asked him if he could do anything to make the boat
more seaworthy. He first inquired if he was to go with me, and
seemed quite pleased when I said “Yes.” He was over fifty years
of age and not altogether fit, but he had a good knowledge of
sailing-boats and was very quick. McCarthy said that he could
contrive some sort of covering for the James Caird if he might use
the lids of the cases and the four sledge-runners that we had
lashed inside the boat for use in the event of a landing on Graham
Land at Wilhelmina Bay. This bay, at one time the goal of our
desire, had been left behind in the course of our drift, but we
had retained the runners. The carpenter proposed to complete the
covering with some of our canvas; and he set about making his
plans at once.
Noon had passed and the gale was more severe than ever. We could
not proceed with our preparations that day. The tents were
suffering in the wind and the sea was rising. We made our way to
the snow-slope at the shoreward end of the spit, with the intention
of digging a hole in the snow large enough to provide shelter for
the party. I had an idea that Wild and his men might camp there
during my absence, since it seemed impossible that the tents could
hold together for many more days against the attacks of the wind;
but an examination of the spot indicated that any hole we could
dig probably would be filled quickly by the drift. At dark,
about 5 p.m., we all turned in, after a supper consisting of a
pannikin of hot milk, one of our precious biscuits, and a cold
penguin leg each.
The gale was stronger than ever on the following morning (April
20). No work could be done. Blizzard and snow, snow and blizzard,
sudden lulls and fierce returns. During the lulls we could see on
the far horizon to the north-east bergs of all shapes and sizes
driving along before the gale, and the sinister appearance of
the swift-moving masses made us thankful indeed that, instead of
battling with the storm amid the ice, we were required only to
face the drift from the glaciers and the inland heights.
The gusts might throw us off our feet, but at least we fell on
solid ground and not on the rocking floes. Two seals came up on
the beach that day, one of them within ten yards of my tent. So
urgent was our need of food and blubber that I called all hands
and organized a line of beaters instead of simply walking up to
the seal and hitting it on the nose. We were prepared to fall upon
this seal en masse if it attempted to escape. The kill was made
with a pick-handle, and in a few minutes five days’ food and six
days’ fuel were stowed in a place of safety among the boulders
above high-water mark. During this day the cook, who had worked
well on the floe and throughout the boat journey, suddenly
collapsed. I happened to be at the galley at the moment and saw
him fall. I pulled him down the slope to his tent and pushed him
into its shelter with orders to his tent-mates to keep him in his
sleeping-bag until I allowed him to come out or the doctors said
he was fit enough. Then I took out to replace the cook one of
the men who had expressed a desire to lie down and die. The
task of keeping the galley fire alight was both difficult and
strenuous, and it took his thoughts away from the chances of
immediate dissolution. In fact, I found him a little later
gravely concerned over the drying of a naturally not over-clean
pair of socks which were hung up in close proximity to our evening
milk. Occupation had brought his thoughts back to the ordinary
cares of life.
There was a lull in the bad weather on April 21, and the
carpenter started to collect material for the decking of the
James Caird. He fitted the mast of the Stancomb Wills fore
and aft inside the James Caird as a hog-back and thus strengthened
the keel with the object of preventing our boat “hogging”—that
is, buckling in heavy seas. He had not sufficient wood to provide
a deck, but by using the sledge-runners and box-lids he made a
framework extending from the forecastle aft to a well. It was a
patched-up affair, but it provided a base for a canvas covering.
We had a bolt of canvas frozen stiff, and this material had to be
cut and then thawed out over the blubber-stove, foot by foot, in
order that it might be sewn into the form of a cover. When it had
been nailed and screwed into position it certainly gave an appearance
of safety to the boat, though I had an uneasy feeling that it bore
a strong likeness to stage scenery, which may look like a granite
wall and is in fact nothing better than canvas and lath. As events
proved, the covering served its purpose well. We certainly could
not have lived through the voyage without it.
Another fierce gale was blowing on April 22, interfering with our
preparations for the voyage. The cooker from No. 5 tent came adrift
in a gust, and, although it was chased to the water’s edge, it
disappeared for good. Blackborrow’s feet were giving him much
pain, and McIlroy and Macklin thought it would be necessary for
them to operate soon. They were under the impression then that
they had no chloroform, but they found some subsequently in the
medicine-chest after we had left. Some cases of stores left on
a rock off the spit on the day of our arrival were retrieved during
this day. We were setting aside stores for the boat journey and
choosing the essential equipment from the scanty stock at our
disposal. Two ten-gallon casks had to be filled with water melted
down from ice collected at the foot of the glacier. This was a
rather slow business. The blubber-stove was kept going all night,
and the watchmen emptied the water into the casks from the pot
in which the ice was melted. A working party started to dig a
hole in the snow-slope about forty feet above sea-level with the
object of providing a site for a camp. They made fairly good
progress at first, but the snow drifted down unceasingly from
the inland ice, and in the end the party had to give up the
project.
The weather was fine on April 23, and we hurried forward our
preparations. It was on this day I decided finally that the crew
for the James Caird should consist of Worsley, Crean, McNeish,
McCarthy, Vincent, and myself. A storm came on about noon, with
driving snow and heavy squalls. Occasionally the air would clear
for a few minutes, and we could see a line of pack-ice, five miles
out, driving across from west to east. This sight increased my
anxiety to get away quickly. Winter was advancing, and soon the
pack might close completely round the island and stay our
departure for days or even for weeks, I did not think that ice
would remain around Elephant Island continuously during
the winter, since the strong winds and fast currents would keep it
in motion. We had noticed ice and bergs, going past at the rate
of four or five knots. A certain amount of ice was held up about
the end of our spit, but the sea was clear where the boat would
have to be launched.
Worsley, Wild, and I climbed to the summit of the seaward rocks
and examined the ice from a better vantage-point than the beach
offered. The belt of pack outside appeared to be sufficiently
broken for our purposes, and I decided that, unless the conditions
forbade it, we would make a start in the James Caird on the
following morning. Obviously the pack might close at any
time. This decision made, I spent the rest of the day looking
over the boat, gear, and stores, and discussing plans with Worsley
and Wild.
Our last night on the solid ground of Elephant Island was cold and
uncomfortable. We turned out at dawn and had breakfast. Then we
launched the Stancomb Wills and loaded her with stores, gear, and
ballast, which would be transferred to the James Caird when the
heavier boat had been launched. The ballast consisted of bags made
from blankets and filled with sand, making a total weight of about
1000 lbs. In addition we had gathered a number of round boulders
and about 250 lbs. of ice, which would supplement our two casks of
water.
The stores taken in the James Caird, which would last six men for
one month, were as follows:
30 boxes of matches.
6½ gallons paraffin.
1 tin methylated spirit.
10 boxes of flamers.
1 box of blue lights.
2 Primus stoves with spare parts and prickers.
1 Nansen aluminium cooker.
6 sleeping-bags.
A few spare socks.
A few candles and some blubber-oil in an oil-bag.
Food:
3 cases sledging rations = 300 rations.
2 cases nut food = 200 ”
2 cases biscuits = 600 biscuits.
1 case lump sugar.
30 packets of Trumilk.
1 tin. of Bovril cubes.
1 tin of Cerebos salt.
36 gallons of water.
250 lbs. of ice.
Instruments:
Sextant.
Sea-anchor.
Binoculars.
Charts.
Prismatic compass.
Aneroid.
The swell was slight when the Stancomb Wills was launched and
the boat got under way without any difficulty; but half an hour
later, when we were pulling down the James Caird, the swell
increased suddenly. Apparently the movement of the ice outside
had made an opening and allowed the sea to run in without being
blanketed by the line of pack. The swell made things difficult.
Many of us got wet to the waist while dragging the boat out—a
serious matter in that climate. When the James Caird was afloat
in the surf she nearly capsized among the rocks before we could get
her clear, and Vincent and the carpenter, who were on the deck,
were thrown into the water. This was really bad luck, for the two
men would have small chance of drying their clothes after we had
got under way. Hurley, who had the eye of the professional
photographer for “incidents,” secured a picture of the upset,
and I firmly believe that he would have liked the two unfortunate
men to remain in the water until he could get a “snap” at close
quarters; but we hauled them out immediately, regardless of his
feelings.
The James Caird was soon clear of the breakers. We used all the
available ropes as a long painter to prevent her drifting away to
the north-east, and then the Stancomb Wills came alongside,
transferred her load, and went back to the shore for more. As she
was being beached this time the sea took her stern and half filled
her with water. She had to be turned over and emptied before the
return journey could be made. Every member of the crew of the
Stancomb Wills was wet to the skin. The water-casks were towed
behind the Stancomb Wills on this second journey, and the swell,
which was increasing rapidly, drove the boat on to the rocks, where
one of the casks was slightly stove in. This accident proved later
to be a serious one, since some sea-water had entered the cask and
the contents were now brackish.
By midday the James Caird was ready for the voyage. Vincent and
the carpenter had secured some dry clothes by exchange with
members of the shore party (I heard afterwards that it was a full
fortnight before the soaked garments were finally dried), and the
boat’s crew was standing by waiting for the order to cast off.
A moderate westerly breeze was blowing. I went ashore in the
Stancomb Wills and had a last word with Wild, who was remaining
in full command, with directions as to his course of action in the
event of our failure to bring relief, but I practically left the
whole situation and scope of action and decision to his own
judgment, secure in the knowledge that he would act wisely. I told
him that I trusted the party to him and said good-bye to the men.
Then we pushed off for the last time, and within a few minutes
I was aboard the James Caird. The crew of the Stancomb Wills
shook hands with us as the boats bumped together and offered us
the last good wishes. Then, setting our jib, we cut the painter
and moved away to the north-east. The men who were staying behind
made a pathetic little group on the beach, with the grim heights
of the island behind them and the sea seething at their feet, but
they waved to us and gave three hearty cheers. There was hope in
their hearts and they trusted us to bring the help that they needed.
I had all sails set, and the James Caird quickly dipped the beach
and its line of dark figures. The westerly wind took us rapidly
to the line of pack, and as we entered it I stood up with my arm
around the mast, directing the steering, so as to avoid the great
lumps of ice that were flung about in the heave of the sea. The
pack thickened and we were forced to turn almost due east, running
before the wind towards a gap I had seen in the morning from the
high ground. I could not see the gap now, but we had come out on
its bearing and I was prepared to find that it had been influenced
by the easterly drift. At four o’clock in the afternoon we found
the channel, much narrower than it had seemed in the morning but
still navigable. Dropping sail, we rowed through without touching
the ice anywhere, and by 5.30 p.m. we were clear of the pack with
open water before us. We passed one more piece of ice in the
darkness an hour later, but the pack lay behind, and with a fair
wind swelling the sails we steered our little craft through the
night, our hopes centred on our distant goal. The swell was very
heavy now, and when the time came for our first evening meal we
found great difficulty in keeping the Primus lamp alight and
preventing the hoosh splashing out of the pot. Three men were
needed to attend to the cooking, one man holding the lamp and two
men guarding the aluminium cooking-pot, which had to be lifted
clear of the Primus whenever the movement of the boat threatened
to cause a disaster. Then the lamp had to be protected from water,
for sprays were coming over the bows and our flimsy decking was by
no means water-tight. All these operations were conducted in the
confined space under the decking, where the men lay or knelt and
adjusted themselves as best they could to the angles of our cases
and ballast. It was uncomfortable, but we found consolation in the
reflection that without the decking we could not have used the
cooker at all.
The tale of the next sixteen days is one of supreme strife amid
heaving waters. The sub-Antarctic Ocean lived up to its evil
winter reputation. I decided to run north for at least two days
while the wind held and so get into warmer weather before turning
to the east and laying a course for South Georgia. We took
two-hourly spells at the tiller. The men who were not on watch
crawled into the sodden sleeping-bags and tried to forget their
troubles for a period; but there was no comfort in the boat.
The bags and cases seemed to be alive in the unfailing knack of
presenting their most uncomfortable angles to our rest-seeking
bodies. A man might imagine for a moment that he had found a
position of ease, but always discovered quickly that some
unyielding point was impinging on muscle or bone. The first night
aboard the boat was one of acute discomfort for us all, and we were
heartily glad when the dawn came and we could set about the
preparation of a hot breakfast.
This record of the voyage to South Georgia is based upon scanty
notes made day by day. The notes dealt usually with the bare
facts of distances, positions, and weather, but our memories
retained the incidents of the passing days in a period never to
be forgotten. By running north for the first two days I hoped to
get warmer weather and also to avoid lines of pack that might be
extending beyond the main body. We needed all the advantage that
we could obtain from the higher latitude for sailing on the great
circle, but we had to be cautious regarding possible ice-streams.
Cramped in our narrow quarters and continually wet by the spray,
we suffered severely from cold throughout the journey. We fought
the seas and the winds and at the same time had a daily struggle
to keep ourselves alive. At times we were in dire peril. Generally
we were upheld by the knowledge that we were making progress towards
the land where we would be, but there were days and nights when we
lay hove to, drifting across the storm-whitened seas and watching
with eyes interested rather than apprehensive the uprearing masses
of water, flung to and fro by Nature in the pride of her strength.
Deep seemed the valleys when we lay between the reeling seas. High
were the hills when we perched momentarily on the tops of giant
combers. Nearly always there were gales. So small was our boat and
so great were the seas that often our sail flapped idly in the calm
between the crests of two waves. Then we would climb the next slope
and catch the full fury of the gale where the wool-like whiteness
of the breaking water surged around us. We had our moments of
laughter—rare, it is true, but hearty enough. Even when cracked
lips and swollen mouths checked the outward and visible signs of
amusement we could see a joke of the primitive kind. Man’s sense
of humour is always most easily stirred by the petty misfortunes
of his neighbours, and I shall never forget Worsley’s efforts on
one occasion to place the hot aluminium stand on top of the Primus
stove after it had fallen off in an extra heavy roll. With his
frost-bitten fingers he picked it up, dropped it, picked it up
again, and toyed with it gingerly as though it were some fragile
article of lady’s wear. We laughed, or rather gurgled with laughter.
The wind came up strong and worked into a gale from the north-west
on the third day out. We stood away to the east. The increasing
seas discovered the weaknesses of our decking. The continuous blows
shifted the box-lids and sledge-runners so that the canvas sagged
down and accumulated water. Then icy trickles, distinct from the
driving sprays, poured fore and aft into the boat. The nails that
the carpenter had extracted from cases at Elephant Island and used
to fasten down the battens were too short to make firm the decking.
We did what we could to secure it, but our means were very limited,
and the water continued to enter the boat at a dozen points. Much
baling was necessary, and nothing that we could do prevented our
gear from becoming sodden. The searching runnels from the canvas
were really more unpleasant than the sudden definite douches of
the sprays. Lying under the thwarts during watches below, we tried
vainly to avoid them. There were no dry places in the boat, and at
last we simply covered our heads with our Burberrys and endured the
all-pervading water. The baling was work for the watch. Real rest
we had none. The perpetual motion of the boat made repose
impossible; we were cold, sore, and anxious. We moved on hands and
knees in the semi-darkness of the day under the decking. The
darkness was complete by 6 p.m., and not until 7 a.m. of the following
day could we see one another under the thwarts. We had a few scraps
of candle, and they were preserved carefully in order that we might
have light at meal-times. There was one fairly dry spot in the
boat, under the solid original decking at the bows, and we managed
to protect some of our biscuit from the salt water; but I do not
think any of us got the taste of salt out of our mouths during the
voyage.
The difficulty of movement in the boat would have had its humorous
side if it had not involved us in so many aches and pains. We had
to crawl under the thwarts in order to move along the boat, and our
knees suffered considerably. When watch turned out it was necessary
for me to direct each man by name when and where to move, since if
all hands had crawled about at the same time the result would have
been dire confusion and many bruises. Then there was the trim of
the boat to be considered. The order of the watch was four hours on
and four hours off, three men to the watch. One man had the tiller-ropes,
the second man attended to the sail, and the third baled for
all he was worth. Sometimes when the water in the boat had been
reduced to reasonable proportions, our pump could be used. This
pump, which Hurley had made from the Flinder’s bar case of our ship’s
standard compass, was quite effective, though its capacity was not
large. The man who was attending the sail could pump into the big
outer cooker, which was lifted and emptied overboard when filled.
We had a device by which the water could go direct from the pump
into the sea through a hole in the gunwale, but this hole had to
be blocked at an early stage of the voyage, since we found that
it admitted water when the boat rolled.
While a new watch was shivering in the wind and spray, the men who
had been relieved groped hurriedly among the soaked sleeping-bags
and tried to steal a little of the warmth created by the last
occupants; but it was not always possible for us to find even this
comfort when we went off watch. The boulders that we had taken
aboard for ballast had to be shifted continually in order to trim
the boat and give access to the pump, which became choked with
hairs from the moulting sleeping-bags and finneskoe. The four
reindeer-skin sleeping-bags shed their hair freely owing to the
continuous wetting, and soon became quite bald in appearance.
The moving of the boulders was weary and painful work. We came
to know every one of the stones by sight and touch, and I have
vivid memories of their angular peculiarities even to-day. They
might have been of considerable interest as geological specimens
to a scientific man under happier conditions. As ballast they
were useful. As weights to be moved about in cramped quarters
they were simply appalling. They spared no portion of our poor
bodies. Another of our troubles, worth mention here, was the
chafing of our legs by our wet clothes, which had not been changed
now for seven months. The insides of our thighs were rubbed raw,
and the one tube of Hazeline cream in our medicine-chest did not go
far in alleviating our pain, which was increased by the bite of
the salt water. We thought at the time that we never slept.
The fact was that we would doze off uncomfortably, to be aroused
quickly by some new ache or another call to effort. My own
share of the general unpleasantness was accentuated by a finely
developed bout of sciatica. I had become possessor of this
originally on the floe several months earlier.
Our meals were regular in spite of the gales. Attention to this
point was essential, since the conditions of the voyage made
increasing calls upon our vitality. Breakfast, at 8 a.m.,
consisted of a pannikin of hot hoosh made from Bovril sledging
ration, two biscuits, and some lumps of sugar. Lunch came at
1 p.m., and comprised Bovril sledging ration, eaten raw, and
a pannikin of hot milk for each man. Tea, at 5 p.m., had the
same menu. Then during the night we had a hot drink, generally
of milk. The meals were the bright beacons in those cold and
stormy days. The glow of warmth and comfort produced by the food
and drink made optimists of us all. We had two tins of Virol,
which we were keeping for an emergency; but, finding ourselves
in need of an oil-lamp to eke out our supply of candles, we
emptied one of the tins in the manner that most appealed to us,
and fitted it with a wick made by shredding a bit of canvas. When
this lamp was filled with oil it gave a certain amount of light,
though it was easily blown out, and was of great assistance to us
at night. We were fairly well off as regarded fuel, since we had
6½ gallons of petroleum.
A severe south-westerly gale on the fourth day out forced us to
heave to. I would have liked to have run before the wind, but
the sea was very high and the James Caird was in danger of
broaching to and swamping. The delay was vexatious, since up to
that time we had been making sixty or seventy miles a day, good
going with our limited sail area. We hove to under double-reefed
mainsail and our little jigger, and waited for the gale to blow
itself out. During that afternoon we saw bits of wreckage, the
remains probably of some unfortunate vessel that had failed to
weather the strong gales south of Cape Horn. The weather
conditions did not improve, and on the fifth day out the gale was
so fierce that we were compelled to take in the double-reefed
mainsail and hoist our small jib instead. We put out a sea-anchor
to keep the James Caird’s head up to the sea. This anchor
consisted of a triangular canvas bag fastened to the end of the
painter and allowed to stream out from the bows. The boat
was high enough to catch the wind, and, as she drifted to leeward,
the drag of the anchor kept her head to windward. Thus our boat
took most of the seas more or less end on. Even then the crests
of the waves often would curl right over us and we shipped a great
deal of water, which necessitated unceasing baling and pumping.
Looking out abeam, we would see a hollow like a tunnel formed as
the crest of a big wave toppled over on to the swelling body of water.
A thousand times it appeared as though the James Caird must be
engulfed; but the boat lived. The south-westerly gale had its
birthplace above the Antarctic Continent, and its freezing breath
lowered the temperature far towards zero. The sprays froze upon
the boat and gave bows, sides, and decking a heavy coat of mail.
This accumulation of ice reduced the buoyancy of the boat, and to
that extent was an added peril; but it possessed a notable advantage
from one point of view. The water ceased to drop and trickle from
the canvas, and the spray came in solely at the well in the after
part of the boat. We could not allow the load of ice to grow beyond
a certain point, and in turns we crawled about the decking forward,
chipping and picking at it with the available tools.
When daylight came on the morning of the sixth day out we saw
and felt that the James Caird had lost her resiliency. She was not
rising to the oncoming seas. The weight of the ice that had formed
in her and upon her during the night was having its effect, and she
was becoming more like a log than a boat. The situation called for
immediate action. We first broke away the spare oars, which were
encased in ice and frozen to the sides of the boat, and threw them
overboard. We retained two oars for use when we got inshore. Two
of the fur sleeping-bags went over the side; they were thoroughly
wet, weighing probably 40 lbs. each, and they had frozen stiff
during the night. Three men constituted the watch below, and when
a man went down it was better to turn into the wet bag just vacated
by another man than to thaw out a frozen bag with the heat of his
unfortunate body. We now had four bags, three in use and one for
emergency use in case a member of the party should break down
permanently. The reduction of weight relieved the boat to some
extent, and vigorous chipping and scraping did more. We had to
be very careful not to put axe or knife through the frozen canvas
of the decking as we crawled over it, but gradually we got rid of
a lot of ice. The James Caird lifted to the endless waves as
though she lived again.
About 11 a.m. the boat suddenly fell off into the trough of the
sea. The painter had parted and the sea-anchor had gone. This
was serious. The James Caird went away to leeward, and we
had no chance at all of recovering the anchor and our valuable
rope, which had been our only means of keeping the boat’s head up
to the seas without the risk of hoisting sail in a gale. Now we
had to set the sail and trust to its holding. While the James
Caird rolled heavily in the trough, we beat the frozen canvas
until the bulk of the ice had cracked off it and then hoisted
it. The frozen gear worked protestingly, but after a struggle
our little craft came up to the wind again, and we breathed
more freely. Skin frost-bites were troubling us, and we had
developed large blisters on our fingers and hands. I shall
always carry the scar of one of these frost-bites on my left
hand, which became badly inflamed after the skin had burst and
the cold had bitten deeply.
We held the boat up to the gale during that day, enduring as
best we could discomforts that amounted to pain. The boat
tossed interminably on the big waves under grey, threatening
skies. Our thoughts did not embrace much more than the
necessities of the hour. Every surge of the sea was an enemy
to be watched and circumvented. We ate our scanty meals,
treated our frost-bites, and hoped for the improved conditions
that the morrow might bring. Night fell early, and in the
lagging hours of darkness we were cheered by a change for the
better in the weather. The wind dropped, the snow-squalls became
less frequent, and the sea moderated. When the morning of the
seventh day dawned there was not much wind. We shook the reef
out of the sail and laid our course once more for South Georgia.
The sun came out bright and clear, and presently Worsley got a
snap for longitude. We hoped that the sky would remain clear
until noon, so that we could get the latitude. We had been six
days out without an observation, and our dead reckoning naturally
was uncertain. The boat must have presented a strange appearance
that morning. All hands basked in the sun. We hung our sleeping-bags
to the mast and spread our socks and other gear all over the
deck. Some of the ice had melted off the James Caird in the
early morning after the gale began to slacken; and dry patches were
appearing in the decking. Porpoises came blowing round the boat,
and Cape pigeons wheeled and swooped within a few feet of us.
These little black-and-white birds have an air of friendliness that
is not possessed by the great circling albatross. They had looked
grey against the swaying sea during the storm as they darted about
over our heads and uttered their plaintive cries. The albatrosses,
of the black or sooty variety, had watched with hard, bright eyes,
and seemed to have a quite impersonal interest in our struggle to
keep afloat amid the battering seas. In addition to the Cape pigeons
an occasional stormy petrel flashed overhead. Then there was a
small bird, unknown to me, that appeared always to be in a fussy,
bustling state, quite out of keeping with the surroundings. It
irritated me. It had practically no tail, and it flitted about
vaguely as though in search of the lost member. I used to find
myself wishing it would find its tail and have done with the silly
fluttering.
We revelled in the warmth of the sun that day. Life was not so bad,
after all. We felt we were well on our way. Our gear was drying,
and we could have a hot meal in comparative comfort. The swell was
still heavy, but it was not breaking and the boat rode easily. At
noon Worsley balanced himself on the gunwale and clung with one hand
to the stay of the mainmast while he got a snap of the sun. The
result was more than encouraging. We had done over 380 miles and
were getting on for half-way to South Georgia. It looked as though
we were going to get through.
The wind freshened to a good stiff breeze during the afternoon, and
the James Caird made satisfactory progress. I had not realized
until the sunlight came how small our boat really was. There was
some influence in the light and warmth, some hint of happier days,
that made us revive memories of other voyages, when we had stout
decks beneath our feet, unlimited food at our command, and pleasant
cabins for our ease. Now we clung to a battered little boat,
“alone, alone—all, all alone; alone on a wide, wide sea.” So
low in the water were we that each succeeding swell cut off our
view of the sky-line. We were a tiny speck in the vast vista of
the sea—the ocean that is open to all and merciful to none, that
threatens even when it seems to yield, and that is pitiless always
to weakness. For a moment the consciousness of the forces arrayed
against us would be almost overwhelming. Then hope and confidence
would rise again as our boat rose to a wave and tossed aside the
crest in a sparkling shower like the play of prismatic colours at
the foot of a waterfall. My double-barrelled gun and some cartridges
had been stowed aboard the boat as an emergency precaution against a
shortage of food, but we were not disposed to destroy our little
neighbours, the Cape pigeons, even for the sake of fresh meat. We
might have shot an albatross, but the wandering king of the ocean
aroused in us something of the feeling that inspired, too late,
the Ancient Mariner. So the gun remained among the stores and
sleeping-bags in the narrow quarters beneath our leaking deck,
and the birds followed us unmolested.
The eighth, ninth, and tenth days of the voyage had few features
worthy of special note. The wind blew hard during those days, and
the strain of navigating the boat was unceasing, but always we made
some advance towards our goal. No bergs showed on our horizon, and
we knew that we were clear of the ice-fields. Each day brought
its little round of troubles, but also compensation in the form of
food and growing hope. We felt that we were going to succeed.
The odds against us had been great, but we were winning through.
We still suffered severely from the cold, for, though the
temperature was rising, our vitality was declining owing to shortage
of food, exposure, and the necessity of maintaining our cramped
positions day and night. I found that it was now absolutely
necessary to prepare hot milk for all hands during the night, in
order to sustain life till dawn. This meant lighting the Primus
lamp in the darkness and involved an increased drain on our small
store of matches. It was the rule that one match must serve
when the Primus was being lit. We had no lamp for the compass and
during the early days of the voyage we would strike a match when
the steersman wanted to see the course at night; but later the
necessity for strict economy impressed itself upon us, and the
practice of striking matches at night was stopped. We had one
water-tight tin of matches. I had stowed away in a pocket, in
readiness for a sunny day, a lens from one of the telescopes,
but this was of no use during the voyage. The sun seldom shone
upon us. The glass of the compass got broken one night, and we
contrived to mend it with adhesive tape from the medicine-chest.
One of the memories that comes to me from those days is of Crean
singing at the tiller. He always sang while he was steering, and
nobody ever discovered what the song was. It was devoid of tune
and as monotonous as the chanting of a Buddhist monk at his prayers;
yet somehow it was cheerful. In moments of inspiration Crean would
attempt “The Wearing of the Green.”
On the tenth night Worsley could not straighten his body after
his spell at the tiller. He was thoroughly cramped, and we had to
drag him beneath the decking and massage him before he could unbend
himself and get into a sleeping-bag. A hard north-westerly gale
came up on the eleventh day (May 5) and shifted to the south-west
in the late afternoon. The sky was overcast and occasional snow-squalls
added to the discomfort produced by a tremendous cross-sea—the worst,
I thought, that we had experienced. At midnight I
was at the tiller and suddenly noticed a line of clear sky between
the south and south-west. I called to the other men that the sky
was clearing, and then a moment later I realized that what I had
seen was not a rift in the clouds but the white crest of an enormous
wave. During twenty-six years’ experience of the ocean in all its
moods I had not encountered a wave so gigantic. It was a mighty
upheaval of the ocean, a thing quite apart from the big white-capped
seas that had been our tireless enemies for many days. I shouted,
“For God’s sake, hold on! It’s got us!” Then came a moment of
suspense that seemed drawn out into hours. White surged the foam
of the breaking sea around us. We felt our boat lifted and flung
forward like a cork in breaking surf. We were in a seething chaos
of tortured water; but somehow the boat lived through it, half-full
of water, sagging to the dead weight and shuddering under the blow.
We baled with the energy of men fighting for life, flinging the
water over the sides with every receptacle that came to our hands,
and after ten minutes of uncertainty we felt the boat renew her
life beneath us. She floated again and ceased to lurch drunkenly
as though dazed by the attack of the sea. Earnestly we hoped that
never again would we encounter such a wave.
The conditions in the boat, uncomfortable before, had been made
worse by the deluge of water. All our gear was thoroughly wet again.
Our cooking-stove had been floating about in the bottom of the boat,
and portions of our last hoosh seemed to have permeated everything.
Not until 3 a.m., when we were all chilled almost to the limit of
endurance, did we manage to get the stove alight and make ourselves
hot drinks. The carpenter was suffering particularly, but he showed
grit and spirit. Vincent had for the past week ceased to be an active
member of the crew, and I could not easily account for his collapse.
Physically he was one of the strongest men in the boat. He was a
young man, he had served on North Sea trawlers, and he should have
been able to bear hardships better than McCarthy, who, not so strong,
was always happy.
The weather was better on the following day (May 6), and we got a
glimpse of the sun. Worsley’s observation showed that we were not
more than a hundred miles from the north-west corner of South
Georgia. Two more days with a favourable wind and we would sight
the promised land. I hoped that there would be no delay, for our
supply of water was running very low. The hot drink at night was
essential, but I decided that the daily allowance of water must be
cut down to half a pint per man. The lumps of ice we had taken
aboard had gone long ago. We were dependent upon the water we had
brought from Elephant Island, and our thirst was increased by the
fact that we were now using the brackish water in the breaker that
had been slightly stove in in the surf when the boat was being
loaded. Some sea-water had entered at that time. Thirst took
possession of us. I dared not permit the allowance of water to be
increased since an unfavourable wind might drive us away from the
island and lengthen our voyage by many days. Lack of water is
always the most severe privation that men can be condemned to endure,
and we found, as during our earlier boat voyage, that the salt water
in our clothing and the salt spray that lashed our faces made our
thirst grow quickly to a burning pain. I had to be very firm in
refusing to allow any one to anticipate the morrow’s allowance,
which I was sometimes begged to do. We did the necessary work
dully and hoped for the land. I had altered the course to the east
so as to make sure of our striking the island, which would have been
impossible to regain if we had run past the northern end. The
course was laid on our scrap of chart for a point some thirty miles
down the coast. That day and the following day passed for us in a
sort of nightmare. Our mouths were dry and our tongues were
swollen. The wind was still strong and the heavy sea forced us to
navigate carefully, but any thought of our peril from the waves was
buried beneath the consciousness of our raging thirst. The bright
moments were those when we each received our one mug of hot milk
during the long, bitter watches of the night. Things were bad for
us in those days, but the end was coming. The morning of May 8
broke thick and stormy, with squalls from the north-west. We
searched the waters ahead for a sign of land, and though we could
see nothing more than had met our eyes for many days, we were
cheered by a sense that the goal was near at hand. About
ten o’clock that morning we passed a little bit of kelp, a glad
signal of the proximity of land. An hour later we saw two shags
sitting on a big mass of kelp, and knew then that we must be within
ten or fifteen miles of the shore. These birds are as sure an
indication of the proximity of land as a lighthouse is, for they
never venture far to sea. We gazed ahead with increasing eagerness,
and at 12.30 p.m., through a rift in the clouds, McCarthy caught
a glimpse of the black cliffs of South Georgia, just fourteen days
after our departure from Elephant Island. It was a glad moment.
Thirst-ridden, chilled, and weak as we were, happiness irradiated us.
The job was nearly done.
We stood in towards the shore to look for a landing-place, and
presently we could see the green tussock-grass on the ledges above
the surf-beaten rocks. Ahead of us and to the south, blind rollers
showed the presence of uncharted reefs along the coast. Here and
there the hungry rocks were close to the surface, and over them
the great waves broke, swirling viciously and spouting thirty and
forty feet into the air. The rocky coast appeared to descend sheer
to the sea. Our need of water and rest was well-nigh desperate, but
to have attempted a landing at that time would have been suicidal.
Night was drawing near, and the weather indications were not
favourable. There was nothing for it but to haul off till the
following morning, so we stood away on the starboard tack until we
had made what appeared to be a safe offing. Then we hove to in
the high westerly swell. The hours passed slowly as we waited
the dawn, which would herald, we fondly hoped, the last stage
of our journey. Our thirst was a torment and we could scarcely
touch our food; the cold seemed to strike right through our weakened
bodies. At 5 a.m. the wind shifted to the north-west and quickly
increased to one of the worst hurricanes any of us had ever
experienced. A great cross-sea was running and the wind simply
shrieked as it tore the tops off the waves and converted the whole
seascape into a haze of driving spray. Down into valleys, up to
tossing heights, straining until her seams opened, swung our little
boat, brave still but labouring heavily. We knew that the wind
and set of the sea was driving us ashore, but we could do nothing.
The dawn showed us a storm-torn ocean, and the morning passed
without bringing us a sight of the land; but at 1 p.m., through
a rift in the flying mists, we got a glimpse of the huge crags
of the island and realized that our position had become desperate.
We were on a dead lee shore, and we could gauge our approach to
the unseen cliffs by the roar of the breakers against the sheer
walls of rock. I ordered the double-reefed mainsail to be set
in the hope that we might claw off, and this attempt increased
the strain upon the boat. The James Caird was bumping heavily,
and the water was pouring in everywhere. Our thirst was forgotten
in the realization of our imminent danger, as we baled unceasingly,
and adjusted our weights from time to time; occasional glimpses showed
that the shore was nearer. I knew that Annewkow Island lay to the
south of us, but our small and badly marked chart showed uncertain
reefs in the passage between the island and the mainland, and I
dared not trust it, though as a last resort we could try to lie
under the lee of the island. The afternoon wore away as we edged
down the coast, with the thunder of the breakers in our ears. The
approach of evening found us still some distance from Annewkow Island,
and, dimly in the twilight, we could see a snow-capped mountain
looming above us. The chance of surviving the night, with the
driving gale and the implacable sea forcing us on to the lee shore,
seemed small. I think most of us had a feeling that the end
was very near. Just after 6 p.m., in the dark, as the boat was
in the yeasty backwash from the seas flung from this iron-bound
coast, then, just when things looked their worst, they changed for
the best. I have marvelled often at the thin line that divides
success from failure and the sudden turn that leads from apparently
certain disaster to comparative safety. The wind suddenly shifted,
and we were free once more to make an offing. Almost as soon as
the gale eased, the pin that locked the mast to the thwart fell out.
It must have been on the point of doing this throughout the hurricane,
and if it had gone nothing could have saved us; the mast would have
snapped like a carrot. Our backstays had carried away once before
when iced up and were not too strongly fastened now. We were
thankful indeed for the mercy that had held that pin in its place
throughout the hurricane.
We stood off shore again, tired almost to the point of apathy. Our
water had long been finished. The last was about a pint of hairy
liquid, which we strained through a bit of gauze from the medicine-chest.
The pangs of thirst attacked us with redoubled intensity,
and I felt that we must make a landing on the following day at almost
any hazard. The night wore on. We were very tired. We longed for
day. When at last the dawn came on the morning of May 10 there was
practically no wind, but a high cross-sea was running. We made
slow progress towards the shore. About 8 a.m. the wind backed to
the north-west and threatened another blow. We had sighted in
the meantime a big indentation which I thought must be King Haakon
Bay, and I decided that we must land there. We set the bows of the
boat towards the bay and ran before the freshening gale. Soon we
had angry reefs on either side. Great glaciers came down to the sea
and offered no landing-place. The sea spouted on the reefs and
thundered against the shore. About noon we sighted a line of jagged
reef, like blackened teeth, that seemed to bar the entrance to the
bay. Inside, comparatively smooth water stretched eight or nine
miles to the head of the bay. A gap in the reef appeared, and we
made for it. But the fates had another rebuff for us. The wind
shifted and blew from the east right out of the bay. We could
see the way through the reef, but we could not approach it directly.
That afternoon we bore up, tacking five times in the strong wind.
The last tack enabled us to get through, and at last we were in
the wide mouth of the bay. Dusk was approaching. A small cove,
with a boulder-strewn beach guarded by a reef, made a break in
the cliffs on the south side of the bay, and we turned in that
direction. I stood in the bows directing the steering as we ran
through the kelp and made the passage of the reef. The entrance
was so narrow that we had to take in the oars, and the swell was
piling itself right over the reef into the cove; but in a minute
or two we were inside, and in the gathering darkness the James
Caird ran in on a swell and touched the beach. I sprang ashore
with the short painter and held on when the boat went out with
the backward surge. When the James Caird came in again three
of the men got ashore, and they held the painter while I climbed
some rocks with another line. A slip on the wet rocks twenty
feet up nearly closed my part of the story just at the moment
when we were achieving safety. A jagged piece of rock held me
and at the same time bruised me sorely. However, I made fast
the line, and in a few minutes we were all safe on the beach,
with the boat floating in the surging water just off the shore.
We heard a gurgling sound that was sweet music in our ears, and,
peering around, found a stream of fresh water almost at our feet.
A moment later we were down on our knees drinking the pure, ice-cold
water in long draughts that put new life into us. It was
a splendid moment.
The next thing was to get the stores and ballast out of the boat,
in order that we might secure her for the night. We carried the
stores and gear above high-water mark and threw out the bags of
sand and the boulders that we knew so well. Then we attempted
to pull the empty boat up the beach, and discovered by this effort
how weak we had become. Our united strength was not sufficient to
get the James Caird clear of the water. Time after time we pulled
together, but without avail. I saw that it would be necessary to
have food and rest before we beached the boat. We made fast a line
to a heavy boulder and set a watch to fend the James Caird off
the rocks of the beach. Then I sent Crean round to the left side
of the cove, about thirty yards away, where I had noticed a little
cave as we were running in. He could not see much in the darkness,
but reported that the place certainly promised some shelter. We
carried the sleeping-bags round and found a mere hollow in the rock-face,
with a shingle floor sloping at a steep angle to the sea.
There we prepared a hot meal, and when the food was finished I
ordered the men to turn in. The time was now about 8 p.m., and
I took the first watch beside the James Caird, which was still
afloat in the tossing water just off the beach.
Fending the James Caird off the rocks in the darkness was awkward
work. The boat would have bumped dangerously if allowed to ride
in with the waves that drove into the cove. I found a flat rock
for my feet, which were in a bad way owing to cold, wetness, and
lack of exercise in the boat, and during the next few hours I
laboured to keep the James Caird clear of the beach. Occasionally
I had to rush into the seething water. Then, as a wave receded,
I let the boat out on the alpine rope so as to avoid a sudden jerk.
The heavy painter had been lost when the sea-anchor went adrift.
The James Caird could be seen but dimly in the cove, where the
high black cliffs made the darkness almost complete, and the
strain upon one’s attention was great. After several hours had
passed I found that my desire for sleep was becoming irresistible,
and at 1 a.m. I called Crean. I could hear him groaning as he
stumbled over the sharp rocks on his way down the beach. While he
was taking charge of the James Caird she got adrift, and we had
some anxious moments. Fortunately, she went across towards the
cave and we secured her, unharmed. The loss or destruction of the
boat at this stage would have been a very serious matter, since we
probably would have found it impossible to leave the cove except by
sea. The cliffs and glaciers around offered no practicable path
towards the head of the bay. I arranged for one-hour watches during
the remainder of the night and then took Crean’s place among the
sleeping men and got some sleep before the dawn came.
The sea went down in the early hours of the morning (May 11), and
after sunrise we were able to set about getting the boat ashore,
first bracing ourselves for the task with another meal. We were
all weak still. We cut off the topsides and took out all the movable
gear. Then we waited for Byron’s “great ninth wave,” and when it
lifted the James Caird in we held her and, by dint of great
exertion, worked her round broadside to the sea. Inch by inch we
dragged her up until we reached the fringe of the tussock-grass
and knew that the boat was above high-water mark. The rise of
the tide was about five feet, and at spring tide the water must
have reached almost to the edge of the tussock-grass. The
completion of this job removed our immediate anxieties, and we
were free to examine our surroundings and plan the next move.
The day was bright and clear.
King Haakon Bay is an eight-mile sound penetrating the coast of
South Georgia in an easterly direction. We had noticed that the
northern and southern sides of the sound were formed by steep
mountain-ranges, their flanks furrowed by mighty glaciers, the
outlets of the great ice-sheet of the interior. It was obvious
that these glaciers and the precipitous slopes of the mountains
barred our way inland from the cove. We must sail to the head of
the sound. Swirling clouds and mist-wreaths had obscured our view
of the sound when we were entering, but glimpses of snow-slopes had
given us hope that an overland journey could be begun from that
point. A few patches of very rough, tussocky land, dotted with
little tarns, lay between the glaciers along the foot of the
mountains, which were heavily scarred with scree-slopes. Several
magnificent peaks and crags gazed out across their snowy domains
to the sparkling waters of the sound.
Our cove lay a little inside the southern headland of King Haakon
Bay. A narrow break in the cliffs, which were about a hundred feet
high at this point, formed the entrance to the cove. The cliffs
continued inside the cove on each side and merged into a hill which
descended at a steep slope to the boulder beach. The slope, which
carried tussock-grass, was not continuous. It eased at two points
into little peaty swamp terraces dotted with frozen pools and drained
by two small streams. Our cave was a recess in the cliff on the
left-hand end of the beach. The rocky face of the cliff was undercut
at this point, and the shingle thrown up by the waves formed a steep
slope, which we reduced to about one in six by scraping the stones
away from the inside. Later we strewed the rough floor with the dead,
nearly dry underleaves of the tussock-grass, so as to form a slightly
soft bed for our sleeping-bags. Water had trickled down the face
of the cliff and formed long icicles, which hung down in front of
the cave to the length of about fifteen feet. These icicles
provided shelter, and when we had spread our sails below them,
with the assistance of oars, we had quarters that, in the
circumstances, had to be regarded as reasonably comfortable.
The camp at least was dry, and we moved our gear there with
confidence. We built a fireplace and arranged our sleeping-bags
and blankets around it. The cave was about 8 ft. deep and 12 ft.
wide at the entrance.
While the camp was being arranged Crean and I climbed the tussock
slope behind the beach and reached the top of a headland overlooking
the sound. There we found the nests of albatrosses, and, much to
our delight, the nests contained young birds. The fledgelings were
fat and lusty, and we had no hesitation about deciding that they were
destined to die at an early age. Our most pressing anxiety at this
stage was a shortage of fuel for the cooker. We had rations for ten
more days, and we knew now that we could get birds for food; but if
we were to have hot meals we must secure fuel. The store of
petroleum carried in the boat was running very low, and it seemed
necessary to keep some quantity for use on the overland journey that
lay ahead of us. A sea-elephant or a seal would have provided fuel
as well as food, but we could see none in the neighbourhood. During
the morning we started a fire in the cave with wood from the top-sides
of the boat, and though the dense smoke from the damp sticks
inflamed our tired eyes, the warmth and the prospect of hot food were
ample compensation. Crean was cook that day, and I suggested to him
that he should wear his goggles, which he happened to have brought
with him. The goggles helped him a great deal as he bent over the fire
and tended the stew. And what a stew it was! The young albatrosses
weighed about fourteen pounds each fresh killed, and we estimated that
they weighed at least six pounds each when cleaned and dressed for
the pot. Four birds went into the pot for six men, with a Bovril
ration for thickening. The flesh was white and succulent, and
the bones, not fully formed, almost melted in our mouths. That
was a memorable meal. When we had eaten our fill, we dried our
tobacco in the embers of the fire and smoked contentedly. We
made an attempt to dry our clothes, which were soaked with salt
water, but did not meet with much success. We could not afford
to have a fire except for cooking purposes until blubber or
driftwood had come our way.
The final stage of the journey had still to be attempted.
I realized that the condition of the party generally, and
particularly of McNeish and Vincent, would prevent us putting
to sea again except under pressure of dire necessity. Our boat,
moreover, had been weakened by the cutting away of the topsides,
and I doubted if we could weather the island. We were still 150
miles away from Stromness whaling-station by sea. The alternative
was to attempt the crossing of the island. If we could not get
over, then we must try to secure enough food and fuel to keep us
alive through the winter, but this possibility was scarcely
thinkable. Over on Elephant Island twenty-two men were waiting
for the relief that we alone could secure for them. Their plight
was worse than ours. We must push on somehow. Several days must
elapse before our strength would be sufficiently recovered to
allow us to row or sail the last nine miles up to the head of the
bay. In the meantime we could make what preparations were possible
and dry our clothes by taking advantage of every scrap of heat from
the fires we lit for the cooking of our meals. We turned in early
that night, and I remember that I dreamed of the great wave and
aroused my companions with a shout of warning as I saw with half-awakened
eyes the towering cliff on the opposite side of the cove.
Shortly before midnight a gale sprang up suddenly from the north-east
with rain and sleet showers. It brought quantities of glacier-ice
into the cove, and by 2 a.m. (May 12) our little harbour was
filled with ice, which surged to and fro in the swell and pushed
its way on to the beach. We had solid rock beneath our feet and
could watch without anxiety. When daylight came rain was falling
heavily, and the temperature was the highest we had experienced
for many months. The icicles overhanging our cave were melting
down in streams and we had to move smartly when passing in and out
lest we should be struck by falling lumps. A fragment weighing
fifteen or twenty pounds crashed down while we were having
breakfast. We found that a big hole had been burned in the bottom
of Worsley’s reindeer sleeping-bag during the night. Worsley had
been awakened by a burning sensation in his feet, and had asked
the men near him if his bag was all right; they looked and could
see nothing wrong. We were all superficially frostbitten about
the feet, and this condition caused the extremities to burn
painfully, while at the same time sensation was lost in the skin.
Worsley thought that the uncomfortable heat of his feet was due to
the frost-bites, and he stayed in his bag and presently went to
sleep again. He discovered when he turned out in the morning that
the tussock-grass which we had laid on the floor of the cave had
smouldered outwards from the fire and had actually burned a large
hole in the bag beneath his feet. Fortunately, his feet were not
harmed.
Our party spent a quiet day, attending to clothing and gear,
checking stores, eating and resting. Some more of the young
albatrosses made a noble end in our pot. The birds were nesting
on a small plateau above the right-hand end of our beach. We had
previously discovered that when we were landing from the boat on
the night of May 10 we had lost the rudder. The James Caird had
been bumping heavily astern as we were scrambling ashore, and
evidently the rudder was then knocked off. A careful search of
the beach and the rocks within our reach failed to reveal the
missing article. This was a serious loss, even if the voyage to
the head of the sound could be made in good weather. At dusk the
ice in the cove was rearing and crashing on the beach. It had
forced up a ridge of stones close to where the James Caird lay
at the edge of the tussock-grass. Some pieces of ice were driven
right up to the canvas wall at the front of our cave. Fragments
lodged within two feet of Vincent, who had the lowest sleeping-place,
and within four feet of our fire. Crean and McCarthy had brought
down six more of the young albatrosses in the afternoon, so we were
well supplied with fresh food. The air temperature that night
probably was not lower than 38° or 40° Fahr., and we were
rendered uncomfortable in our cramped sleeping quarters by the
unaccustomed warmth. Our feelings towards our neighbours underwent
a change. When the temperature was below 20° Fahr, we could not
get too close to one another—every man wanted to cuddle against
his neighbour; but let the temperature rise a few degrees and the
warmth of another man’s body ceased to be a blessing. The ice
and the waves had a voice of menace that night, but I heard it
only in my dreams.
The bay was still filled with ice on the morning of Saturday,
May 13, but the tide took it all away in the afternoon. Then a
strange thing happened. The rudder, with all the broad Atlantic
to sail in and the coasts of two continents to search for a
resting-place, came bobbing back into our cove. With anxious eyes
we watched it as it advanced, receded again, and then advanced
once more under the capricious influence of wind and wave. Nearer
and nearer it came as we waited on the shore, oars in hand, and at
last we were able to seize it. Surely a remarkable salvage!
The day was bright and clear; our clothes were drying and our
strength was returning. Running water made a musical sound down
the tussock slope and among the boulders. We carried our blankets
up the hill and tried to dry them in the breeze 300 ft. above sea-level.
In the afternoon we began to prepare the James Caird for
the journey to the head of King Haakon Bay. A noon observation on
this day gave our latitude as 54° 10´ 47´´ S., but according
to the German chart the position should have been 54° 12´ S.
Probably Worsley’s observation was the more accurate. We were able
to keep the fire alight until we went to sleep that night, for while
climbing the rocks above the cove I had seen at the foot of a cliff
a broken spar, which had been thrown up by the waves. We could reach
this spar by climbing down the cliff, and with a reserve supply of
fuel thus in sight we could afford to burn the fragments of the
James Caird’s topsides more freely.
During the morning of this day (May 13) Worsley and I tramped
across the hills in a north-easterly direction with the object
of getting a view of the sound and possibly gathering some
information that would be useful to us in the next stage of our
journey. It was exhausting work, but after covering about 2½
miles in two hours, we were able to look east, up the bay. We
could not see very much of the country that we would have to
cross in order to reach the whaling-station on the other side of
the island. We had passed several brooks and frozen tarns, and
at a point where we had to take to the beach on the shore of the
sound we found some wreckage—an 18-ft. pine-spar (probably part
of a ship’s topmast), several pieces of timber, and a little model
of a ship’s hull, evidently a child’s toy. We wondered what
tragedy that pitiful little plaything indicated. We encountered
also some gentoo penguins and a young sea-elephant, which Worsley
killed.
When we got back to the cave at 3 p.m., tired, hungry, but rather
pleased with ourselves, we found a splendid meal of stewed albatross
chicken waiting for us. We had carried a quantity of blubber and
the sea-elephant’s liver in our blouses, and we produced our
treasures as a surprise for the men. Rough climbing on the way back
to camp had nearly persuaded us to throw the stuff away, but we had
held on (regardless of the condition of our already sorely tried
clothing), and had our reward at the camp. The long bay had been
a magnificent sight, even to eyes that had dwelt on grandeur long
enough and were hungry for the simple, familiar things of everyday
life. Its green-blue waters were being beaten to fury by the north-westerly
gale. The mountains, “stern peaks that dared the stars,”
peered through the mists, and between them huge glaciers poured down
from the great ice-slopes and fields that lay behind. We counted
twelve glaciers and heard every few minutes the reverberating roar
caused by masses of ice calving from the parent streams.
On May 14 we made our preparations for an early start on the
following day if the weather held fair. We expected to be able
to pick up the remains of the sea-elephant on our way up the sound.
All hands were recovering from the chafing caused by our wet clothes
during the boat journey. The insides of our legs had suffered severely,
and for some time after landing in the cove we found movement extremely
uncomfortable. We paid our last visit to the nests of the albatrosses,
which were situated on a little undulating plateau above the cave
amid tussocks, snow-patches, and little frozen tarns. Each nest
consisted of a mound over a foot high of tussock-grass, roots,
and a little earth. The albatross lays one egg and very rarely two.
The chicks, which are hatched in January, are fed on the nest by
the parent birds for almost seven months before they take to the sea
and fend for themselves. Up to four months of age the chicks are
beautiful white masses of downy fluff, but when we arrived on the
scene their plumage was almost complete. Very often one of the parent
birds was on guard near the nest. We did not enjoy attacking these
birds, but our hunger knew no law. They tasted so very good and
assisted our recuperation to such an extent that each time we
killed one of them we felt a little less remorseful.
May 15 was a great day. We made our hoosh at 7.30 a.m. Then we
loaded up the boat and gave her a flying launch down the steep
beach into the surf. Heavy rain had fallen in the night and a
gusty north-westerly wind was now blowing, with misty showers.
The James Caird headed to the sea as if anxious to face the battle
of the waves once more. We passed through the narrow mouth of the
cove with the ugly rocks and waving kelp close on either side,
turned to the east, and sailed merrily up the bay as the sun broke
through the mists and made the tossing waters sparkle around us.
We were a curious-looking party on that bright morning, but we were
feeling happy. We even broke into song, and, but for our Robinson
Crusoe appearance, a casual observer might have taken us for a
picnic party sailing in a Norwegian fiord or one of the beautiful
sounds of the west coast of New Zealand. The wind blew fresh and
strong, and a small sea broke on the coast as we advanced. The
surf was sufficient to have endangered the boat if we had attempted
to land where the carcass of the sea-elephant was lying, so we
decided to go on to the head of the bay without risking anything,
particularly as we were likely to find sea-elephants on the upper
beaches. The big creatures have a habit of seeking peaceful
quarters protected from the waves. We had hopes, too, of finding
penguins. Our expectation as far as the sea-elephants were
concerned was not at fault. We heard the roar of the bulls as we
neared the head of the bay, and soon afterwards saw the great
unwieldy forms of the beasts lying on a shelving beach towards the
bay-head. We rounded a high, glacier-worn bluff on the north side,
and at 12.30 p.m. we ran the boat ashore on a low beach of sand and
pebbles, with tussock growing above high-water mark. There were
hundreds of sea-elephants lying about, and our anxieties with
regard to food disappeared. Meat and blubber enough to feed
our party for years was in sight. Our landing-place was about
a mile and a half west of the north-east corner of the bay. Just
east of us was a glacier-snout ending on the beach but giving a
passage towards the head of the bay, except at high water or when
a very heavy surf was running. A cold, drizzling rain had begun
to fall, and we provided ourselves with shelter as quickly as
possible. We hauled the James Caird up above highwater
mark and turned her over just to the lee or east side of
the bluff. The spot was separated from the mountain-side by
a low morainic bank, rising twenty or thirty feet above sea-level.
Soon we had converted the boat into a very comfortable cabin à la
Peggotty, turfing it round with tussocks, which we dug up with knives.
One side of the James Caird rested on stones so as to afford a
low entrance, and when we had finished she looked as though she had
grown there. McCarthy entered into this work with great spirit.
A sea-elephant provided us with fuel and meat, and that evening found
a well-fed and fairly contented party at rest in Peggotty Camp.
Our camp, as I have said, lay on the north side of King Haakon Bay
near the head. Our path towards the whaling-stations led round the
seaward end of the snouted glacier on the east side of the camp
and up a snow-slope that appeared to lead to a pass in the great
Allardyce Range, which runs north-west and south-east and forms the
main backbone of South Georgia. The range dipped opposite the bay
into a well-defined pass from east to west. An ice-sheet covered
most of the interior, filling the valleys and disguising the
configurations of the land, which, indeed, showed only in big
rocky ridges, peaks, and nunataks. When we looked up the pass
from Peggotty Camp the country to the left appeared to offer two
easy paths through to the opposite coast, but we knew that the
island was uninhabited at that point (Possession Bay). We had to
turn our attention farther east, and it was impossible from the
camp to learn much of the conditions that would confront us on the
overland journey. I planned to climb to the pass and then be
guided by the configuration of the country in the selection of a
route eastward to Stromness Bay, where the whaling-stations were
established in the minor bays, Leith, Husvik, and Stromness. A
range of mountains with precipitous slopes, forbidding peaks,
and large glaciers lay immediately to the south of King Haakon Bay
and seemed to form a continuation of the main range. Between this
secondary range and the pass above our camp a great snow-upland
sloped up to the inland ice-sheet and reached a rocky ridge that
stretched athwart our path and seemed to bar the way. This ridge
was a right-angled offshoot from the main ridge. Its chief features
were four rocky peaks with spaces between that looked from a distance
as though they might prove to be passes.
The weather was bad on Tuesday, May 16, and we stayed under the
boat nearly all day. The quarters were cramped but gave full
protection from the weather, and we regarded our little cabin with
a great deal of satisfaction. Abundant meals of sea-elephant steak
and liver increased our contentment. McNeish reported during the day
that he had seen rats feeding on the scraps, but this interesting
statement was not verified. One would not expect to find rats at
such a spot, but there was a bare possibility that they had landed
from a wreck and managed to survive the very rigorous conditions.
A fresh west-south-westerly breeze was blowing on the following
morning (Wednesday, May 17), with misty squalls, sleet, and rain.
I took Worsley with me on a pioneer journey to the west with the
object of examining the country to be traversed at the beginning
of the overland journey. We went round the seaward end of the
snouted glacier, and after tramping about a mile over stony ground
and snow-coated debris, we crossed some big ridges of scree and
moraines. We found that there was good going for a sledge as far
as the north-east corner of the bay, but did not get much
information regarding the conditions farther on owing to the view
becoming obscured by a snow-squall. We waited a quarter of an hour
for the weather to clear but were forced to turn back without having
seen more of the country. I had satisfied myself, however, that we
could reach a good snow-slope leading apparently to the inland ice.
Worsley reckoned from the chart that the distance from our camp to
Husvik, on an east magnetic course, was seventeen geographical miles,
but we could not expect to follow a direct line. The carpenter
started making a sledge for use on the overland journey. The
materials at his disposal were limited in quantity and scarcely
suitable in quality.
We overhauled our gear on Thursday, May 18; and hauled our sledge
to the lower edge of the snouted glacier. The vehicle proved heavy
and cumbrous. We had to lift it empty over bare patches of rock
along the shore, and I realized that it would be too heavy for three
men to manage amid the snow-plains, glaciers, and peaks of the
interior. Worsley and Crean were coming with me, and after
consultation we decided to leave the sleeping-bags behind us and
make the journey in very light marching order. We would take three
days’ provisions for each man in the form of sledging ration and
biscuit. The food was to be packed in three sacks, so that each
member of the party could carry his own supply. Then we were to
take the Primus lamp filled with oil, the small cooker, the
carpenter’s adze (for use as an ice-axe), and the alpine rope,
which made a total length of fifty feet when knotted. We might
have to lower ourselves down steep slopes or cross crevassed
glaciers. The filled lamp would provide six hot meals, which would
consist of sledging ration boiled up with biscuit. There were two
boxes of matches left, one full and the other partially used. We
left the full box with the men at the camp and took the second box,
which contained forty-eight matches. I was unfortunate as regarded
footgear, since I had given away my heavy Burberry boots on the floe,
and had now a comparatively light pair in poor condition. The
carpenter assisted me by putting several screws in the sole of each
boot with the object of providing a grip on the ice. The screws
came out of the James Caird.
We turned in early that night, but sleep did not come to me. My
mind was busy with the task of the following day. The weather
was clear and the outlook for an early start in the morning was good.
We were going to leave a weak party behind us in the camp. Vincent
was still in the same condition, and he could not march. McNeish was
pretty well broken up. The two men were not capable of managing for
themselves and McCarthy must stay to look after them. He might
have a difficult task if we failed to reach the whaling station.
The distance to Husvik, according to the chart, was no more than
seventeen geographical miles in a direct line, but we had very
scanty knowledge of the conditions of the interior. No man had
ever penetrated a mile from the coast of South Georgia at any point,
and the whalers I knew regarded the country as inaccessible. During
that day, while we were walking to the snouted glacier, we had seen
three wild duck flying towards the head of the bay from the eastward.
I hoped that the presence of these birds indicated tussock-land and
not snow-fields and glaciers in the interior, but the hope was not
a very bright one.
We turned out at 2 a.m. on the Friday morning and had our hoosh
ready an hour later. The full moon was shining in a practically
cloudless sky, its rays reflected gloriously from the pinnacles
and crevassed ice of the adjacent glaciers. The huge peaks of
the mountains stood in bold relief against the sky and threw dark
shadows on the waters of the sound. There was no need for delay,
and we made a start as soon as we had eaten our meal. McNeish
walked about 200 yds with us; he could do no more. Then we said
good-bye and he turned back to the camp. The first task was to
get round the edge of the snouted glacier, which had points like
fingers projecting towards the sea. The waves were reaching the
points of these fingers, and we had to rush from one recess to
another when the waters receded. We soon reached the east side
of the glacier and noticed its great activity at this point.
Changes had occurred within the preceding twenty-four hours.
Some huge pieces had broken off, and the masses of mud and stone
that were being driven before the advancing ice showed movement.
The glacier was like a gigantic plough driving irresistibly
towards the sea.
Lying on the beach beyond the glacier was wreckage that told of
many ill-fated ships. We noticed stanchions of teakwood,
liberally carved, that must have came from ships of the older
type; iron-bound timbers with the iron almost rusted through;
battered barrels and all the usual debris of the ocean. We had
difficulties and anxieties of our own, but as we passed that
graveyard of the sea we thought of the many tragedies written in
the wave-worn fragments of lost vessels. We did not pause, and
soon we were ascending a snow-slope heading due east on the last
lap of our long trail.
The snow-surface was disappointing. Two days before we had been
able to move rapidly on hard, packed snow; now we sank over our
ankles at each step and progress was slow. After two hours’
steady climbing we were 2500 ft. above sea-level. The weather
continued fine and calm, and as the ridges drew nearer and the
western coast of the island spread out below, the bright moonlight
showed us that the interior was broken tremendously. High peaks,
impassable cliffs, steep snow-slopes, and sharply descending
glaciers were prominent features in all directions, with stretches
of snow-plain over laying the ice-sheet of the interior. The slope
we were ascending mounted to a ridge and our course lay direct to
the top. The moon, which proved a good friend during this journey,
threw a long shadow at one point and told us that the surface was
broken in our path. Warned in time, we avoided a huge hole capable
of swallowing an army. The bay was now about three miles away,
and the continued roaring of a big glacier at the head of the bay
came to our ears. This glacier, which we had noticed during the stay
at Peggotty Camp, seemed to be calving almost continuously.
I had hoped to get a view of the country ahead of us from the top
of the slope, but as the surface became more level beneath our
feet, a thick fog drifted down. The moon became obscured and
produced a diffused light that was more trying than darkness,
since it illuminated the fog without guiding our steps. We roped
ourselves together as a precaution against holes, crevasses, and
precipices, and I broke trail through the soft snow. With almost
the full length of the rope between myself and the last man we were
able to steer an approximately straight course, since, if I veered
to the right or the left when marching into the blank wall of the
fog, the last man on the rope could shout a direction. So, like a
ship with its “port,” “starboard,” “steady,” we tramped through
the fog for the next two hours.
Then, as daylight came, the fog thinned and lifted, and from an
elevation of about 3000 ft. we looked down on what seemed to be
a huge frozen lake with its farther shores still obscured by the
fog. We halted there to eat a bit of biscuit while we discussed
whether we would go down and cross the flat surface of the lake,
or keep on the ridge we had already reached. I decided to go down,
since the lake lay on our course. After an hour of comparatively
easy travel through the snow we noticed the thin beginnings of
crevasses. Soon they were increasing in size and showing fractures,
indicating that we were travelling on a glacier. As the daylight
brightened the fog dissipated; the lake could be seen more clearly,
but still we could not discover its east shore. A little later
the fog lifted completely, and then we saw that our lake stretched
to the horizon, and realized suddenly that we were looking down
upon the open sea on the east coast of the island. The slight
pulsation at the shore showed that the sea was not even frozen;
it was the bad light that had deceived us. Evidently we were at
the top of Possession Bay, and the island at that point could not
be more than five miles across from the head of King Haakon Bay.
Our rough chart was inaccurate. There was nothing for it but to
start up the glacier again. That was about seven o’clock in
the morning, and by nine o’clock we had more than recovered our
lost ground. We regained the ridge and then struck south-east,
for the chart showed that two more bays indented the coast
before Stromness. It was comforting to realize that we would
have the eastern water in sight during our journey, although we
could see there was no way around the shore line owing to steep
cliffs and glaciers. Men lived in houses lit by electric light
on the east coast. News of the outside world waited us there, and,
above all, the east coast meant for us the means of rescuing the
twenty-two men we had left on Elephant Island.
ACROSS SOUTH GEORGIA
The sun rose in the sky with every appearance of a fine day, and we
grew warmer as we toiled through the soft snow. Ahead of us lay the
ridges and spurs of a range of mountains, the transverse range that
we had noticed from the bay. We were travelling over a gently rising
plateau, and at the end of an hour we found ourselves growing
uncomfortably hot. Years before, on an earlier expedition, I had
declared that I would never again growl at the heat of the sun, and
my resolution had been strengthened during the boat journey. I
called it to mind as the sun beat fiercely on the blinding white
snow-slope. After passing an area of crevasses we paused for our
first meal. We dug a hole in the snow about three feet deep with
the adze and put the Primus into it. There was no wind at the moment,
but a gust might come suddenly. A hot hoosh was soon eaten and we
plodded on towards a sharp ridge between two of the peaks already
mentioned. By 11 a.m. we were almost at the crest. The slope
had become precipitous and it was necessary to cut steps as we
advanced. The adze proved an excellent instrument for this
purpose, a blow sufficing to provide a foothold. Anxiously but
hopefully I cut the last few steps and stood upon the razor-back,
while the other men held the rope and waited for my news. The
outlook was disappointing. I looked down a sheer precipice to a
chaos of crumpled ice 1500 ft. below. There was no way down for
us. The country to the east was a great snow upland, sloping
upwards for a distance of seven or eight miles to a height of over
4000 ft. To the north it fell away steeply in glaciers into the
bays, and to the south it was broken by huge outfalls from the
inland ice-sheet. Our path lay between the glaciers and the
outfalls, but first we had to descend from the ridge on which
we stood. Cutting steps with the adze, we moved in a lateral
direction round the base of a dolomite, which blocked our view
to the north. The same precipice confronted us. Away to the
north-east there appeared to be a snow-slope that might give a
path to the lower country, and so we retraced our steps down
the long slope that had taken us three hours to climb. We were
at the bottom in an hour. We were now feeling the strain of
the unaccustomed marching. We had done little walking since
January and our muscles were out of tune. Skirting the base
of the mountain above us, we came to a gigantic bergschrund,
a mile and a half long and 1000 ft. deep. This tremendous gully,
cut in the snow and ice by the fierce winds blowing round the
mountain, was semicircular in form, and it ended in a gentle
incline. We passed through it, under the towering precipice of
ice, and at the far end we had another meal and a short rest.
This was at 12:30 p.m. Half a pot of steaming Bovril ration
warmed us up, and when we marched again ice-inclines at angles
of 45 degrees did not look quite as formidable as before.
Once more we started for the crest. After another weary climb
we reached the top. The snow lay thinly on blue ice at the
ridge, and we had to cut steps over the last fifty yards. The
same precipice lay below, and my eyes searched vainly for a way
down. The hot sun had loosened the snow, which was now in a
treacherous condition, and we had to pick our way carefully.
Looking back, we could see that a fog was rolling up behind us
and meeting in the valleys a fog that was coming up from the east.
The creeping grey clouds were a plain warning that we must get
down to lower levels before becoming enveloped.
The ridge was studded with peaks, which prevented us getting a
clear view either to the right or to the left. The situation in
this respect seemed no better at other points within our reach,
and I had to decide that our course lay back the way we had come.
The afternoon was wearing on and the fog was rolling up ominously
from the west. It was of the utmost importance for us to get down
into the next valley before dark. We were now up 4500 ft. and
the night temperature at that elevation would be very low. We had
no tent and no sleeping-bags, and our clothes had endured much rough
usage and had weathered many storms during the last ten months.
In the distance, down the valley below us, we could see tussock-grass
close to the shore, and if we could get down it might be possible
to dig out a hole in one of the lower snow-banks, line it with dry
grass, and make ourselves fairly comfortable for the night. Back
we went, and after a detour we reached the top of another ridge in
the fading light. After a glance over the top I turned to the
anxious faces of the two men behind me and said, “Come on, boys.”
Within a minute they stood beside me on the ice-ridge. The
surface fell away at a sharp incline in front of us, but it merged
into a snow-slope. We could not see the bottom clearly owing to
mist and bad light, and the possibility of the slope ending in a
sheer fall occurred to us; but the fog that was creeping up behind
allowed no time for hesitation. We descended slowly at first,
cutting steps in the snow; then the surface became softer,
indicating that the gradient was less severe. There could be no
turning back now, so we unroped and slid in the fashion of youthful
days. When we stopped on a snow-bank at the foot of the slope we
found that we had descended at least 900 ft. in two or three
minutes. We looked back and saw the grey fingers of the fog
appearing on the ridge, as though reaching after the intruders into
untrodden wilds. But we had escaped.
The country to the east was an ascending snow upland dividing
the glaciers of the north coast from the outfalls of the south.
We had seen from the top that our course lay between two huge
masses of crevasses, and we thought that the road ahead lay clear.
This belief and the increasing cold made us abandon the idea of
camping. We had another meal at 6 p.m. A little breeze made
cooking difficult in spite of the shelter provided for the cooker
by a hole. Crean was the cook, and Worsley and I lay on the snow
to windward of the lamp so as to break the wind with our bodies.
The meal over, we started up the long, gentle ascent. Night was
upon us, and for an hour we plodded along in almost complete darkness,
watching warily for signs of crevasses. Then about 8 p.m. a glow
which we had seen behind the jagged peaks resolved itself into the
full moon, which rose ahead of us and made a silver pathway for
our feet. Along that pathway in the wake of the moon we advanced
in safety, with the shadows cast by the edges of crevasses showing
black on either side of us. Onwards and upwards through soft snow
we marched, resting now and then on hard patches which had revealed
themselves by glittering ahead of us in the white light. By midnight
we were again at an elevation of about 4000 ft. Still we were
following the light, for as the moon swung round towards the north-east,
our path curved in that direction. The friendly moon seemed
to pilot our weary feet. We could have had no better guide. If
in bright daylight we had made that march we would have followed
the course that was traced for us that night.
Midnight found us approaching the edge of a great snowfield,
pierced by isolated nunataks which cast long shadows like black
rivers across the white expanse. A gentle slope to the north-east
lured our all-too-willing feet in that direction. We thought that
at the base of the slope lay Stromness Bay. After we had descended
about 300 ft. a thin wind began to attack us. We had now been on
the march for over twenty hours, only halting for our occasional
meals. Wisps of cloud drove over the high peaks to the southward,
warning us that wind and snow were likely to come. After 1 a.m.
we cut a pit in the snow, piled up loose snow around it, and
started the Primus again. The hot food gave us another renewal
of energy. Worsley and Crean sang their old songs when the Primus
was going merrily. Laughter was in our hearts, though not on our
parched and cracked lips.
We were up and away again within half an hour, still downward to
the coast. We felt almost sure now that we were above Stromness
Bay. A dark object down at the foot of the slope looked like
Mutton Island, which lies off Husvik. I suppose our desires were
giving wings to our fancies, for we pointed out joyfully various
landmarks revealed by the now vagrant light of the moon, whose
friendly face was cloud-swept. Our high hopes were soon shattered.
Crevasses warned us that we were on another glacier, and soon we
looked down almost to the seaward edge of the great riven ice-mass.
I knew there was no glacier in Stromness and realized that this
must be Fortuna Glacier. The disappointment was severe. Back
we turned and tramped up the glacier again, not directly tracing
our steps but working at a tangent to the south-east.
We were very tired.
At 5 a.m. we were at the foot of the rocky spurs of the range.
We were tired, and the wind that blew down from the heights was
chilling us. We decided to get down under the lee of a rock for a
rest. We put our sticks and the adze on the snow, sat down on them
as close to one another as possible, and put our arms round each
other. The wind was bringing a little drift with it and the white
dust lay on our clothes. I thought that we might be able to keep
warm and have half an hour’s rest this way. Within a minute my
two companions were fast asleep. I realized that it would be
disastrous if we all slumbered together, for sleep under such
conditions merges into death. After five minutes I shook them
into consciousness again, told them that they had slept for half
an hour, and gave the word for a fresh start. We were so stiff
that for the first two or three hundred yards we marched with our
knees bent. A jagged line of peaks with a gap like a broken tooth
confronted us. This was the ridge that runs in a southerly
direction from Fortuna Bay, and our course eastward to Stromness
lay across it. A very steep slope led up to the ridge and an icy
wind burst through the gap.
We went through the gap at 6 a.m. with anxious hearts as well
as weary bodies. If the farther slope had proved impassable
our situation would have been almost desperate; but the worst
was turning to the best for us. The twisted, wave-like rock formations
of Husvik Harbour appeared right ahead in the opening
of dawn. Without a word we shook hands with one another.
To our minds the journey was over, though as a matter of fact
twelve miles of difficult country had still to be traversed.
A gentle snow-slope descended at our feet towards a valley that
separated our ridge from the hills immediately behind Husvik,
and as we stood gazing Worsley said solemnly, “Boss, it looks
too good to be true!” Down we went, to be checked presently
by the sight of water 2500 ft. below. We could see the little
wave-ripples on the black beach, penguins strutting to and fro,
and dark objects that looked like seals lolling lazily on the sand.
This was an eastern arm of Fortuna Bay, separated by the ridge
from the arm we had seen below us during the night. The slope
we were traversing appeared to end in a precipice above this beach.
But our revived spirits were not to be damped by difficulties on
the last stage of the journey, and we camped cheerfully for breakfast.
Whilst Worsley and Crean were digging a hole for the lamp and starting
the cooker I climbed a ridge above us, cutting steps with the adze,
in order to secure an extended view of the country below. At 6.30
a.m. I thought I heard the sound of a steam-whistle. I dared not
be certain, but I knew that the men at the whaling-station would be
called from their beds about that time. Descending to the camp
I told the others, and in intense excitement we watched the
chronometer for seven o’clock, when the whalers would be summoned
to work. Right to the minute the steam-whistle came to us, borne
clearly on the wind across the intervening miles of rock and snow.
Never had any one of us heard sweeter music. It was the first
sound created by outside human agency that had come to our ears
since we left Stromness Bay in December 1914. That whistle told
us that men were living near, that ships were ready, and that
within a few hours we should be on our way back to Elephant Island
to the rescue of the men waiting there under the watch and ward
of Wild. It was a moment hard to describe. Pain and ache, boat
journeys, marches, hunger and fatigue seemed to belong to the
limbo of forgotten things, and there remained only the perfect
contentment that comes of work accomplished.
My examination of the country from a higher point had not
provided definite information, and after descending I put the
situation before Worsley and Crean. Our obvious course lay
down a snow-slope in the direction of Husvik. “Boys,” I said,
“this snow-slope seems to end in a precipice, but perhaps
there is no precipice. If we don’t go down we shall have to
make a detour of at least five miles before we reach level going
What shall it be?” They both replied at once, “Try the
slope.” So we started away again downwards. We abandoned the
Primus lamp, now empty, at the breakfast camp and carried with us
one ration and a biscuit each. The deepest snow we had yet
encountered clogged our feet, but we plodded downward, and after
descending about 500 ft., reducing our altitude to 2000 ft. above
sea-level, we thought we saw the way clear ahead. A steep
gradient of blue ice was the next obstacle. Worsley and Crean got
a firm footing in a hole excavated with the adze and then lowered
me as I cut steps until the full 50 ft. of our alpine rope was
out. Then I made a hole big enough for the three of us, and the
other two men came down the steps. My end of the rope was
anchored to the adze and I had settled myself in the hole braced
for a strain in case they slipped. When we all stood in the
second hole I went down again to make more steps, and in this
laborious fashion we spent two hours descending about 500 ft.
Halfway down we had to strike away diagonally to the left, for
we noticed that the fragments of ice loosened by the adze were
taking a leap into space at the bottom of the slope. Eventually
we got off the steep ice, very gratefully, at a point where some
rocks protruded, and we could see then that there was a perilous
precipice directly below the point where we had started to cut
steps. A slide down a slippery slope, with the adze and our
cooker going ahead, completed this descent, and incidentally did
considerable damage to our much-tried trousers.
When we picked ourselves up at the bottom we were not more than
1500 ft. above the sea. The slope was comparatively easy. Water
was running beneath the snow, making “pockets” between the rocks
that protruded above the white surface. The shells of snow over
these pockets were traps for our feet; but we scrambled down, and
presently came to patches of tussock. A few minutes later we
reached the sandy beach. The tracks of some animals were to be
seen, and we were puzzled until I remembered that reindeer, brought
from Norway, had been placed on the island and now ranged along
the lower land of the eastern coast. We did not pause to
investigate. Our minds were set upon reaching the haunts of
man, and at our best speed we went along the beach to another
rising ridge of tussock. Here we saw the first evidence of the
proximity of man, whose work, as is so often the ease, was one
of destruction. A recently killed seal was lying there, and
presently we saw several other bodies bearing the marks of
bullet-wounds. I learned later that men from the whaling-station
at Stromness sometimes go round to Fortuna Bay by boat to shoot
seals.
Noon found us well up the slope on the other side of the bay
working east-south-east, and half an hour later we were on a flat
plateau, with one more ridge to cross before we descended into
Husvik. I was leading the way over this plateau when I suddenly
found myself up to my knees in water and quickly sinking deeper
through the snow-crust. I flung myself down and called to the
others to do the same, so as to distribute our weight on the
treacherous surface. We were on top of a small lake, snow-covered.
After lying still for a few moments we got to our feet and walked
delicately, like Agag, for 200 yds., until a rise in the surface
showed us that we were clear of the lake.
At 1.30 p.m. we climbed round a final ridge and saw a little
steamer, a whaling-boat, entering the bay 2500 ft, below. A few
moments later, as we hurried forward, the masts of a sailing-ship
lying at a wharf came in sight. Minute figures moving to and fro
about the boats caught our gaze, and then we saw the sheds and
factory of Stromness whaling-station. We paused and shook hands,
a form of mutual congratulation that had seemed necessary on four
other occasions in the course of the expedition. The first time
was when we landed on Elephant Island, the second when we reached
South Georgia, and the third when we reached the ridge and saw the
snow-slope stretching below on the first day of the overland
journey, then when we saw Husvik rocks.
Cautiously we started down the slope that led to warmth and
comfort. The last lap of the journey proved extraordinarily
difficult. Vainly we searched for a safe, or a reasonably safe,
way down the steep ice-clad mountain-side. The sole possible
pathway seemed to be a channel cut by water running from the
upland. Down through icy water we followed the course of this
stream. We were wet to the waist, shivering, cold, and tired.
Presently our ears detected an unwelcome sound that might have
been musical under other conditions. It was the splashing of
a waterfall, and we were at the wrong end. When we reached the
top of this fall we peered over cautiously and discovered that
there was a drop of 25 or 30 ft., with impassable ice-cliffs on
both sides. To go up again was scarcely thinkable in our utterly
wearied condition. The way down was through the waterfall itself.
We made fast one end of our rope to a boulder with some difficulty,
due to the fact that the rocks had been worn smooth by the running
water. Then Worsley and I lowered Crean, who was the heaviest man.
He disappeared altogether in the falling water and came out gasping
at the bottom. I went next, sliding down the rope, and Worsley,
who was the lightest and most nimble member of the party, came last.
At the bottom of the fall we were able to stand again on dry land.
The rope could not be recovered. We had flung down the adze from the
top of the fall and also the logbook and the cooker wrapped in one
of our blouses. That was all, except our wet clothes, that we
brought out of the Antarctic, which we had entered a year and a
half before with well-found ship, full equipment, and high hopes.
That was all of tangible things; but in memories we were rich.
We had pierced the veneer of outside things. We had “suffered,
starved, and triumphed, grovelled down yet grasped at glory, grown
bigger in the bigness of the whole.” We had seen God in His
splendours, heard the text that Nature renders. We had reached
the naked soul of man.
Shivering with cold, yet with hearts light and happy, we set off
towards the whaling-station, now not more than a mile and a half
distant. The difficulties of the journey lay behind us. We
tried to straighten ourselves up a bit, for the thought that there
might be women at the station made us painfully conscious of our
uncivilized appearance. Our beards were long and our hair was
matted. We were unwashed and the garments that we had worn for
nearly a year without a change were tattered and stained. Three
more unpleasant-looking ruffians could hardly have been imagined.
Worsley produced several safety-pins from some corner of his
garments and effected some temporary repairs that really emphasized
his general disrepair. Down we hurried, and when quite close to
the station we met two small boys ten or twelve years of age.
I asked these lads where the manager’s house was situated. They
did not answer. They gave us one look—a comprehensive look
that did not need to be repeated. Then they ran from us as fast
as their legs would carry them. We reached the outskirts of the
station and passed through the “digesting-house,” which was dark
inside. Emerging at the other end, we met an old man, who started
as if he had seen the Devil himself and gave us no time to ask any
question. He hurried away. This greeting was not friendly. Then
we came to the wharf, where the man in charge stuck to his station.
I asked him if Mr. Sorlle (the manager) was in the house.
“Yes,” he said as he stared at us.
“We would like to see him,” said I.
“Who are you?” he asked.
“We have lost our ship and come over the island,” I replied.
“You have come over the island?” he said in a tone of entire
disbelief.
The man went towards the manager’s house and we followed him. I
learned afterwards that he said to Mr. Sorlle: “There are three
funny-looking men outside, who say they have come over the
island and they know you. I have left them outside.” A very
necessary precaution from his point of view.
Mr. Sorlle came out to the door and said, “Well?”
“Don’t you know me?” I said.
“I know your voice,” he replied doubtfully. “You’re the mate of
the Daisy.”
“My name is Shackleton,” I said.
Immediately he put out his hand and said, “Come in. Come in.”
“Tell me, when was the war over?” I asked.
“The war is not over,” he answered. “Millions are being killed.
Europe is mad. The world is mad.”
Mr. Sorlle’s hospitality had no bounds. He would scarcely let us
wait to remove our freezing boots before he took us into his house
and gave us seats in a warm and comfortable room. We were in no
condition to sit in anybody’s house until we had washed and got
into clean clothes, but the kindness of the station-manager was
proof even against the unpleasantness of being in a room with us.
He gave us coffee and cakes in the Norwegian fashion, and then
showed us upstairs to the bathroom, where we shed our rags and
scrubbed ourselves luxuriously.
Mr. Sorlle’s kindness did not end with his personal care for the
three wayfarers who had come to his door. While we were washing
he gave orders for one of the whaling-vessels to be prepared at
once in order that it might leave that night for the other side
of the island and pick up the three men there. The whalers knew
King Haakon Bay, though they never worked on that side of the island.
Soon we were clean again. Then we put on delightful new clothes
supplied from the station stores and got rid of our superfluous hair.
Within an hour or two we had ceased to be savages and had become
civilized men again. Then came a splendid meal, while Mr. Sorlle
told us of the arrangements he had made and we discussed plans for
the rescue of the main party on Elephant Island.
I arranged that Worsley should go with the relief ship to show the
exact spot where the carpenter and his two companions were camped,
while I started to prepare for the relief of the party on Elephant
Island. The whaling-vessel that was going round to King Haakon Bay
was expected back on the Monday morning, and was to call at
Grytviken Harbour, the port from which we had sailed in December
1914, in order that the magistrate resident there might be informed
of the fate of the Endurance. It was possible that letters were
awaiting us there. Worsley went aboard the whaler at ten o’clock
that night and turned in. The next day the relief ship entered
King Haakon Bay and he reached Peggotty Camp in a boat. The
three men were delighted beyond measure to know that we had made
the crossing in safety and that their wait under the upturned
James Caird was ended. Curiously enough, they did not recognize
Worsley, who had left them a hairy, dirty ruffian and had returned
his spruce and shaven self. They thought he was one of the whalers.
When one of them asked why no member of the party had come round
with the relief, Worsley said, “What do you mean?” “We thought
the Boss or one of the others would come round,” they explained.
“What’s the matter with you?” said Worsley. Then it suddenly
dawned upon them that they were talking to the man who had been
their close companion for a year and a half. Within a few minutes
the whalers had moved our bits of gear into their boat. They
towed off the James Caird and hoisted her to the deck of their
ship. Then they started on the return voyage. Just at dusk on
Monday afternoon they entered Stromness Bay, where the men of
the whaling-station mustered on the beach to receive the rescued
party and to examine with professional interest the boat we had
navigated across 800 miles of the stormy ocean they knew so well.
When I look back at those days I have no doubt that Providence
guided us, not only across those snowfields, but across the
storm-white sea that separated Elephant Island from our landing-place
on South Georgia. I know that during that long and racking
march of thirty-six hours over the unnamed mountains and glaciers
of South Georgia it seemed to me often that we were four, not three.
I said nothing to my companions on the point, but afterwards
Worsley said to me, “Boss, I had a curious feeling on the march
that there was another person with us.” Crean confessed to
the same idea. One feels “the dearth of human words, the
roughness of mortal speech” in trying to describe things
intangible, but a record of our journeys would be incomplete
without a reference to a subject very near to our hearts.
THE RESCUE
Our first night at the whaling-station was blissful. Crean and I
shared a beautiful room in Mr. Sorlle’s house, with electric light
and two beds, warm and soft. We were so comfortable that we were
unable to sleep. Late at night a steward brought us tea, bread
and butter and cakes, and we lay in bed, revelling in the luxury
of it all. Outside a dense snow-storm, which started two hours
after our arrival and lasted until the following day, was swirling
and driving about the mountain-slopes. We were thankful indeed
that we had made a place of safety, for it would have gone hard
with us if we had been out on the mountains that night. Deep
snow lay everywhere when we got up the following morning.
After breakfast Mr. Sorlle took us round to Husvik in a motor-launch.
We were listening avidly to his account of the war
and of all that had happened while we were out of the world of men.
We were like men arisen from the dead to a world gone mad. Our
minds accustomed themselves gradually to the tales of nations in
arms, of deathless courage and unimagined slaughter, of a world-conflict
that had grown beyond all conceptions, of vast red
battlefields in grimmest contrast with the frigid whiteness we
had left behind us. The reader may not realize quite how
difficult it was for us to envisage nearly two years of the most
stupendous war of history. The locking of the armies in the
trenches, the sinking of the Lusitania, the murder of Nurse Cavell,
the use of poison-gas and liquid fire, the submarine warfare,
the Gallipoli campaign, the hundred other incidents of the war,
almost stunned us at first, and then our minds began to compass
the train of events and develop a perspective. I suppose our
experience was unique. No other civilized men could have been
as blankly ignorant of world-shaking happenings as we were when
we reached Stromness Whaling Station.
I heard the first rumour of the Aurora’s misadventures in the Ross
Sea from Mr. Sorlle. Our host could tell me very little. He had
been informed that the Aurora had broken away from winter quarters
in McMurdo Sound and reached New Zealand after a long drift, and
that there was no news of the shore party. His information was
indefinite as to details, and I had to wait until I reached the
Falkland Islands some time later before getting a definite report
concerning the Aurora. The rumour that had reached South Georgia,
however, made it more than ever important that I should bring out
the rest of the Weddell Sea party quickly, so as to free myself
for whatever effort was required on the Ross Sea side.
When we reached Husvik that Sunday morning we were warmly greeted
by the magistrate (Mr. Bernsten), whom I knew of old, and the
other members of the little community. Moored in the harbour was
one of the largest of the whalers, the Southern Sky, owned by an
English company but now laid up for the winter. I had no means of
getting into communication with the owners without dangerous delay,
and on my accepting all responsibility Mr. Bernsten made
arrangements for me to take this ship down to Elephant Island.
I wrote out an agreement with Lloyd’s for the insurance of the ship.
Captain Thom, an old friend of the Expedition, happened to be in
Husvik with his ship, the Orwell, loading oil for use in Britain’s
munition works, and he at once volunteered to come with us in any
capacity. I asked him to come as captain of the Southern Sky.
There was no difficulty about getting a crew. The whalers were
eager to assist in the rescue of men in distress. They started
work that Sunday to prepare and stow the ship. Parts of the
engines were ashore, but willing hands made light labour. I
purchased from the station stores all the stores and equipment
required, including special comforts for the men we hoped to
rescue, and by Tuesday morning the Southern Sky was ready to
sail. I feel it is my duty as well as my pleasure to thank here
the Norwegian whalers of South Georgia for the sympathetic hands
they stretched out to us in our need. Among memories of kindness
received in many lands sundered by the seas, the recollection of
the hospitality and help given to me in South Georgia ranks high.
There is a brotherhood of the sea. The men who go down to the sea
in ships, serving and suffering, fighting their endless battle
against the caprice of wind and ocean, bring into their own
horizons the perils and troubles of their brother sailormen.
The Southern Sky was ready on Tuesday morning, and at nine
o’clock we steamed out of the bay, while the whistles of the
whaling-station sounded a friendly farewell. We had forgathered
aboard Captain Thom’s ship on the Monday night with several
whaling captains who were bringing up their sons to their
own profession. They were “old stagers” with faces lined and
seamed by the storms of half a century, and they were even more
interested in the story of our voyage from Elephant Island than
the younger generation was. They congratulated us on having
accomplished a remarkable boat journey. I do not wish to belittle
our success with the pride that apes humility. Under Providence
we had overcome great difficulties and dangers, and it was
pleasant to tell the tale to men who knew those sullen and
treacherous southern seas.
McCarthy, McNeish, and Vincent had been landed on the Monday
afternoon. They were already showing some signs of increasing
strength under a regime of warm quarters and abundant food.
The carpenter looked woefully thin after he had emerged from a bath.
He must have worn a lot of clothes when he landed from the boat,
and I did not realize how he had wasted till I saw him washed and
changed. He was a man over fifty years of age, and the strain had
told upon him more than upon the rest of us. The rescue came just
in time for him.
The early part of the voyage down to Elephant Island in the
Southern Sky was uneventful. At noon on Tuesday, May 23, we were
at sea and steaming at ten knots on a south-westerly course. We
made good progress, but the temperature fell very low, and the signs
gave me some cause for anxiety as to the probability of encountering
ice. On the third night out the sea seemed to grow silent. I
looked over the side and saw a thin film of ice. The sea was
freezing around us and the ice gradually grew thicker, reducing
our speed to about five knots. Then lumps of old pack began to
appear among the new ice. I realized that an advance through pack-ice
was out of the question. The Southern Sky was a steel-built
steamer, and her structure, while strong to resist the waves, would
not endure the blows of masses of ice. So I took the ship north,
and at daylight on Friday we got clear of the pancake-ice. We
skirted westward, awaiting favourable conditions. The morning
of the 28th was dull and overcast, with little wind. Again the
ship’s head was turned to the south-west, but at 3 p.m. a definite
line of pack showed up on the horizon. We were about 70 miles from
Elephant Island, but there was no possibility of taking the
steamer through the ice that barred the way. North-west again
we turned. We were directly north of the island on the
following day, and I made another move south. Heavy pack formed
an impenetrable barrier.
To admit failure at this stage was hard, but the facts had to be
faced. The Southern Sky could not enter ice of even moderate
thickness. The season was late, and we could not be sure that the
ice would open for many months, though my opinion was that the
pack would not become fast in that quarter even in the winter,
owing to the strong winds and currents. The Southern Sky could
carry coal for ten days only, and we had been out six days. We
were 500 miles from the Falkland Islands and about 600 miles from
South Georgia. So I determined that, since we could not wait about
for an opening, I would proceed to the Falklands, get a more
suitable vessel either locally or from England, and make a second
attempt to reach Elephant Island from that point.
We encountered very bad weather on the way up, but in the early
afternoon of May 31 we arrived at Port Stanley, where the cable
provided a link with the outer world. The harbour-master came out
to meet us, and after we had dropped anchor I went ashore and met
the Governor, Mr. Douglas Young. He offered me his assistance at
once. He telephoned to Mr. Harding, the manager of the Falkland
Islands station, and I learned, to my keen regret, that no ship
of the type required was available at the islands. That evening
I cabled to London a message to His Majesty the King, the first
account of the loss of the Endurance and the subsequent adventures
of the Expedition. The next day I received the following message
from the King:
“Rejoice to hear of your safe arrival in the Falkland Islands and
trust your comrades on Elephant Island may soon be rescued.
“GEORGE R.I.”
The events of the days that followed our arrival at the
Falkland Islands I will not attempt to describe in detail. My
mind was bent upon the rescue of the party on Elephant Island at
the earliest possible moment. Winter was advancing, and I was
fully conscious that the lives of some of my comrades might be
the price of unnecessary delay. A proposal had been made to send
a relief ship from England, but she could not reach the southern
seas for many weeks. In the meantime I got into communication
with the Governments of the South American Republics by wireless
and cable and asked if they had any suitable ship I could use for
a rescue. I wanted a wooden ship capable of pushing into loose
ice, with fair speed and a reasonable coal capacity. Messages of
congratulation and goodwill were reaching me from all parts of the
world, and the kindness of hundreds of friends in many lands was
a very real comfort in a time of anxiety and stress.
The British Admiralty informed me that no suitable vessel was
available in England and that no relief could be expected before
October. I replied that October would be too late. Then the
British Minister in Montevideo telegraphed me regarding a trawler
named Instituto de Pesca No. 1, belonging to the Uruguayan
Government. She was a stout little vessel, and the Government had
generously offered to equip her with coal, provisions, clothing,
etc., and send her across to the Falkland Islands for me to take
down to Elephant Island. I accepted this offer gladly, and the
trawler was in Port Stanley on June 10. We started south at
once.
The weather was bad but the trawler made good progress, steaming
steadily at about six knots, and in the bright, clear dawn of the
third day we sighted the peaks of Elephant Island. Hope ran high;
but our ancient enemy the pack was lying in wait, and within twenty
miles of the island the trawler was stopped by an impenetrable barrier
of ice. The pack lay in the form of a crescent, with a horn to the
west of the ship stretching north. Steaming north-east, we reached
another horn and saw that the pack, heavy and dense, then trended
away to the east. We made an attempt to push into the ice, but it
was so heavy that the trawler was held up at once and began to grind
in the small thick floes, so we cautiously backed out. The propeller,
going slowly, was not damaged, though any moment I feared we might
strip the blades. The island lay on our starboard quarter, but there
was no possibility of approaching it. The Uruguayan engineer
reported to me that he had three days’ coal left, and I had to give
the order to turn back. A screen of fog hid the lower slopes of the
island, and the men watching from the camp on the beach could not
have seen the ship. Northward we steamed again, with the engines
knocking badly, and after encountering a new gale, made Port Stanley
with the bunkers nearly empty and the engines almost broken down.
H.M.S. Glasgow was in the port, and the British sailors gave us a
hearty welcome as we steamed in.
The Uruguayan Government offered to send the trawler to Punta
Arenas and have her dry-docked there and made ready for another
effort. One of the troubles on the voyage was that according to
estimate the trawler could do ten knots on six tons of coal a day,
which would have given us a good margin to allow for lying off the
ice; but in reality, owing to the fact that she had not been in
dock for a year, she only developed a speed of six knots on a
consumption of ten tons a day. Time was precious and these
preparations would have taken too long. I thanked the Government
then for its very generous offer, and I want to say now that the
kindness of the Uruguayans at this time earned my warmest gratitude.
I ought to mention also the assistance given me by Lieut. Ryan, a
Naval Reserve officer who navigated the trawler to the Falklands
and came south on the attempt at relief. The Instituto de Pesca
went off to Montevideo and I looked around for another ship.
A British mail-boat, the Orita called at Port Stanley opportunely,
and I boarded her with Worsley and Crean and crossed to Punta
Arenas in the Magellan Straits. The reception we received there
was heartening. The members of the British Association of
Magellanes took us to their hearts. Mr. Allan McDonald was
especially prominent in his untiring efforts to assist in the
rescue of our twenty-two companions on Elephant Island. He
worked day and night, and it was mainly due to him that within
three days they had raised a sum of £1500 amongst themselves,
chartered the schooner Emma and equipped her for our use.
She was a forty-year-old oak schooner, strong and seaworthy,
with an auxiliary oil-engine.
Out of the complement of ten men all told who were manning the ship,
there were eight different nationalities; but they were all good
fellows and understood perfectly what was wanted. The Chilian
Government lent us a small steamer, the Yelcho, to tow us part of
the way. She could not touch ice, though, as she was built of steel.
However, on July 12 we passed her our tow-rope and proceeded on our
way. In bad weather we anchored next day, and although the wind
increased to a gale I could delay no longer, so we hove up anchor
in the early morning of the 14th. The strain on the tow-rope was
too great. With the crack of a gun the rope broke. Next day
the gale continued, and I will quote from the log of the Emma,
which Worsley kept as navigating officer.
“9 a.m.—Fresh, increasing gale; very rough, lumpy sea.
10 a.m.—Tow-rope parted.
12 noon. Similar weather.
1 p.m.—Tow-rope parted again. Set foresail and forestay-sail
and steered south-east by south.
3 p.m.—Yelcho hailed us and said that the ship’s bilges were
full of water (so were our decks) and they were short of coal.
Sir Ernest told them that they could return to harbour.
After this the Yelcho steamed into San Sebastian Bay.”
After three days of continuous bad weather we were left alone to
attempt once more to rescue the twenty-two men on Elephant Island,
for whom by this time I entertained very grave fears.
At dawn of Friday, July 21, we were within a hundred miles of
the island, and we encountered the ice in the half-light.
I waited for the full day and then tried to push through. The
little craft was tossing in the heavy swell, and before she had
been in the pack for ten minutes she came down on a cake of ice and
broke the bobstay. Then the water-inlet of the motor choked with
ice. The schooner was tossing like a cork in the swell, and I saw
after a few bumps that she was actually lighter than the fragments
of ice around her. Progress under such conditions was out of the
question. I worked the schooner out of the pack and stood to the
east. I ran her through a line of pack towards the south that night,
but was forced to turn to the north-east, for the ice trended in that
direction as far as I could see. We hove to for the night, which was
now sixteen hours long. The winter was well advanced and the weather
conditions were thoroughly bad. The ice to the southward was moving
north rapidly. The motor-engine had broken down and we were entirely
dependent on the sails. We managed to make a little southing during
the next day, but noon found us 108 miles from the island. That
night we lay off the ice in a gale, hove to, and morning found the
schooner iced up. The ropes, cased in frozen spray, were as thick
as a man’s arm, and if the wind had increased much we would have had
to cut away the sails, since there was no possibility of lowering them.
Some members of the scratch crew were played out by the cold and the
violent tossing. The schooner was about seventy feet long, and
she responded to the motions of the storm-racked sea in a manner
that might have disconcerted the most seasoned sailors.
I took the schooner south at every chance, but always the line of
ice blocked the way. The engineer, who happened to be an American,
did things to the engines occasionally, but he could not keep them
running, and, the persistent south winds were dead ahead. It was
hard to turn back a third time, but I realized we could not reach
the island under those conditions, and we must turn north in order
to clear the ship of heavy masses of ice. So we set a northerly
course, and after a tempestuous passage reached Port Stanley once
more. This was the third reverse, but I did not abandon my belief
that the ice would not remain fast around Elephant Island during
the winter, whatever the arm-chair experts at home might say. We
reached Port Stanley in the schooner on August 8, and I learned
there that the ship Discovery was to leave England at once and
would be at the Falkland Islands about the middle of September.
My good friend the Governor said I could settle down at Port Stanley
and take things quietly for a few weeks. The street of that port
is about a mile and a half long. It has the slaughter-house at one
end and the graveyard at the other. The chief distraction is to
walk from the slaughter-house to the graveyard. For a change one
may walk from the graveyard to the slaughter-house. Ellaline
Terriss was born at Port Stanley—a fact not forgotten by the
residents, but she has not lived there much since. I could not
content myself to wait for six or seven weeks, knowing that six
hundred miles away my comrades were in dire need. I asked the
Chilian Government to send the Yelcho, the steamer that had towed
us before, to take the schooner across to Punta Arenas, and they
consented promptly, as they had done to every other request of
mine. So in a north-west gale we went across, narrowly escaping
disaster on the way, and reached Punta Arenas on August 14.
There was no suitable ship to be obtained. The weather was showing
some signs of improvement, and I begged the Chilian Government to
let me have the Yelcho for a last attempt to reach the island.
She was a small steel-built steamer, quite unsuitable for work in
the pack, but I promised that I would not touch the ice. The
Government was willing to give me another chance, and on August 25 I
started south on the fourth attempt at relief. This time
Providence favoured us. The little steamer made a quick run down
in comparatively fine weather, and I found as we neared Elephant
Island that the ice was open. A southerly gale had sent it
northward temporarily, and the Yelcho had her chance to slip
through. We approached the island in a thick fog. I did not dare
to wait for this to clear, and at 10 a.m. on August 30 we passed some
stranded bergs. Then we saw the sea breaking on a reef, and I
knew that we were just outside the island. It was an anxious moment,
for we had still to locate the camp and the pack could not be trusted
to allow time for a prolonged search in thick weather; but presently
the fog lifted and revealed the cliffs and glaciers of Elephant Island.
I proceeded to the east, and at 11.40 a.m. Worsley’s keen eyes
detected the camp, almost invisible under its covering of snow.
The men ashore saw us at the same time, and we saw tiny black figures
hurry to the beach and wave signals to us. We were about a mile and
a half away from the camp. I turned the Yelcho in, and within half
an hour reached the beach with Crean and some of the Chilian sailors.
I saw a little figure on a surf-beaten rock and recognized Wild.
As I came nearer I called out, “Are you all well?” and he answered,
“We are all well, boss,” and then I heard three cheers. As I
drew close to the rock I flung packets of cigarettes ashore; they
fell on them like hungry tigers, for well I knew that for months
tobacco was dreamed of and talked of. Some of the hands were in
a rather bad way, but Wild had held the party together and kept hope
alive in their hearts. There was no time then to exchange news or
congratulations. I did not even go up the beach to see the camp,
which Wild assured me had been much improved. A heavy sea was running
and a change of wind might bring the ice back at any time. I hurried
the party aboard with all p